Quarterlytics / Communication Services / Specialty Retail / Pendragon

Pendragon

pdg · LSE Communication Services
Claim this profile
Ticker pdg
Exchange LSE
Sector Communication Services
Industry Specialty Retail
Employees 10,000+
← All annual reports
FY2022 Annual Report · Pendragon
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
2022 ANNUAL REPORT

2
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
IN THIS REPORT

3
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
STRATEGIC REVIEW
4	
Chairman's Statement 
5 
Chief Executive Officer's Review
7	
Business Segments 
8	
Financial Summary
9	
Operational and Financial Highlights
9	
Performance Indicators
10	 s172 Statement 
13 Business Profiles
19	 Life at Pendragon
22	 Industry Insight
OPERATIONAL AND FINANCIAL REVIEW
 
25  Business Review
33  Financial Review 
38  Risk Overview and Management 
49 	 Viability Statement 
DIRECTORS REPORT 
51	 Environment, Social and Governance Report
52	 Environmental Report
60	 Social Report
63	 Corporate Governance Report
66	 Board of Directors 
68	 Audit Committee Report
74	 Nomination Committee Report
76	 Remuneration Committee Report
77	 Directors’ Remuneration Report
96	 Directors’ Report
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
100	Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities in Respect
	
of the Annual Report and the Financial Statements
101 Independent Auditor’s Report to the Members of 
	
Pendragon PLC
112	 Consolidated Income Statement 
113	 Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income 
114	 Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
115	 Consolidated Balance Sheet 
116 Consolidated Cash Flow Statement 
117 Reconciliation of Net Cash Flow to Movement in   
	
Adjusted Net  Debt
118	 Notes to the Financial Statements
197	Company Balance Sheet
198	Company Statement of Other Comprehensive Income
199	Company Statement of Changes in Equity 
200	Notes to the Financial Statements of the Company 
209	Advisors, Banks and Shareholder Information 
210 5 Year Group Review

4
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
CHAIRMAN'S STATEMENT
Ian Filby, Non-Executive Chairman
I am delighted to report a year of good progress for Pendragon as we continue 
to deliver on our strategy which has resulted in an underlying profit before tax of 
£57.6m (FY21: £83.0m).  This was made possible by the effort and contribution 
of our associates across all of the UK Motor, Software and Leasing divisions.  
This result was achieved despite a backdrop of higher interest rates and higher 
operating costs than expected at the start of 2022, contributing to the reduction 
from FY21.
Doing the right thing, both in the way our associates carry out their day to day 
activities, ensuring they remain passionate and enjoy what they do, together with 
continued strong and effective governance is a key ingredient in delivering success 
for all our stakeholders.  The Board of directors, under my leadership, remains 
responsible for the long term success of the Company, setting corporate objectives 
and providing the strategic oversight required as we continuously look for new 
ways to exceed expectations and innovate, approve and adapt our approaches to 
the prevailing circumstances.  
In October 2022, following a period of engagement and reflection, we successfully 
relaunched our cultural values, designed to ensure all areas of the business and 
each and every associate knows what is expected of them, aiming to ensure we are 
‘driving beyond the possible’ at every opportunity presented to us.  
As a Group, we will continue to embed our new culture, ensuring that it assists us in 
our continued focus on the implementation of our strategy to (i) unlock value in UK 
Motor; (ii) growing and diversifying Pinewood and (iii) disrupting UK used car sales.
I am confident that with our new cultural values and a well developed, adaptable 
and focussed strategy, and our demonstrable ability to innovate, the Group is well 
placed to capitalise on its opportunities going forward.
During 2022, the Company received approaches to acquire the Group from two 
parties, which recognised the real value of the Group, but neither came to fruition 
for different reasons.  The Board remains completely focused on creating and 
delivering value for its shareholders.

5
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
We have made further progress with our strategy to 
“Transform automotive retail through digital innovation and 
operational excellence” during an extremely busy year of 
delivery in 2022, the second full-year of our strategy since its 
launch in 2020.  During the year we completed the relaunch 
of Car Store, with a market leading omni-channel proposition, 
developed new relationships with the world's largest new-
energy manufacturer in BYD, delivered 13% user growth in 
International markets with Pinewood, and also delivered 
numerous strategic initiatives to drive the performance of our 
UK Motor division.  We are already seeing the benefits of these 
significant changes, which underpinned a strong financial 
performance in a year of challenging conditions shaped by 
supply shortages in both new and used vehicles, inflationary 
cost pressures and rising interest rates.    
The Group also navigated an intense period of corporate activity 
after disclosing two offers for the Group. This demonstrates 
belief in the strength of our strategy and the prospects for 
the Group overall. We remain confident in our market-leading 
proposition and are well positioned to capitalise on the long-
term growth opportunities while managing the short-term 
challenges that consumer-facing businesses are experiencing. 
We remain focussed on further opportunities for strategic 
expansion in order to create shareholder value.
The Group delivered an underlying profit before tax of £57.6m 
in FY22 (FY21: £83.0m), which, although behind FY21 was 
ahead of expectations at the start of the year.  This performance 
was delivered through higher-than-expected gross profits as a 
result of both strategic self-help initiatives and strong new car 
margins, which together outpaced the higher than expected 
levels of cost inflation and increases to base interest rates, 
which together added approximately £10m of additional cost 
and interest charges.  We also further improved the strength 
of our balance sheet, reducing adjusted net debt by a further 
£26.4m in the year, and closing the year with net assets of 
£281m, an improvement of £55m compared to FY21.
During 2022 we invested more than ever before in Pinewood, 
with development capex of almost £6m being deployed in order 
to further maximise the benefit that our DMS technology can 
bring both to our business, and that of our external customers. 
Many of the developments we have made have powered the 
performance in our UK Motor Division, with multiple software 
changes being implemented to support the digitisation and 
presentation of finance and insurance options to our customers, 
improvements to the way we value part exchanges online, 
and also to the “sell-your-car” customer journey.  Pinewood’s 
technology also powers the capability and functionality of 
our fully transactional CarStore.com web platform.  Last year 
saw significant international expansion too, with Pinewood 
growing its international user base by 13% to a record of 
approximately 6,400 users.  International users now represent 
24% of Pinewood’s total external user base.  There continues to 
be a strong pipeline of opportunities in new markets, with new 
customers added in Singapore and the Middle East during 2022. 
The used car market has evolved rapidly since 2020 presenting 
permanent changes to the way that consumers search and 
shop for used cars.   In this time, we have successfully adapted 
our model, and evolved our strategy to respond to these 
changes.  The Group’s focus has evolved from a standalone 
used car proposition, to our ‘new-used car strategy’.  At its 
core is a focus on an omni-channel business model across our 
entire used car business, including those cars in our existing 
franchise locations, ensuring we fully utilise our wider used car 
inventory.  The development of our technological capability, 
enhanced website functionality and the emergence of a truly 
omni-channel business model has put us in a strong position to 
respond to these developments in the used car market.   
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER'S REVIEW

6
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
During 2022 we relaunched Car Store, centred around 
CarStore.com, which is our primary market-place for all of 
our used car inventory. This platform now lists approximately 
12,000 cars across our brands on one single platform, more 
than any of the other new automotive retail platforms that 
have entered the market since 2019. To further support 
CarStore.com, we launched a new cross-channel marketing 
campaign during May, including prime-time TV advertising, 
which aims to raise brand awareness and to highlight the 
omni-channel credentials of our offer, focussing on ‘car 
buying that revolves around you’. Physical space remains 
a good opportunity to grow our used car proposition, and 
we completed the first of our new model Car Store sites in 
Chesterfield in April, with a second opened in Warrington in 
December 2022.  I am pleased with the new concept of these 
stores and early performance has been encouraging.  Against 
a backdrop of constrained used car supply, we delivered a 
strong used car performance in the second half as we saw the 
benefits of our investment in CarStore.com.  This meant we 
outperformed the used car market by around 600bps in H2.
As well as investing in our used car business during 2022, 
we have invested heavily into our new car business, which 
remains a fundamental part of the Group.  We have completed 
a number of major building projects during 2022, including 
completely remodelled BMW showrooms in Derby and Hull, 
investment into the Mercedes showroom in Huddersfield, 
and a new concept investment into the Mayfair Land Rover 
showroom.  Finally, we are well on the way to completing 
the development of a new build freehold development of our 
Porsche showroom in Nottingham in 2023, reflecting the latest 
design of Destination Porsche, as we exit a leased location. 
We continue to work alongside our manufacturer partners to 
maximise performance in this important part of the Group. 
We are also looking at the potential to increase our new car 
representation and are delighted to be a UK launch partner for 
BYD, with our first stores opened in March, as well as exploring 
other potential strategic opportunities.
We also invested significant time and resources into the 
development of Pendragon’s culture during 2022.  Led by our 
Chief People Officer, we completed a comprehensive review of 
our purpose and values to support our vision of ‘Transforming 
automotive retail through digital innovation and operational 
excellence’, with input from a wide range of teams across the 
business.  The resulting set of values, formed by our teams, 
are all aimed to support our newly defined Group purpose – 
‘Driving beyond the possible’.  I am confident that this new 
purpose will further enable the changes we continue to make 
at pace, throughout the organisation.  
Given the mixed economic backdrop and market conditions, 
I am proud of our progress during the year and believe we 
are well positioned to move the business forward in 2023. 
As always, our success depends on the contribution from 
our associates, and I would again like to thank them for their 
performance in challenging conditions during 2022.
OUTLOOK
We finished FY22 with good momentum, and trading has 
been positive in the first two months of FY23, but we remain 
mindful of the potential headwinds from challenging macro-
economic conditions and the potential for further interest 
rate rises.  We expect the levels of supply in both new and 
used vehicles to remain below historical levels during FY23, 
but there are some encouraging signs of improvement in both 
production and supply of new vehicles.  We continue to expect 
our ongoing initiatives and growth opportunities to more than 
offset operating cost inflation within the business during FY23. 
Accordingly, the Board remains confident in the prospects for 
the Group in the year ahead.
Bill Berman
Chief Executive
22 March 2023
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER'S REVIEW

7
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
BUSINESS SEGMENTS
UK MOTOR
Sale and servicing of 
vehicles in the UK
SOFTWARE
Software as a Service 
provision to global 
automotive business 
users
LEASING
Fleet and contract 
hire provider - and 
also a source of used 
vehicle supply
The business is organised into 3 segments, analysed as follows:
N
E
W
 
V
E
H
I
C
L
E
 
R
E
T
A
I
LI
N
G
F
L
E
E
T
 
A
N
D
 
L
E
A
S
I
N
G
S
u
p
pl
y
 o
f 
u
s
e
d
 v
e
hi
cl
e 
in
v
e
nt
or
y
fr
o
m
 p
a
rt
 e
x
c
h
a
n
g
e
s
S
u
p
pl
y
 o
f 
u
s
e
d
 v
e
hi
cl
e 
in
v
e
nt
or
y
fr
o
m
 
d
e
fl
e
e
t
e
d
 v
e
hi
cl
e
s
USED
VEHICLE
RETAILING
S
O
F
T
W
A
R
E
e
x
p
er
ti
se
 f
o
r 
v
e
hi
cl
e 
r
e
c
o
n
di
ti
o
ni
n
g
T
e
c
h
ni
c
al
 
e
q
u
i
p
m
e
n
t 
a
n
d
V
E
HI
C
L
E
 
S
E
R
V
I
C
E 
&
 
R
E
P
A
I
R
fo
r 
ef
fi
ci
e
n
t 
us
e
d 
c
a
r 
o
p
er
at
i
o
n
s
M
a
rk
e
t 
l
e
a
d
in
g
 s
y
st
e
m
The Group has revised its reporting segments.  In January 2022 the Group re-organised its management and reporting structure.  The significant changes were that the 
Franchised UK Motor and Car Store operations were brought under the management of the UK Motor operation.  In the 2022 financial statements therefore, the Franchised 
UK Motor and Car Store segments are no longer reported separately.  See note 2.3. 

8
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
2021
2022
49.7
2020
ADJUSTED NET DEBT*
£23.3M
2021
2022
116.3
2020
UNDERLYING OPERATING PROFIT*
£98.5M
REVENUE
£3,620.0M
GROSS PROFIT
£457.2M
2021
2022
2020
457.2
441.3
GROSS MARGIN
12.6%
2021
2022
2020
12.8
2021
2022
2020
UNDERLYING EPS*
3.2P
5.0
£57.6M
2021
2022
2020  
83.0
2021
2022
3,449.9
2020
UNDERLYING PROFIT BEFORE TAX*
3,620.0
12.6
98.5
3.2
57.6
23.3
2021
2022
107.6
2020
 OPERATING PROFIT 
£101.0M
101.0
2021
100.4
45.9
353.2
12.1
0.6
8.2
2,924.6
9.2
(29.6)
2022
73.3
2020
PROFIT / (LOSS) BEFORE TAX
£57.2M
57.2
NOTE:  Throughout this document, Alternative Performance Measures have been used which are non-GAAP measures that are presented to provide readers with 
additional financial information that is regularly reviewed by management and should not be viewed in isolation or as an alternative to the equivalent GAAP measure, 
see note 1 of the Financial Statements for details.
* Alternative Performance Measure
FINANCIAL SUMMARY

9
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
KPI
Definition
2022 Performance
Change
Underlying EPS
Underlying profit after tax divided by weighted average 
number of shares
3.2p
down 36.0%
Underlying PBT
Underlying profit before tax excludes items that are 
not incurred in the normal course of business and are 
sufficiently significant and/or irregular to impact the 
underlying trends in the business
£57.6m
down 30.6%
Underlying
Operating Margin
Underlying operating profit divided by revenue
2.7%
down 0.7%
Leverage ratio
Adjusted net debt : underlying EBITDA is the ratio of our 
adjusted net debt to underlying EBITDA
0.1
down 66.7%
KEY STRATEGIC MEASURES
KPI
Definition
2022 Performance
Change
Aftersales 
Revenue
All aftersales revenues (like-for-like)1
£276.1m
up 7.5%
Used Revenue
All used vehicle revenues (like-for-like)1
£1,807.7m
up 6.5%
Used GPU
Used gross profit divided used retail units sold
£1,607
down 3.8%
New GPU
New gross profit divided new retail units sold
£2,719
up 42.3%
KEY FINANCIAL MEASURES
1 see section 1 of the notes to the financial statements for Alternative Performance Measure reconciliations and like-for-like reconciliations
OPERATIONAL AND FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
PERFORMANCE INDICATORS
OPERATIONAL AND FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
Strong financial performance
•	 Group Revenue up by 4.9% to £3,620.0m (FY21: £3,449.9m). 
Revenue up 6.7% on a like-for-like basis.
•	 Gross profit value 3.6% higher at £457.2m, with investment 
in strategic initiatives delivering increases in both new and 
aftersales gross profit.
•	 Underlying cost increases of 10.4% (£33.7m), driven by higher 
levels of cost inflation, c.£10m of additional marketing costs 
to support the used car proposition and the non-recurrence 
of c.£12m of rates relief received in FY21.  
•	 Underlying profit before tax of £57.6m (FY21: £83.0m) was 
ahead of the Board’s expectations at the start of the year. 
Outperformance delivered despite c.£10m headwind from 
approximately £4m higher operating expenses, driven by 
higher levels of inflation, and approximately £6m of higher 
interest costs driven by rate changes, against original 
expectations for FY22.
•	 After non-underlying items the Group reported profit before 
tax of £57.2m (FY21: £73.3m).
•	 Strengthened balance sheet, with adjusted net debt reduced 
by £26.4m from £49.7m in FY21 to £23.3m in FY22.
Further strategic progress delivered
•	 Technology releases in Pinewood including integrated used 
car valuation tools and open banking tools are key enablers 
for UK Motor performance.
•	 New processes and products for UK Motor, including 
enhanced customer journey management and improvements 
to aftersales diary management, are driving improved 
productivity and supporting strong margins.
•	 New omni channel used car platform, CarStore.com has 
increased digital traffic by 61% year on year post-launch in 
May 2022.
•	 CarStore.com now lists approximately 12,000 used cars, 
more than any of the new automotive retail platforms that 
have entered the market since 2019.
•	 Investment into numerous franchise locations, including 
Porsche, BMW, Mercedes-Benz and Land Rover, completed 
in FY22 as well as development of a new Car Store in 
Warrington.
•	 Pendragon selected as UK launch partner for BYD, the 
world’s largest new energy vehicle manufacturer.

10
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
HOW 
WE ENGAGE
WHY
WE ENGAGE
WHAT MATTERS 
TO THIS GROUP
WHAT DID WE DO
AS A RESULT
CUSTOMERS
We continue to engage with our 
customers in a variety of ways, 
including:-
Measuring customer KPIs from OEM 
surveys reported to management;
Management and directors continue to 
visit dealerships, regularly listening to 
customer feedback;
Online review of our services through 
platforms such as Trust Pilot regularly 
monitored by our marketing teams;
Undertaking mystery shopping 
exercises periodically carried out to 
provide insight into the customer 
perspective and journey
Our purpose is to 
deliver a high quality, 
personalised service 
to all our customers 
across all of our business 
divisions: Franchised 
UK Motor, Car Store, 
Software and Leasing
•	 Product range, price 
and quality
•	 Convenience and 
accessibility
•	 Ease of transacting
•	 Customer service
•	 Responsible use of 
personal data
•	 	Improving and 
developing the on-line 
customer journey for 
ease of transacting
•	 	Continued prioritisation 
of customer safety 
following reopening of 
operations throughout 
the Covid-19 pandemic.
ASSOCIATES
We listen carefully to the views of our 
employees across all our businesses.   
In 2021, we appointed a Chief People 
Officer who is further innovating 
and developing our engagement 
processes.
We continue to operate an 
independent whistleblowing helpline, 
enabling employees to raise any issues 
or matters of concern in confidence
We wish to continue 
to be a responsible 
employer, both in 
terms of continuing 
to ensure the health, 
safety and wellbeing of 
our employees and also 
ensuring we maintain a 
responsible approach to 
the pay and benefits our 
employees receive.
•	 	Fair employment
•	  Fair pay and benefits
•	 	Tackling our gender 
pay gap
•	 	Diversity and inclusion
•	 	Training, development 
and career 
opportunities
•	 	Health and safety
•	 	Responsible use of 
personal data
•	 Ensured that associate 
safety and wellbeing 
was at the forefront 
of all decisions taken 
during the Covid-19 
pandemic
•	 We put in place 
stringent measures 
to protect employee  
safety
•	 Continued to enhance 
the range of benefits 
available
•	 Recruitment and 
appointment of a 
diversity and equality 
officer currently 
underway
STATEMENT BY THE DIRECTORS IN PERFORMANCE OF THEIR STATUTORY 
DUTIES IN ACCORDANCE WITH s172(1) COMPANIES ACT 2006
The board of directors of Pendragon PLC confirm that during the year under review, it has acted to promote the long term 
success of the Company for the benefit of all shareholders, whilst having regard to the  matters set out in section 172(1)(a)-(f) 
of the Companies Act 2006 in the decisions taken during the year ended 31 December 2022, further detail of which is set out 
below and which are incorporated into the Strategic Report.
s172 STATEMENT

11
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
HOW 
WE ENGAGE
WHY
WE ENGAGE
WHAT MATTERS 
TO THIS GROUP
WHAT DID WE DO
AS A RESULT
SUPPLIERS
Regular meetings and updates with 
all key suppliers with executive 
management, in particular our OEM 
partners 
Supplier payment terms reported and 
published
Although we do not 
manufacture the vehicles 
we sell, we need to 
maintain relationships 
with all our OEM 
partners to ensure 
we can continue to 
provide products to our 
customers.
All our suppliers must be 
able to demonstrate that 
they take appropriate 
action to prevent 
involvement in modern 
slavery, corruption, 
bribery and breaches of 
competition law 
•	 	Fair trading and 
payment terms
•	 	Anti-Bribery
•	  Anti-Modern Slavery
•	 	Operational 
improvement 
•	 	We continued to 
work closely with 
all our suppliers to 
deliver operational 
improvement and 
effective trading 
through the 
continuation of the  
Covid-19 pandemic and 
the associated impact 
on supplies;
•	 	We surveyed all key 
suppliers for adherence 
to anti-slavery 
standards.
COMMUNITY
Regular involvement in charity appeals 
both nationally and locally
As a predominantly retail 
operator, with a tangible 
nationwide presence 
in many communities, 
our retail businesses 
generate community 
involvement through 
local engagement, 
contributing to local 
areas in a variety of 
ways.
•	 	Charitable donations 
and support;
•	 	Employment 
opportunities;
•	  Volunteering;
•	 	Fair tax policy
•	 We continued other 
charitable activities 
where possible, as 
reported at page 
62 of the Corporate 
Governance Report

12
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
HOW 
WE ENGAGE
WHY
WE ENGAGE
WHAT MATTERS 
TO THIS GROUP
WHAT DID WE DO
AS A RESULT
ENVIRONMENT
Over the last 24-30 months, 
we have re-evaluated 
seriously our responsibilities 
to our customers, investors, 
associates, suppliers and the 
public in terms of how our 
activities as a retailer impact 
the natural environment.
We continue to regularly 
review our environment policy.
We acknowledge the 
responsibility we have to 
protect the environment 
and to minimise the 
environmental impact of 
our activities.
•	  Minimising atmospheric 
emissions, commercial 
and industrial waste
•	  Minimising vehicle 
movements causing 
nuisance or noise
•	  Minimising industrial 
noise and energy 
wastage
•	  Complying with 
statutory requirements 
relating to 
environmental matters
•	 	Ensuring environmental 
priorities are 
accounted for 
appropriately in 
planning and decision 
making
•	 	Operate an obsolete asset 
disposal policy
•	  Minimise and where possible, 
eliminating pollution
•	 	We continue to reduce 
incidences of energy wastage 
wherever possible, as reported 
in our Environment, Social and 
Governance Report at page 
56 of this Annual Report
•	 	We have successfully reduced 
our carbon emissions from 
our commuting activities, see 
page 56 of this Annual Report
•	  We continue to work with our 
OEM partners to effect the roll 
out of PHEV charging points 
across our dealership network 
SHAREHOLDERS AND POTENTIAL SHAREHOLDERS
Annual Report and Accounts
	
Corporate website
	
AGM
	
Results announcements and 
presentation
	
Shareholder and analyst 
meeting with management, 
followed by feedback from 
brokers and financial PR 
consultants
	
Engagement via the Directors 
and Company Secretary
We work to ensure our 
shareholders and their 
representatives have 
a good understanding 
of our strategy and 
business model
•	 	Long term value 
creation
•	 	Fair and equal 
treatment
•	  Growth opportunity
•	 	Financial stability
•	 	Transparency
•	 	To share in the success 
of our business
•	 	Dividends
•	 	Committed to reducing 
pension entitlement of 
executive directors to the 
workforce average
•	 The chief executive officer 
and chief finance officer 
report back to the Board after 
the investor roadshows
•	 The Group’s brokers and 
financial advisors provide 
detailed feedback after full 
and half year announcements 
and investor roadshows 
to inform the Board about 
investor views
•	 The non-executive chairman 
and senior independent 
director are available to 
shareholders and respond 
on matters relating to 
their responsibilities where 
requested
•	  We continue to consult with 
all major shareholders in 
relation to our remuneration 
policy
•	 We will engage with 
shareholders in the future 
about when to resume 
dividends
s172 STATEMENT

13
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
14 
UK Motor
16 
Software - Pinewood
18 
Leasing - Pendragon Vehicle Management
BUSINESS PROFILES

14
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
UK MOTOR
Sale and servicing of vehicles in the UK.
Operating Highlights 
•	 	Revenue up 6.1% to £3,536.2m (FY21: £3,332.7m).  Revenue 
up 7.0% on a like-for-like basis.
•	 Underlying operating profit down 20.9% to £69.1m (FY21: 
£87.4m).  
•	 Reported operating profit after non-underlying items of 
£71.6m (FY21: £82.6m).
•	 Gross margin of 11.8% (FY21: 11.9%).
•	 Used gross margin of 7.9% (FY21: 9.6%) as margins 
rebased from exceptional levels of H2 FY21.
•	 New gross margin of 9.1% (FY21: 7.3%) with constrained 
supply supporting higher margins.
•	 Aftersales gross margin of 50.5% (FY21: 50.5%).
•	 Used vehicle gross profit per unit remained strong, 
underpinned by strategic initiatives at £1,607 (FY21: £1,670).
•	 New vehicle gross profit per unit rose by £808 to a record 
high of £2,719 (FY21: £1,911).
•	 New volumes down 6.1%, compared to a market decline of 
2%, with supply constraints the driving factor.
•	 Used volumes down 8.7% on a like-for-like basis as 
supply constraints also impacted used vehicles.  Overall 
performance broadly in line with market down 8.5%. 
Strong H2 performance post launch of new CarStore.com 
proposition, with sales down just 2.2% compared to a market 
decline of 8.7%.  
•	 Total operating costs up by £36.7m, or 11.8%, driven by non-
repeat of government support measures, increased used car 
brand marketing and higher levels of cost inflation, partially 
offset by an ongoing focus on cost saving opportunities and 
utility hedging.
•	
BUSINESS PROFILES
“Our UK Motor division is recognised through our two main consumer brands in the UK, 
Evans Halshaw and Stratstone, complemented by our used car only brand, Car Store”

15
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
UK RETAIL POINTS
145
138K VEHICLES SOLD
24.1M
WEBSITE
VISITS
Evans Halshaw 90
Ford 35
Vauxhall 20 
Citroën 11
Renault 6 
Dacia 6 
Peugeot 4 
Nissan 4 
Kia 2
Hyundai 2  
Stratstone 43
Mercedes-Benz 7 
BMW 7  
MINI 7  
Porsche 6 
Land Rover 5 
Jaguar 5 
Aston Martin 3  
Smart 2   
Ferrari 1
Other Retail Points 12 
Car Stores 10 
EH Used Car Centres 2 

16
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
“Our Dealer Management System is 
split by role-type, collating common 
tasks together to make dealerships 
more efficient. With one central 
database, all information is shared 
throughout the system.”
Personalised video to customers	
	
Online payments
Integrated website solution for online buying
Integrated website solution for service booking
Operating Highlights
•	 Revenue up 4.1% to £25.4m (FY21: £24.4m).
•	 Gross profit up 0.9% to £22.7m (FY21: £22.5m).
•	 Operating profit down 12.0% to £11.0m (FY21: £12.5m), with 
the reduction driven by increased costs, principally driven 
by investment in developer resource to support product 
development and implementation.
•	 Strong global expansion continuing:
•	
Record high international users at 6,400,  up 13%.  
•	
International users now represent 24% of external users.
•	
New market entries to Singapore and Middle East.
•	 System development has both supported Pendragon’s 
strategic agenda as well as opened opportunities to sell 
developments to external customers:  
•	
Pinewood technology powering CarStore.com.
•	
Enhancement to used car valuation tools.
•	
Development of Finance & Insurance tools.
•	 Continued high levels of customer retention with net user 
churn of sub 1% in FY22, supported by frequent system 
updates.
BUSINESS PROFILES
SOFTWARE - PINEWOOD
Licencing of Software as a Service to global automotive business users.

17
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Pinewood Apps
Our apps are designed to streamline 
processes and improve efficiency across 
the whole dealership.
Our fully integrated suite of apps work 
seamlessly with our Pinewood DMS. 
Our apps are multi-platform and users 
can choose their preferred tablet or 
mobile, 
across 
iOS, 
Windows 
and 
Android devices.
Sales+ Efficiently manage the vehicle 
sales process and provide a great 
customer experience - the ultimate 
showroom app for sales professionals. 
	
	
Stock+ Respond to enquiries with 
personalised videos, instantly update 
stock information and store vehicle 
documentation.	
	
	
	
Parts+ Issue parts on-the-move, saving 
time with our in-built barcode scanner.
Tech+ Improve the service and repair 
experience, including video integration 
and technician time management.
Host+ Integrated video processes 
including 360° tours of a used vehicle 
in stock, or visually identifying work 
required following a health check.
Integration with over 50 manufacturers
Cars:
Commercial Vehicles:	
	
	
	
	
   Motorbikes:

18
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
LEASING - PENDRAGON VEHICLE MANAGEMENT
Fleet funding and services provider. Source of used vehicle 
supply. 
Operating Highlights
•	 Revenue down 6.9% to £83.7m (FY21: £89.9m).
•	 Gross profit up 10.9% to £24.4m (FY21: £22.0m), the decline 
in overall revenue was more than offset by higher residual 
values achieved on disposal.
•	 Operating profit up 13.7% to £19.9m (FY21: £17.5m), with 
operating costs flat at £4.5m.
•	 Growth opportunity in EV – c.40% of current order bank for 
electric and hybrid vehicles.
Pendragon Vehicle Management
At Pendragon Vehicle Management our Business to Business 
(B2B) brand focuses on comprehensive solutions for fleet 
customers. 
Utilising 
market 
leading 
software, 
tailored 
options are developed for the ever-evolving requirements of 
businesses.
From a variety of options on Fleet Management, to all elements 
of fleet funding across cars and commercial vehicles, business 
solutions are crafted to focus on customer priorities. From 
managing uptime to driving cost control, making the switch 
to electric vehicles or offering a variety of rental solutions, 
Pendragon Vehicle Management can provide comprehensive 
and tailored fleet solutions for any business. 
Rental Solutions
•	 Fast response service with over 30,000 vehicles ready to 
access.
•	  Real Time Rental Management system.
•	 	Daily and Flexible (three months and beyond) rental options 
available.
•	 Car, van, electric and specialist vehicle hire, delivered within 
four hours. 
Personal vehicle solutions and Employee schemes
Pendragon Vehicle Management has also evolved to offer 
bespoke Business to Employee (B2E) solutions including 
personal contract hire and Salary Sacrifice Car Schemes.
Salary Sacrifice
•	  Associates offered a brand-new car with no credit check 
and no upfront fee.
•	 	Convenient monthly payment deducted from associates’ 
salaries before tax.
•	  Choosing low emission vehicles offers savings on BIK tax 
and National Insurances payments.
“Pendragon Vehicle Management provide fleet 
funding solutions and services to help customers 
manage their fleets, improving efficiency, 
reducing costs and saving time.”
B V R L A
MEMBER
VAN EXCELLENCE
LOGISTICS UK MEMBER
Contract Hire 
For Cars
Contract Hire 
For Vans
Electric Vehicle 
Contract Hire
Salary Sacrifice
Sale and 
Leaseback
Contract 
Purchase
Fleet Funding
Telematics
Outsourced 
Administration
Risk Management
Maintenance and 
Repair
Fuel Cards
Accident 
Management
Fleet Management
BUSINESS PROFILES

19
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
LIFE AT PENDRAGON
Our people are what allow Pendragon to drive beyond the 
possible, they are the life and soul of our business, and what 
makes us great.  We aim to attract, retain and develop the 
best and brightest associates.  
Pendragon is transforming for tomorrow, simplifying our 
business to deliver our newly created purpose, adapt to the 
tough market environments that continue to be unpredictable 
and deliver on our strategy.  
Long term success relies on inspiring and nurturing a range 
of talent, from all sectors and industries.   We pride ourselves 
on seeing the potential of our associates before they even 
join the business and, then once they have, providing the 
support, encouragement and skills needed to build a long and 
rewarding career. Together we are unstoppable. 
We remain  focussed on making our business and our sector 
appeal to future generations and to support this, our people 
strategy focusses on:
•	 Embedding our group purpose and values to enable an 
inclusive and progressive culture
•	 	Driving 
continuous 
improvement 
of 
our 
associate 
engagement
•	  Digitalising our associate journey, people policies, benefits 
and support where possible.
•	  Enhancing and empowering career progression and 
experiences, through understanding and identifying our 
skills shortages
•	 	Addressing those gaps through modern skills learning 
initiatives
•	  Embedding a new way of working by embracing agile 
principles and the delivery of value driven products to the 
business
DEFINING OUR PURPOSE
Much of 2022 was spent defining our company purpose with 
every level and business unit in our business involved in setting 
why we are here and why we choose to exist.
Our Purpose is ‘Driving Beyond the Possible’.  Through our 
new purpose we are cementing our desire to drive beyond the 
possible and give the ‘Gift of Movement’ to all our customers be 
that through the sales & service of their vehicle or developing 
the software to enable a seamless digitally enabled buying 
experience.  
Our new purpose is guided by a set of co-created values: 
Unite as One, Do The Right Thing, Drive Our Innovation and 
Enjoy The Journey.  
UNITE
AS ONE
DO THE
RIGHT THING
DRIVE OUR
INNOVATION
ENJOY THE 
JOURNEY

20
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
BEGINNING YOUR JOURNEY 
We review our recruitment strategies to ensure we are 
attracting and identifying a diverse range of talent to join and 
develop within our business. We continually utilise modern 
attraction strategies to ensure we are reaching a diverse range 
of candidates in a difficult marketplace. We have revamped 
and relaunched our company induction which is available to 
all associates when they begin their journey with us.
YOUR DEVELOPMENT
We continue to provide comprehensive training to all 
associates, via our in-house learning and development team 
and our manufacturer partners.  All sales, technical and 
leadership associates have access to a range of blended 
learning packages via our manufacturer partners. In 2022, a 
total of 5,222 associates received training in 2023, delivering 
37,321 training hours. 
In 2022, A significant focus was placed on reviewing the skills 
and capabilities required for now and in the future this led to 
the re-design of core sales and leadership programmes for the 
business. 
We remain committed to investing in early career programmes, 
2022 saw the launch of a new sales apprenticeship 
programme, a customer service apprenticeship programme 
and a partnership with Manchester College launching their new 
Automotive T Levels programme. In our Pinewood business, 
with the onboarding of experienced and entry level associates, 
59% were recruited specifically to join either one of the graduate 
or early careers Schemes, including Apprenticeships, across 
the retail and development departments. During an exciting 
period of growth, especially in the international markets, this 
expresses Pinewood Technologies commitment to invest 
in those who are kick-starting their careers.  Pinewood also 
continued to offer an undergraduate placement scheme.
YOUR WORKPLACE & YOUR REWARD  
Looking after our associates is essential and we continuously 
review our benefits offering.  Our ambition is to offer an 
industry competitive total reward package that values our 
associates and enables us to be a responsible and attractive 
employer. Our benefits offering was further improved in 
November to ensure our associates continue to feel cared for. 
We have introduced a new associate benefits platform “Your 
Reward” to allow our people to have one dedicated space 
to select a voluntary benefit or increase their contractual 
LIFE AT PENDRAGON

21
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
benefits such as pension contribution or medical insurance 
cover levels. The Your Reward platform includes improved 
access to our Employee Assistance Programme (EAP) that 
looks after our associate’s wellbeing.  
2022 also saw the re-introduction of an all associate 
engagement survey, Your Voice.  The tri-annual survey, 
delivered digitally across the group, has enabled a way for 
the organisation to get fast and frequent feedback from 
our associates.  This is acted on at multiple levels within the 
organisation and helps to inform our people strategy for the 
group.  We saw over 79% of the organisation take part in the 
last survey and we were delighted to see an increase in the 
average score for our associates engagement rise from 6.9 to 
7.3.  
YOUR INCLUSION & YOUR INFLUENCE:
At Pendragon we are committed to fostering a more diverse, 
inclusive and unified culture that is representative of our 
associates, our customers and the society in which we live.
There are tremendous benefits to an environment where 
everyone feels valued and included. Diversity of thought 
and experience will be a key driver of our future success as 
a business: we cannot underestimate the positive impact that 
diversity and inclusion can have on how we understand our 
customers, drive our innovation and, most importantly, engage 
and inspire our people.  In 2022 we recruited our first Head 
of Diversity & Inclusion.  This was to ensure that appropriate 
focus was placed on engaging the business and drive an 
inclusion strategy that shapes a culture of unity, engages our 
associates to accelerate progress and in turn to create real, 
positive change.
With dealerships and offices across the UK, we’re in a unique 
position to understand and positively impact the local 
communities in which we live and work, while offering the 
support and backing of a large national business. Over the past 
year, Pendragon associates have participated in community 
activities giving time, money and knowledge to organisations, 
people and causes both locally and nationally. We are proud 
that our associates are positive active members of their local 
communities, they work to support both local and national 
initiatives. This year this has included co-ordinating and 
making donations to foodbanks, supplies for animal rescue 
centres and Christmas box donations to support local causes 
and charities. We continued our whole company support for 
the BBC’s Children in Need appeal, the Save the Children 
Christmas Jumper Day as well as continuing our partnership 
with Battersea Dogs and Cats Home.  

22
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDUSTRY INSIGHT
NEW CAR MARKET
The UK new car market was 1,614k vehicles in FY22 which 
was a decrease of 2.0% over the prior year, reflecting the 
continued shortfall in supply as a result of global microchip 
shortages. The UK new car market is divided into two markets, 
retail and fleet.  The retail market is the direct selling of vehicle 
units to individual customers and operates at a higher margin 
than the fleet market.  The retail market is the key market 
opportunity for the Group and represents 51% of the total 
market in the year.  The fleet market represents the sale 
of multiple vehicles to businesses, and is predominately 
transacted at a lower margin and consumes higher levels of 
working capital than retail, and represents 49% of the market 
in the year.
NEW CAR VEHICLE REGISTRATIONS FOR YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER ('000)
2022
2021
Change %
UK New Registrations
1,614.1
1,647.2
-2.0%
Group Represented* UK New Registrations
920.2
925.1
-0.5%
Source: new car vehicle registrations data from the ‘Society of Motor Manufacturers and Traders’.
*Group Represented - defined as national registrations for the franchised brands that the Group represents as a franchised dealer.
1.05m
1.32m
1.12m
1.42m
  PRIVATE     
  FLEET/BUSINESS  
  FORECAST
UK NEW CAR MARKET
Source: SMMT
3.0m
2.8m
2.6m
2.4m
2.2m
2.0m
1.8m
1.6m
1.4m
1.2m
1.0m
0.8m
0.6m
0.4m
0.2m
0
2019
2017
2020
2.31m
1.02m
1.29m
2.54m
2.37m
1.63m
2018
Units
0.75m
0.88m
2021
1.65m
2022
1.61m
2023
0.80m
0.84m
1.79m
2024
1.96m
0.82m
0.80m

23
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
USED CAR MARKET
In FY22, there were 6.6m used cars sold in the UK, an 
decrease of 8.3% on the prior year.  This represents a market 
opportunity that is more than four times the size by volume of 
the new car market.  The used market is more stable than the 
new vehicle sector, being less affected by fluctuations in the 
UK economy and providing a more reliable supply chain than 
the new market.
AFTERSALES MARKET
The main determinant of the aftersales market is the number 
of vehicles on the road, known as the ‘car parc’.  The car parc 
in the UK has risen slightly to 35.5m vehicles at the end of 
FY22, a rise of 0.6% from the end of FY21.  The car parc can 
also be segmented into markets representing different age 
groups.  At the end of FY22, around 13% of the car parc was 
represented by less than three-year-old cars, around 19% by 
four to six-year-old cars and 68% is greater than seven-year-
old cars.  The demand for servicing and repair activity is less 
affected than other sectors by economic conditions, as motor 
vehicles require regular maintenance and repair for safety, 
economy and performance reasons.
UK USED CAR MARKET
Source: DVLA Market Data
10.0m
8.0m
6.0m
4.0m
2.0m
0
2017
2018
2019
2020
7.8m
7.6m
7.6m
6.5m
2021
7.2m
2022
6.6m
UK CAR PARC BY AGE OF VEHICLE
Source:  GMAP
10.0m
9.0m
8.0m
7.0m
6.0m
5.0m
4.0m
3.0m
2.0m
1.0m
0
  0-3 YEARS
  4-6 YEARS
  7-10 YEARS
  11-15 YEARS
2020
2022
2017
  >15 YEARS
2018
2020
2020
2016
2019
Units
2021
2020
2022
2017
2018
2019
2021
2020
2022
2017
2018
2019
2021
2020
2022
2017
2018
2019
2021
2020
2022
2017
2018
2019
2021

24
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2021
25  Business Review
33  Financial Review
38  Risk Overview and Management
49 	 Viability Statement 
OPERATIONAL AND FINANCIAL REVIEW

25
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
BUSINESS REVIEW
STRATEGY AND BUSINESS REVIEW
SEGMENTAL PERFORMANCE
Units sold
H1 2022
H2 2022
FY22
H1 2021
H2 2021
FY21
Change
(%)
LFL 
Change
(%)
USED UNITS
UK Motor
46,016
43,339
89,355
53,894
44,432
98,326
-9.1%
-8.7%
US Motor
-
-
-
51
-
51
-100.0%
-
Total
46,016
43,339
89,355
53,945
44,432
98,377
-9.2%
-8.7%
NEW UNITS
UK Motor
24,686
24,087
48,773
30,067
22,218
52,285
-6.7%
-6.1%
US Motor
-
-
-
397
-
397
-100.0%
-
Total
24,686
24,087
48,773
30,464
22,218
52,682
-7.4%
-6.1%
(£m)
H1 2022
H2 2022
FY22
H1 2021*
H2 2021*
FY21*
Change
(%)
LFL 
Change
(%)
REVENUE
UK Motor
1,802.9
1,733.3
3,536.2
1,739.8
1,592.9
3,332.7
6.1%
7.0%
Software
12.4
13.0
25.4
12.1
12.3
24.4
4.1%
4.1%
Leasing
42.9
40.8
83.7
49.0
40.9
89.9
-6.9%
-6.9%
US Motor
-
-
-
28.3
0.3
28.6
-100%
-
Inter-segment revenue
(12.7)
(12.6)
(25.3)
(13.6)
(12.1)
(25.7)
-1.6%
-1.6%
Revenue
1,845.5
1,774.5
3,620.0
1,815.6
1,634.3
3,449.9
4.9%
6.7%
GROSS PROFIT
UK Motor
211.1
204.6
415.7
187.6
209.7
397.3
4.6%
5.6%
Software
11.1
11.6
22.7
11.2
11.3
22.5
0.9%
0.9%
Leasing
12.5
11.9
24.4
10.5
11.5
22.0
10.9%
10.9%
US Motor
-
-
-
4.0
-
4.0
-100%
-
Inter-segment gross profit
(2.5)
(3.1)
(5.6)
(2.1)
(2.4)
(4.5)
24.4%
24.4%
Gross Profit
232.2
225.0
457.2
211.2
230.1
441.3
3.6%
5.5%
UNDERLYING OPERATING PROFIT
UK Motor
37.2
31.9
69.1
37.9
49.5
87.4
-20.9%
-20.8%
Software
5.5
5.5
11.0
6.7
5.8
12.5
-12.0%
-12.0%
Leasing
10.2
9.7
19.9
8.1
9.4
17.5
13.7%
13.7%
US Motor
(0.8)
(0.7)
(1.5)
(0.8)
(0.3)
(1.1)
36.4%
-
Underlying Operating 
Profit
52.1
46.4
98.5
51.9
64.4
116.3
-15.3%
-14.8%
Gross Margin %
12.6%
12.7%
12.6%
11.6%
14.1%
12.8%
-0.2%
-0.2%
Underlying Operating Margin %
2.8%
2.6%
2.7%
2.9%
3.9%
3.4%
-0.7%
-0.7%
Operating Profit
54.3
46.7
101.0
48.1
59.5
107.6
-6.1%
The business is organised into 3 segments, analysed as follows:
•	 UK Motor – sale and servicing of vehicles in the UK.
•	 Software – Licencing of Software as a Service to global automotive business users
•	  Leasing – Fleet and contract hire provider.  Source of used vehicle supply
* The Group has revised its reporting segments.  In January 2022 the Group re-organised its management and reporting structure.  The significant changes were that the 
Franchised UK Motor and Car Store operations were brought under the management of the UK Motor operation.  In the 2022 financial statements therefore, the Fran-
chised UK Motor and Car Store segments are no longer reported separately.  See note 2.3.

26
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
UK MOTOR
The UK Motor business operated from 133 franchise points 
and 12 used cars only retail points which represent a range of 
volume and premium products offering both sales and service 
functions.
•	 	Further progress in respect of strategy to improve 
performance and unlock significant value in the UK Motor 
division.
•	 Introduced a number of new digital initiatives, underpinned 
by Pinewood, to differentiate our omni-channel model.
•	 CarStore.com – our single market place for all of the Group’s 
used cars.
Strategy delivery
Unlock value in the UK Motor division
The Group has made meaningful progress with its strategy 
to improve performance and unlock significant value in the 
UK Motor division through actions to:
1.	
Accelerate digital innovation 
2.	 Drive operational excellence and embed consistent best 
	
practice
3. Operate from a lean and efficient cost base.
These initiatives have been designed to drive improvements 
in used car margins, aftersales profitability and operating cost 
efficiency.
BUSINESS REVIEW
UK MOTOR (£m)
H1 2022
H2 2022
FY22
H1 2021*
H2 2021*
FY21*
Change
(%)
REVENUE
Used
948.9
859.7
1,808.6
846.1
860.5
1,706.6
6.0%
Aftersales
137.2
138.9
276.1
132.0
131.7
263.7
4.7%
New
716.8
734.7
1,451.5
761.7
600.7
1,362.4
6.5%
Revenue
1,802.9
1,733.3
3,536.2
1,739.8
1,592.9
3,332.7
6.1%
GROSS PROFIT
Used
77.1
66.5
143.6
73.6
90.6
164.2
-12.5%
Aftersales
70.4
69.1
139.5
65.3
67.9
133.2
4.7%
New
63.6
69.0
132.6
48.7
51.2
99.9
32.7%
Gross Profit
211.1
204.6
415.7
187.6
209.7
397.3
4.6%
Gross margin rate
11.7%
11.8%
11.8%
10.8%
13.2%
11.9%
-0.1%
Underlying Operating Expenses
(173.9)
(172.7)
(346.6)
(149.7)
(160.2)
(309.9)
11.8%
Underlying Operating Profit
37.2
31.9
69.1
37.9
49.5
87.4
-20.9%
Underlying Operating margin rate
2.1%
1.8%
2.0%
2.2%
3.1%
2.6%
-0.6%
Stocking Interest1
(5.7)
(9.0)
(14.7)
(4.8)
(5.0)
(9.8)
50.0%
Profit after Stocking Interest
31.5
22.9
54.4
33.1
44.5
77.6
-29.9%
Operating Profit
39.4
32.2
71.6
37.8
44.8
82.6
-13.3%
Total Revenue Change
3.6%
8.8%
6.1%
Like-for-like Revenue Change
4.2%
10.1%
7.0%
Used Units Sold
46,016
43,339
89,355
53,894
44,432
98,326
-9.1%
New Units Sold
24,686
24,087
48,773
30,067
22,218
52,285
-6.7%
Used GPU (£)2
1,676
1,534
1,607
1,366
2,039
1,670
-3.8%
New GPU (£)2
2,576
2,865
2,719
1,620
2,304
1,911
42.3%
Number of Locations
148
145
145
150
149
149
-2.7%
Average Used Selling Price (£)3
18,900
18,421
18,667
14,341
17,453
15,753
18.5%
Average New Selling Price (£)3
28,552
30,535
29,529
25,064
26,386
25,647
15.1%
1 Stocking interest. Whilst stocking interest is an interest expense and not part of operating profit, it is a cost directly related to the trading performance of both new 
and used cars.  It is included as an alternative performance measure in the table above for information.
2 GPU = Gross Profit per Unit. It is calculated as total New/Used GP divided by total New/Used retail units sold.
3 Trading dealerships only.   The used selling price is retail vehicles only and excludes any trade vehicles.  The new selling price excludes vehicles sold by our fleet busi-
ness (National Fleet Solutions).
* The Group has revised its reporting segments.  In January 2022 the Group re-organised its management and reporting structure.  The significant changes were that 
the Franchised UK Motor and Car Store operations were brought under the management of the UK Motor operation.  In the 2022 financial statements therefore, the 
Franchised UK Motor and Car Store segments are no longer reported separately.  See note 2.3.

27
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Accelerate digital innovation
We made further good progress with accelerating digital 
innovation during 2022, introducing a number of new 
initiatives, as well as seeing the full-year benefit from the 
improvements made during 2021.  Sales+, a layered DMS 
application embedded within the Pinewood system, has 
had further releases during FY22 which have enabled the 
automated inclusion of insurance products, subject to customer 
qualification, in all customer offers.  This addition will support 
improved sales penetrations with better product presentation 
to the customer, as well as leaving us well positioned to meet 
all current and future regulatory requirements.  Releases have 
also enabled real-time modification of the customer Finance 
& Insurance (“F&I") offer, allowing our teams to amend all 
aspects of the offer, such as finance type, deposit amount, term 
of loan, annual mileage and additional insurance products, all 
of which improve customer flexibility and transparency.   
We have also improved the content of our digital Finance 
and Insurance offering, by introducing the ability to present 
variable APR’s dependant on the balance being financed, 
together with dynamic lender comparisons to offer the 
best rate to consumers.  Further to this, we have improved 
our ability to perform used equity mining, to determine the 
optimal time to approach customers to maximise the equity 
in their current vehicle to facilitate a replacement vehicle sale. 
Since the launch of our initiatives to drive F&I, we have seen 
an improvement of c.700bps in the penetration rate, driving 
approximately £10m of incremental gross profit. We expect 
F&I penetration to be more challenging in FY23 as interest 
rate changes have resulted in higher APR’s being passed 
through to consumers.  However, we continue to develop 
our digital initiatives, utilising Pinewood Technologies, to be 
able to offer a menu-based approach to customers offering 
packages representing ‘good’, ‘better’ and ‘best’ options and a 
range of stand-alone insurance product sales to help mitigate 
the more challenging market conditions.
We continued to develop our Group-wide vehicle acquisition, 
management and pricing platform during the second half of 
FY22, which is focussed on optimising the speed at which we 
are able to turn vehicle inventory and maximising the margin 
we can achieve on used vehicles.  New functionality allowed 
us to respond quicker to market-based pricing changes, 
augmented with our internal indicators utilising our data 
management tools.  We have improved our online and in-store 
part-exchange and sell-your-car ("SYC") journey to include 
guaranteed customer valuations.  During the year, the Group 
acquired the ‘Sellyourcar.com’ domain name and developed 
a new website and proposition, using our pricing and part-
exchange management tools, in order to maximise the volume 
of cars acquired directly from customers.   Typically, SYC 
and part exchange cars, directly sourced from the customer, 
allow us to achieve higher margins of c.£500 per unit, when 
compared to cars sourced from auction.  During FY23 we will 
further develop this proposition with the ambition to double 
the number of cars we acquire through the SYC channel from 
c.7% of sales in 2022 to c.15% in 2023. 
Drive operational excellence and best practice
We continue to develop new processes and products to 
support our used car margin performance.  Our programme 
to target vehicle preparation efficiency progressed well in 
FY22 with the introduction of process automation to reduce 
reliance on vehicles being brought into stock manually and 
speed up the availability to customers.  We also improved the 
allocation of stock across the Group network to get the right 
cars, to the right location, quicker.  
We also delivered improvements in our Aftersales performance 
with revenue increasing by 4.7% in the year, 7.5% on a like-
for-like basis. A number of operational improvements such 
as a revised technician incentive structure and revised local 
reporting have underpinned this.  In addition, we introduced 
new functionality offering customers interest-free finance on 
aftersales work which is performing well, and driving higher 
penetration into the older vehicle car parc.   Our revised 
guarantee product suite introduced in 2021 which introduced 
new product options, differential pricing and operational 
procedures has seen our penetration of extended guarantee 
sales on eligible vehicles rising from 38% pre-pandemic to 43% 
in FY22, driving approximately £2m of incremental profit in 
FY22.   During FY23, we will refine the product offering further 
to present a dynamic pricing model which will adapt the price 
of  the product by make, model and derivative.

28
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
BUSINESS REVIEW
Operate from a lean and efficient cost base
Costs increased materially during FY22 (see financial review 
below), driven by the combination of the withdrawal of 
government support, our planned investment into marketing 
and the well-publicised levels of inflation which impacted 
across the cost-base, and in particular in labour and utility 
costs.  However, the Group continued to seek opportunities 
to mitigate cash costs where possible in FY22. We completed 
a major property negotiation with our largest landlord 
(c.70 properties in total) that resulted in lease extensions 
at current rent levels at c.30 locations and the return of 12 
vacant properties to the landlord, with the remaining sites to 
be reassessed as their leases expire.  This deal will deliver an 
annual cash saving in excess of £3.5m across rent and rates 
at the returned sites.   Over the past three years the Group 
has significantly reduced its vacant leased property exposure 
through a combination of surrenders, assignments, sublets 
and expiries, delivering over £7.0m in annualised rent savings 
and a further £3.0m in rates savings.
Enhance new car representation – New partnership with BYD 
With our HY results in September we announced that 
Pendragon would be a launch partner for BYD, the world’s 
largest new energy vehicle manufacturer. We continued 
to develop our dialogue with BYD during the second-half 
of FY22 ahead of their launch in 2023.  At launch in March, 
Pendragon initially opened two locations in Milton Keynes and 
Birmingham, with plans for up to a further six locations to be 
opened during the remainder of FY23.  We will continue to 
explore strategic options for expansion.
Strategy delivery – Disrupt used cars
We believe the UK is the most attractive used vehicle market 
globally, with a ratio of over three used vehicles sold for every 
new one.  The overall market for used cars is around seven 
million cars sold per annum.  Based on the desired age and 
mileage profile for our target market, we believe there is an 
addressable market for Pendragon of around three million cars 
per annum, which is larger than the total new car market. 
To capitalise on this opportunity, we will deliver:
1.	
Brand relaunch of the used car proposition
2.	 Differentiated value proposition
3. Build flexible acquisition & fulfilment capability and scale 
	
physical estate. 
Brand relaunch & Differentiate value proposition
Following the significant changes in the used car market in 
the last few years, we have transformed our used car strategy 
away from a standalone proposition to a Group-wide onmi-
channel hybrid proposition.  During 2022 we made significant 
developments to our digital capabilities, enabling us to 
develop a new-look website on CarStore.com displaying the 
majority of all group used vehicle stock. This capability has 
enabled us to list approximately 12,000 used vehicles on a 
single transactional website.  This proposition allows us to 
take a market-place approach to our Group used inventory, 
with consistent presentation with revised image standards. 
CarStore.com is the market leading digital proposition, 
supported by our extensive store network providing us with 
a truly omni-channel advantage, and with greater scale than 
pureplay digital competitors.  Our acquisition of the Sellyourcar.
com website will provide us with greater opportunities to 
source used car stock to support our proposition in a market 
that we anticipate will continue to be constrained for supply 
during 2023.
In addition, we delivered a full launch of this new proposition 
supported by a cross-channel marketing campaign.  This 
campaign included new content advertising across prime-time 
TV slots in order to drive awareness of the repositioned brand. 
We have seen a strong increase in digital traffic to CarStore.
com since the launch of these campaigns, with traffic up 
53% year on year, supporting new customer acquisition.  We 
have also seen very strong customer scores on Trustpilot and 
reputation.com, with Car Store scoring 4.6/5.0 on Trustpilot 
and 4.7/5.0 on reputation.com.  Following the successful 
launch of the new proposition and advertising campaigns, we 
saw our used car volumes outperform the wider market by 
approximately 6%, or approximately 2,750 units in the second 
half of FY22.           
Build flexible acquisition & fulfilment capability and scale 
physical estate
The first concept store to launch our physical proposition was 
formally launched in Chesterfield during April and the new 
store format has been very well received by customers and now 
acts as a blue print for further expansion.  During November 
we opened our second new format store in Warrington which 
holds approximately 400 vehicles on site and will further 
support the digital proposition. In addition, we are scaling our 
small-format locations, CarStore Direct, with a further 10 new 

29
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
locations introduced during FY22 across the UK.  These new 
format stores facilitate our Sell-your-car proposition and offer 
greater choice for click and collect fulfilment by providing 
convenient, small footprint locations, unlocking potential new 
local markets for Car Store to enter.   We will continue to 
look for opportunities to expand our physical estate, and are 
in advanced discussions about a number of locations for full-
scale new format stores. We expect to complete at least one 
addition during FY23.
Operating Review
The UK Motor division performed well during the year despite 
the backdrop of ongoing supply chain issues impacting 
new and used vehicle supply as well as there being various 
inflationary cost pressures, particularly payroll costs.  The 
overall new car market was down 2.0% in the year, with the 
new market down 11.9% in H1 but up 10.1% in H2, showing some 
early signs of new car supply issues easing.  The Group has 
built a strong order bank across its brands, with a strong order 
bank of over 20,000 orders as at the end of December, which 
it expects to deliver when supply eases, and in the short-term 
is focussed on achieving higher margins on the vehicles that 
are supplied.  The shortage in new car supply since 2020 is 
now also impacting the used car market, with a significant 
reduction in new vehicles manufactured in this period that 
would ordinarily flow into the important ‘nearly new’ sector 
now not being available.  
New Car volumes were down 6.1% on a like-for-like basis (total 
reported down 6.7%), slightly below the total market decrease 
of 2.0%, driven by a combination of brand representation 
and product mix.  Our focus on maximising margins through 
reduced levels of vehicle discounting combined with OEMs 
focussing on production of higher margin models resulted in 
new GPUs of £2,719, up 42.3% or £808 compared to 2021.   
Used Car volumes were down 8.7% on a like-for-like basis (total 
reported down 9.1%), with the total market down 8.5%.  This 
performance was driven by a number of different dynamics 
through the year.  During the first-half we were comparing 
against a strong H1 in 2021, where our online capabilities allowed 
us to outperform the market during the lock-downs of 2021, 
resulting in a reduction in sales of 14% against a market down 
8.3%.  In the second-half, we relaunched the Car Store website 
as described above, which together with our revised marketing 
activity resulted in H2 performance of a sales reduction of 
just 2.2% against the market down 8.7%.  Used margins were 
at record levels during parts of 2021, with used GPUs of 
£1,670, and margins over £2,000 in H2 2021.  As anticipated, 
margins declined from these unprecedented levels in 2022,
but through the operational initiatives detailed above, used 
GPU margins were maintained at strong levels, with a used GPU 
of £1,607 in 2022, still significantly higher than the £1,169 and 
£712 in 2020 and 2019 respectively, and over £600 higher than 
the average between 2011 and 2018.
Aftersales revenue also grew in the period, up by 7.5% on a 
like-for-like basis (total reported up 4.7%), which was driven by 
the operational improvements detailed above.  The aftersales 
gross margin of 50.5% is in line with 2021 despite the impact 
of technician pay inflation on cost of sales, resulting in an 
additional £6.3m of gross profit year on year.
Financial Review
Revenue increased by 6.1% to £3,536.2m in FY22 (7.0% on 
a like-for-like basis), as although new and used car volumes 
were down, the average selling price of vehicles increased.
Gross profit grew by 4.6% to £415.7m in FY22 (5.6% on a like-for-
like basis).  The increase in gross profit was principally driven 
by improvements in new cars, with volume declines more than 
offset by significantly stronger GPUs of £2,719 (FY21: £1,911), 
together with higher levels of aftersales gross margin.  These 
increases were partially offset by the anticipated reduction 
in used car GPUs and as well as lower volumes as described 
above. 
Underlying operating costs have increased by 11.8% (13.3% on a 
like-for-like basis).  £12.2m of the £36.7m increase in operating 
expenses was as a result of the non-repeat of government 
support received in FY21 and c.£10m of the increase was as a 
result of increased marketing expenditure, primarily on the Car 
Store re-brand.  Other inflationary cost increases, particularly 
in labour costs and utilities, which combined account for 
approximately 65% of the Group’s total cost base, were also 
impacted by a higher-than-expected impact of inflation during 
2022.  These increases have been partially mitigated by a 
continued focus on cost-saving initiatives.    
The division recorded an underlying operating profit of £69.1m 
(FY21: £87.4m) and a reported operating profit after non-
underlying items of £71.6m (FY21: £82.6m).

30
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
BUSINESS REVIEW
SOFTWARE (£m)
H1 2022
H2 2022
FY22
H1 2021
H2 2021
FY21
Change
(%)
Revenue
12.4
13.0
25.4
12.1
12.3
24.4
4.1%
Gross Profit
11.1
11.6
22.7
11.2
11.3
22.5
0.9%
Gross margin rate
89.5%
89.2%
89.4%
92.6%
91.9%
92.2%
-2.8%
Operating Expenses
(5.6)
(6.1)
(11.7)
(4.5)
(5.5)
(10.0)
17.0%
Operating Profit
5.5
5.5
11.0
6.7
5.8
12.5
-12.0%
Operating margin rate
44.4%
42.3%
43.3%
55.4%
47.2%
51.2%
-7.9%
Total Revenue Change
2.5%
5.7%
4.1%
A more detailed breakdown of the Pinewood financials for FY22 can be seen below:
SOFTWARE
Operating Review
•	  Approximately 90% of DMS revenues are recurring. 
•	  Strong international growth driven by expansion of the 
direct sales model and new market launches.
•	  Strong partnerships with strategic OEMs.
Strategy delivery – Grow and diversify Pinewood
As part of its Group strategy presentation, Pendragon 
announced its plan to ‘grow and diversify Pinewood’.  This 
included the key objectives of:
•	  Growing the international user base by 80% and the total 
user base by 10%; and,
•	 	Further 
product 
extension 
enabling 
turn-key 
digital 
automotive retail solutions.
In FY22 Pinewood continued to focus on both elements of the 
'grow and diversify' strategy.
•	 Grow: international growth accelerated in H2 FY22 with an 
expansion of the direct sales model in the Asia Pacific region 
and new market launches in Singapore and the Middle East. 
The UK and Ireland market returned to growth in H2 FY22 
with net user additions over the year.
•	 Diversify: development of the core DMS product continues. 
New products designed to support digital automotive 
retail are being developed to initially benefit Pendragon 
and, in the longer term, the external customer base. These 
developments included further releases in the Sales+ module, 
functionality to allow real time modification of the customer 
F&I offer and the integration of open banking to improve 
payment options. Pinewood launched a valuation tool in H2 
FY22 to help power Car Store’s web capabilities and the 
overall valuation and pricing platform for Pendragon used 
cars. In FY23, Pinewood will continue to be a key enabler in 
the further functionality development of vehicle acquisition, 
management and pricing platforms.    In order to facilitate 
this development the investment in new functionality of 
the DMS platform saw development capital rise to  £5.7m 
(FY21: £5.0m), with c.80% of these development costs being 
capitalised.  In addition to the development of the DMS, 
investments have also been made in platform architecture 
and security with greatly expanded use of the Microsoft 
Azure platform. 
Operating Review
Pinewood is a software business that provides Software as 
a Service (“SaaS”) in the UK and in a number of countries 
worldwide.  
The UK Dealer Management Systems (DMS) market for 
Franchised Motor Dealers is estimated to be worth over £100 
million in the UK. Three DMS providers dominate the UK market, 
of which Pinewood is one.  The global DMS market which is 
highly fragmented, is estimated to be worth approximately 
(£m)
Contribution 
from 
Pendragon
Contribution 
from external 
customers
Pinewood PLC 
standalone 
result
Share of 
Pendragon 
Group 
overheads
Pinewood 
segment as 
reported in 
Pendragon 
Group 
accouts
Revenue
6.3
19.1
25.4
-
25.4
Gross Profit
5.6
17.1
22.7
-
22.7
Operating Expenses
(2.1)
(9.3)
(11.4)
(0.3)
(11.7)
Operating Profit
3.5
7.8
11.3
(0.3)
11.0

31
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
£2.5bn, with over 50 different DMS providers within Europe 
alone.
Pinewood’s 
unique 
approach 
to 
the 
DMS 
market 
is 
characterised by:
•	  a single product capable of global deployment, which 
simplifies future developments to the system and reduces 
operating costs;
•	 a feature-rich cloud-based solution, with no need for costly 
third-party add-ons; 
•	 focus on strong manufacturer partnerships and supporting 
dealer profitability; and
•	 commitment to using the latest technology to reshape 
motor retail. 
Pinewood was an early adopter of the SaaS business model 
and has focused on developing recurring revenue streams. 
Around 90% of Pinewood’s DMS revenues are on a recurring 
basis. Whilst Pendragon remains an important customer to 
Pinewood, as Pinewood has grown, Pendragon’s proportion 
of the Pinewood total user base has been diluted to c.17% with 
intra-group charging maintained at a competitive market rate.
During FY22, overall net user numbers increased by 4% to 
c.31,700 with the expansion delivered primarily in H2 FY22. 
Across Pinewood’s international markets there was a 13% net 
increase in user numbers to a record high of c.6,400 users. 
All international markets grew user numbers in FY22 with 
Pinewood benefiting from both the expansion of existing 
customers and new sales. Growth was further supported 
by successful launches in Singapore and the Middle Eastern 
market.  Pinewood systems now operate in a total of 19 
different countries.
In the UK and Ireland market (excluding Pendragon) there was 
an increase in user numbers in FY22 to c.20,000. At H1 FY22 
user numbers had declined slightly, this trend was reversed 
in the second half of the year. In H2 FY22 the number of new 
system implementations accelerated, and churn fell from the 
elevated rates seen during FY21. The full benefit of these user 
additions will be seen on an annualised basis in the FY23 result.
Pinewood’s growth benefits not just from sales to new 
customers but also from the expansion of its existing customer 
base. In FY22 external net user churn was less than 1% and 
in international markets (excluding UK and Ireland) it was 
negative, as the rate at which existing customers grew users 
more than offset user reductions.
There has also been good further progress in terms of OEM 
support at an international level. Pinewood continues to build 
a strong partnership with Volkswagen AG and Porsche, which 
has enabled constructive dialogue and, in some cases, initial 
user implementations with large international dealer groups in 
both the European and the Asia Pacific market.
Financial Review
Total revenues increased by 4.1% to £25.4m compared to 
FY21. International DMS recurring revenues increased by 27%, 
reflecting the underlying user growth and expansion of the 
direct sales model in the European and Asia Pacific markets
UK and Ireland DMS recurring revenues fell slightly in the 
period, driven by the annualised impact of two exceptional 
customer exits at the end of the prior year and reduced user 
numbers in H1 FY22. User growth returned by the end of FY22 
leaving Pinewood well placed for growth in its home market 
heading into FY23.  
In addition to recurring revenues, there was a 9% increase 
in external DMS transactional charges, system training and 
implementation revenues. This was driven by an increase in 
system implementations in the UK and Ireland in H2 FY22.
Gross profit increased by 0.9% to £22.7m. There was a 
reduction in gross margins driven by the expanded use of the 
Microsoft Azure platform. This transition is a one-off event, 
and the related cost increase will not recur in future periods.
Operating costs increased by £1.7m or 17.0% compared to 
FY21. In FY22 the amortisation charge of £4.2m (FY21: £3.7m) 
made up over a third of operating costs. Alongside rising 
personnel costs, the higher amortisation charge drove the 
operating cost increase, both reflecting increased investment 
in the development of the DMS platform and Pinewood’s 
operational capabilities. Further cost increases arose from 
higher travel expenditure following the reduction in Covid-19 
restrictions, as well as higher energy costs.
As a result of these movements, underlying operating profit 
was £11.0m, a reduction of 12% compared to FY21.

32
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
LEASING
Operating Review 
Pendragon Vehicle Management ("PVM"), a vehicle leasing 
business, offers a complete range of fleet leasing and contract 
hire solutions. Its customers represent all business sectors with 
varied fleet sizes. The fleet of vehicles is financed through third 
party asset funders which results in a high return on capital.
The overall decrease in revenue compared to FY21 was due 
to a reduction in the exceptionally high level of disposals of 
de-fleeted vehicles in H1 2022.  However, increased demand 
for used vehicles due to continued supply shortages of new 
vehicles resulted in higher residual values being achieved 
on disposal, which led to the increase in gross profit. Total 
revenue in H2 2022 was 0.2% lower than H2 2021.
PVM's fleet continues to experience a rapid change in the 
powertrains demanded by customers in the corporate car 
sector as employers improve their green footprint whilst 
providing their associates with low CO2 vehicles. This, coupled 
with manufacturer supply constraints, has resulted in new 
vehicle delivery lead times increasing significantly compared 
to lead times prior to the pandemic. PVM has a strong order 
bank, with over 2,100 customer vehicles on order as at the 
end of December, which will support growth in the fleet when 
supply constraints ease.
Financial Review
Revenue decreased by 6.9%, due to the slightly reduced 
turnover on disposals.  Gross profit increased by 10.9% due 
to the strong residual values as described above.  Operating 
expenses were in line with last year at £4.5m and operating 
profit increased by 13.7% to £19.9m (FY21: £17.5m).
LEASING (£m)
H1 2022
H2 2022
FY22
H1 2021
H2 2021
FY21
Change
(%)
Revenue
42.9
40.8
83.7
49.0
40.9
89.9
-6.9%
Gross Profit
12.5
11.9
24.4
10.5
11.5
22.0
10.9%
Gross margin rate
29.1%
29.2%
29.2%
21.4%
28.1%
24.5%
4.7%
Operating Expenses
(2.3)
(2.2)
(4.5)
(2.4)
(2.1)
(4.5)
-
Operating Profit
10.2
9.7
19.9
8.1
9.4
17.5
13.7%
Operating margin rate
23.8%
23.8%
23.8%
16.5%
23.0%
19.5%
4.3%
Revenue Change
(12.4%)
(0.2%)
(6.9%)
BUSINESS REVIEW

33
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
FINANCIAL REVIEW
£m
2022
2021
Change
(%)
Interest payable on bank borrowings, senior note and loan notes
10.1 
9.1 
11.0%
Vehicle stocking plan interest
14.7
9.8 
50.0%
Net lease interest
13.6 
 11.7
16.2%
Unwinding of discounts in contract hire residual values
 2.5
 2.7
-7.4%
Total Underlying Net Financing Costs
 40.9 
 33.3
22.8%
UNDERLYING NET FINANCING COSTS
Underlying net financing costs increased by £7.6m to £40.9m. 
Interest payable on bank borrowings increased from £9.1m 
to £10.1m, largely driven by increases in the base interest 
rate. The increase in vehicle stocking plan interest from 
£9.8m to £14.7m was driven by a combination of higher bank 
base rates and higher average values per unit in used cars. 
The net lease interest increased from £11.7m to £13.6m, 
principally due to the accounting impact of a lease regear 
with our largest property partner in which 30 prime leaseholds 
were extended until 2042 with the Group benefitting from 
reductions in rent payable from the agreement to hand-
back 12 vacant properties to the landlord in exchange for 
the lease extensions.  The transaction has resulted in an 
increase in the net lease liability and consequently the net 
interest charge has risen by £3.0m year on year (though this 
has been offset by a reduction in the depreciation charge 
on these properties of £2.7m due to the amortisation period 
being extended).  This increase in the lease interest has been 
partially offset by a reduction in the lease interest charge as 
a result of lease terminations made in the previous year and 
the natural wind down of lease liabilities as they are paid off. 
  

34
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
CAPITAL ALLOCATION AND DIVIDEND
Adjusted Net Debt* has improved by £26.4m from an adjusted 
net debt of £49.7m at 31 December 2021 to adjusted net debt 
of £23.3m at 31 December 2022.   The adjusted net debt to 
underlying EBITDA ratio* was 0.1x for the rolling 12 months 
to FY22.  The adjusted net debt to underlying EBITDA ratio 
has moved from 0.3x at FY 2021, principally as a result of the 
strong trading performance in the year, combined with the 
disposal proceeds from the sale of property received.  
Whilst the Group is not proposing a final dividend for 2022, 
following the successful reduction of debt in line with the 
Group’s stated strategy, the Board is reviewing its capital 
allocation priorities including the potential for return of capital 
to shareholders either through dividend or share buybacks in 
due course.
* These are Alternative Performance Measures (APMs), see 
page 122 for more detail. 
£m
H1 2022
H2 2022
2022
2021
Impairment of goodwill
(3.6) 
-
(3.6) 
-
Impairment of property, plant and equipment 
(1.0) 
-
(1.0) 
-
Impairment of right of use assets
(0.2) 
-
(0.2) 
(9.6)
Termination and severance costs
 (0.2) 
- 
 (0.2) 
 (1.8) 
Aborted transaction related expenses
- 
(0.4) 
 (0.4)
-
Gains on the sale of businesses and property, plant and equipment 
 7.2 
0.7
 7.9 
2.7
Pension costs
 (0.2) 
 (0.1) 
 (0.3) 
 (1.0) 
Loss on refinancing
 (2.6) 
-
 (2.6) 
- 
Total non-underlying items before tax
 (0.6) 
 0.2
 (0.4) 
 (9.7) 
Non-underlying items in tax
 0.5 
0.9 
 1.4 
2.2 
Total non-underlying items after tax
 (0.1) 
 1.1 
1.0
 (7.5) 
NON-UNDERLYING ITEMS
Non-underlying income and expenses are items that are not 
incurred in the normal course of business and are sufficiently 
significant and/or irregular to impact the underlying trends in 
the business.  During the year the Group has recognised a net 
charge of £0.4m of pre-tax non-underlying items compared to 
a charge of £9.7m in 2021.  
An impairment of goodwill charge of £3.6m relates to the 
impairment of acquisition goodwill on the disposal of the truck 
brand, DAF, as a part of a sale to a specialist truck operator.   
During the year, approaches and subsequent bids were made 
by two separate external parties to purchase the Company. 
As a consequence, aborted transaction costs in respect of 
professional and advisory fees of £0.4m were incurred, , in the 
management of these processes.
Gains of £7.9m on the sale of business and property, plant 
and equipment mainly arise from the disposal of certain UK 
freehold properties.  
Pension costs of £0.3m represent the interest charge on 
pension scheme obligations (FY21: £1.0m).
Refinancing costs of £2.6m relate to the costs of the 2022 
Group refinancing exercise, and principally comprised of early 
repayment charges on the previous private placement loan 
notes.
FINANCIAL REVIEW

35
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
RECONCILIATION TO CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT (£m)
2022
2021
Net Cash From Operating Activities
76.1
63.2
Net capital (expenditure) / income
(27.1)
14.0
Receipt of lease receivables 
2.0
2.2
Net cash (outflow) / inflow from investing activities
(25.1)
16.2
Financing cash flows as included above
Payment of lease liabilities
(22.2)
(27.2)
Payment to Employee Benefit Trust (EBT)
(0.4)
-
Financing cash flows not included above relating to loans
Repayment of loans
(90.5)
(88.8)
Proceeds from issue of loans (net of directly attributable transaction costs)
93.8
18.7
Net cash outflow from financing activities
(19.3)
(97.3)
SUMMARY CASHFLOW AND ADJUSTED NET DEBT (£m)
2022
2021
Underlying Operating Profit
98.5
116.3
Depreciation and Amortisation
33.5
36.1
Share Based Payments
3.3
2.9
Non-underlying Items
(0.4)
(1.8)
Contribution into defined benefit pension scheme
(13.1)
(12.8)
Working Capital and Contract Hire Vehicle Movements1
(5.1)
(41.2)
Cash Generated from Operations
116.7
99.5
Capital Expenditure
(43.7)
(17.7)
Business and Property Disposals 
16.6
31.7
Net Capital (Expenditure) / Income2
(27.1)
14.0
Tax Paid
(1.4)
(7.1)
Interest Paid excluding lease interest3
(22.9)
(17.5)
Lease Payments & Receipts4
(33.9)
(36.7)
Non-underlying finance cost
(2.6)
-
Other
(2.4)
(1.5)
Decrease in Adjusted Net Debt
26.4
50.7
Opening Adjusted Net Debt
(49.7)
(100.4)
Closing Adjusted Net Debt
(23.3)
(49.7)
1 being the change in trade and other receivables, change in trade and other payables, change in stocking loans and movement in contract hire vehicle balances. 2 be-
ing the proceeds from sale of businesses, purchase of property, plant, equipment and intangible assets and proceeds from sale of property, plant, equipment and in-
tangible assets.3 being bank and stocking interest paid.  4 being receipts of lease receivables and payment of lease liabilities including lease interest paid and received.
CASH FLOW 
The following table summarises the cash flows and adjusted net debt of the Group for the twelve-month periods ended 31 
December 2022 and 31 December 2021 as follows:

36
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Cash generated from operations was an inflow of £116.7m 
compared to an inflow of £99.5m in 2021.  Although underlying 
operating profit decreased from £116.3m in 2021 to £98.5m in 
2022, the working capital cash outflow of £5.1m was lower 
than the 2021 working capital cash outflow of £41.2m, resulting 
in an increase in cash generated from operations. The working 
capital outflow of £5.1m was driven primarily by the non-
funded element of the increase in used inventory. 
The net capital expenditure of £27.1m (2021: inflow of £14.0m) 
comprised capital expenditure of £43.7m partially offset by 
business and property disposals of £16.6m.  Capital expenditure 
of £43.7m (2021: £17.7m) increased year on year, driven by 
investments into improved dealership facilities at a number 
of brands including BMW, Mercedes, Porsche and Jaguar 
Land Rover as well as investment into our new Car Store 
developments in Warrington and Chesterfield, together with 
increased investment into Pinewood’s software development. 
Business and property disposals were principally driven by 
disposal of the DAF trucks dealerships for £2.9m and the 
disposal of a vacant property in St Albans for £10.5m. 
Lease payments and receipts reduced by £2.8m to £33.9m, 
with the decrease primarily resulting from a reduction in the 
number of leasehold properties as a result of the full-year 
impact of previously announced lease exits and a further 
benefit resulting from the impact of a lease regear as explained 
previously on page 33 and which delivered a c.£2.0m cash 
benefit in rent and rate savings in 2022 and will deliver a saving 
in excess of £3.5m on a full-year basis.  This was partially offset 
by the impact of inflationary rent increases.
Non underlying finance costs of £2.6m are the cash costs 
of the 2022 Group refinancing exercise, and are principally 
comprised of early repayment charges on the previous private 
placement loan notes.
FINANCIAL REVIEW
BALANCE SHEET (£m)
2022
2021
Property
233.7
217.6
Plant & Equipment
26.8
24.2
Goodwill 
144.6
150.3
Intangible Assets
12.4
11.1
Right of Use Assets - property
130.5
126.5
Contract hire vehicle assets
124.9
131.2
Inventories
620.3
512.8
Receivables1
132.9
118.9
Net Assets Held for Sale2
6.1
10.4
Net Tax Balances4
14.9
26.6
Total Assets
1,447.1
1,329.6
Payables3
(810.7)
(689.1)
Lease Liabilities
(217.9)
(222.1)
Contract hire vehicle Liabilities
(111.6)
(119.5)
Retirement Benefit Obligations
(2.6)
(23.6)
Adjusted Net Debt5
(23.3)
(49.7)
Total Liabilities
(1,166.1)
(1,104.0)
Shareholders’ Funds
281.0
225.6
1 being trade and other receivables and finance lease receivables 2 being assets classified as held for sale and liabilities directly associated with assets held for sale 
3 being trade and other payables less contract hire liabilities 4 being deferred tax assets, current tax assets and current tax payable 
5 being cash and cash equivailents and interest bearing loans and borrowings
BALANCE SHEET SUMMARY 
The following table summarises the balance sheet of the Group at 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2021.

37
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Net assets have increased from £225.6m at 31 December 2021 
to £281.0m at 31 December 2022.  
At 31 December 2022, the Group had £233.7m (£364.2m 
including IFRS16 right of use assets) of land and property assets 
(31 December 2021: £217.6m (£344.1m including IFRS16 right 
of use assets)).  The increase in property principally reflects 
capital investments in a number of dealership improvement 
programmes in both OEM and Car Store locations as explained 
with the cash flow statement, partially offset by disposal of 
excess property, together with depreciation. 
Stock has increased by £107.5m to £620.3m (31 December 
2021: £512.8m), which is a result of an increase of c.£44m in 
the level of new car inventory held at 31 December 2021 prior 
to delivery, and an increase of c.£63m in used car inventory. 
The increase in used car inventory is driven by a combination 
of an increase in the number of cars in stock (c.£22m) and 
an increase in average value of cars in stock (c.£41m).  New 
car inventory remains significantly below historic records as a 
result of the ongoing supply shortages, with new car inventory 
approximately £170m lower than as at 31 December 2020. 
The increase in payables of £121.6m to £810.7m (31 December 
2021: £689.1m) principally relates to the higher vehicle creditors 
as a result of the increase in new and used vehicle inventory. 
The net liability for defined benefit pension scheme obligations 
has improved from a £23.6m liability at FY21 to a £2.6m 
liability at FY22.  The improvement of £21.0m comprises of 
contributions of £13.1m, a net interest expense recognised in 
the income statement of £0.3m and a net actuarial gain of 
£8.2m. The net actuarial gain has arisen due in part to changes 
in the principal assumptions used in the valuation of the 
scheme’s assets and liabilities and also the change in value of 
the assets held over the year. The Group contributed £13.1m 
to the Pension Scheme in the period in line with the Group’s 
funding commitment.
The triennial valuation of the company’s pension scheme as at 
31 December 2021 was completed during 2022.  The valuation 
concluded that the actuarial funding deficit had reduced from 
£117m as at 31 December 2018 to £33m as at 31 December 2021. 
The company and trustees agreed to continue the current 
level of contributions into the pension scheme (FY22: £13.1m) 
until the end of 2023, at which point the actuarial deficit is 
expected to be met.  Following this, the company and trustees 
agreed to move towards a long-term funding target and 
continue contributions at a reduced level of contribution of 
£3.5m p.a. until 31 December 2026, at which point the scheme 
is expected to be fully funded on a long-term funding target 
basis.
REVOLVING CREDIT FACILITY (RCF)
In March 2022 the Group refinanced its £175m RCF and £60m 
Private Placement, both of which were due to mature in March 
2023. The new facilities comprise a 5-year, amortising, £100m 
Term Loan, maturing March 2027, with the Group’s existing 
Private Placement lender plus a new lender, and a £75m 3+1+1 
RCF with the Group’s existing bankers, maturing March 2025, 
with extensions available at the election of lenders to March 
2026 and then March 2027.  

38
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
RISK OVERVIEW AND MANAGEMENT
PRINCIPAL RISKS 
Recognising that all businesses entail elements of risk, the 
Board maintains a policy of continuous identification and 
review of risks which may cause our actual future Group 
results to differ materially from expected results. The Board 
continues to carry out robust assessments of the Group’s 
emerging and principal risks in relation to its strategy and 
overall business objectives. The table on pages 40 to 48 is 
an overview of the principal risks faced by the Group, with 
corresponding controls and mitigating factors. A key is 
included to explain the relationship between each principal 
risk and the Group’s three strategic pillars. The specific risks 
are not intended to represent an exhaustive list of all potential 
risks and uncertainties. Thorough risk reviews, involving 
company-wide participation, have been completed in 2022 
by the Risk Control Group. There were no new risks identified 
as a result, though a number of risk impact and mitigation 
disclosures have been updated as a result, including:
•	
Risk relating to Technology and Information Systems, and 
Information and Cyber Security has increased, driven by 
the threat and sophistication levels of cyber incidents such 
as ransomware increasing exponentially globally. During 
2022 a number of mitigation activities were implemented, 
including 
technology 
investments, 
policy 
updates, 
associate training, and most recently, the onboarding of a 
security operations centre to further enhance and develop 
our ability to monitor for, and track cyber security threats 
to our business. A ransomware event occurred during the 
year and controls in place at the time of the incident, as 
well as the response of the security team and specialists 
through cyber insurance helped contain the incident. 
A full review has recently been completed involving 
third-party specialists and further control improvement 
opportunities will be considered as part of the ongoing 
security improvement plan for 2023
•	
Risk relating to Macro-economic, Political & Environmental 
has increased, driven by UK and Global events including 
the war in Ukraine resulting in volatility in inflation and 
interest rates and a UK cost of living crisis. The threat of 
longer-term impact of higher interest rates on consumer 
purchasing habits is reflected in our risk description. 
Financial business plans consider how these external 
factors may affect areas of our business, including 
customer spending on big ticket items as well as our 
operating costs. The impact of reduced supply since 
the Covid-19 pandemic has resulted in a large amount 
of pent-up demand in the market, which together with 
changes in consumer transport habits may underpin the 
market despite lower consumer disposable income
•	
Risk relating to Manufacturer Relationships includes 
the potential impact of emerging Chinese and Asian 
manufacturer brands producing high quality BEV products 
in direct competition to our traditional OEM partners 
products. The overall risk trend is not considered to have 
increased due to risk mitigation, such as the distribution 
agreement we have recently agreed with BYD, as well as 
the likelihood of the overall marketplace becoming more 
competitive both in terms of product offering and market 
price positions   
•	
Risk relating to Environmental includes the potential 
impact of electricity costs reducing customer demand 
causing used BEV values to fall, impacting negatively the 
overall cost of ownership. We monitor and track all used 
vehicle values and sales rates frequently to limit our risk 
and exposure to any fall in used BEV values  
The risk factors outlined below should be considered in 
conjunction with the Group’s system for managing risk, 
described below and in the Corporate Governance Report on 
page 65.

39
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
RI
SK
 M
ON
IT
O
RI
N
G 
A
N
D 
O
N
GO
IN
G 
A
S
SE
SS
M
E
N
T
RI
SK
 
ID
EN
TI
FI
C
A
TI
O
N
RI
S
K 
MI
TI
G
AT
IO
N
P
LA
N
NI
N
G
C
O
NT
RO
L 
AC
TI
O
NS
IM
P
L
E
M
EN
T
RI
SK
 
A
SS
E
S
S
M
E
NT
S
T
R
A
T
E
G
Y
 
A
N
D
 
B
U
S
I
N
E
S
S
 
O
B
J
E
C
T
I
V
E
S
STRATEGIC RISKS
FINANCIAL RISKS
OPERATIONAL RISKS
COMPLIANCE RISKS
BOARD
LEADERS & 
BUSINESS AREAS
RISK MANAGEMENT AND INTERNAL CONTROLS
Accountability 
The Board is responsible for risk management and internal 
control within the context of achieving the Group’s objectives. 
The system of control the Board has established covers both 
the Group’s financial reporting and the mitigation of business 
and operational risks. The system is designed to manage, 
rather than eliminate, the risk of failure to achieve business 
objectives, and can provide only reasonable and not absolute 
assurance against material misstatement or loss.
Financial Reporting 
The executive directors oversee the preparation of the Group’s 
annual corporate plan; the Board reviews and approves it and 
monitors actual performance against it on a monthly basis. 
Where appropriate, during the year, revised forecasts are 
prepared and presented for Board review and approval. To 
ensure that information to be consolidated into the Group’s 
financial statements is in compliance with relevant accounting 
policies, internal reporting data is comprehensively reviewed. 
Reviews of the appropriateness of Group accounting policies 
take place at least twice a year, under the scrutiny of the Audit 
Committee, which considers reports on this from the Group’s 
Auditor, the application of IFRS and the reliability of the 
Group’s system of control of financial information. Controls 
are designed to ensure that the Group’s financial reporting 
presents a true and fair reflection of the Group’s financial 
position. 
Operational and Other Risks
Operational management is charged by the Board with 
responsibility for identifying and evaluating risks faced by the 
Group’s businesses on a day-to-day basis and is supported 
by the Risk Control Group (RCG), a Committee formed of 
the chief operating officer, chief finance officer, company 
secretary, group head of internal audit and, by invitation, 
other members of the Group’s senior operational and financial 
management. We maintain on-line risk registers to facilitate 
an efficient and effective method for update of, review of, 
and consolidated reporting across our risk profile. Risks are 
reviewed as a top down and bottom up activity at the Group, 
Division and functional level. The content of the risk registers 
is considered and discussed regularly through discussion 
with senior management and review within our governance 
committees. The approach to risk control and the work of 
the RCG are described on page 65. The Group continues 
to follow the principles of the three lines assurance model 
and in addition to the responsibilities of management, the 
Group deploys specialist second line support and oversight 
for certain principal risks through dedicated teams including 
Finance & Insurance and Health & Safety. In addition, a well-
established Internal Audit function provides independent 
third line assurance, with priorities and associated resource 
requirements including any specialist external support being 
agreed at least annually with the Audit Committee. Any 
control issues identified by Internal Audit and second line 
teams, follow a strict protocol to ensure their effective and 
timely remediation. During 2022 Internal Audit has provided 
independent assurance over a number of key risk areas, 
including health, safety & environmental management, cyber 
security for the Pinewood entity, associate retention, and 
financial controls for the Finance Shared Services Centre. 

40
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Residual Risk Trend: 	
   Unchanged            Increasing            Decreasing
Link to Strategy:     Unlock value in UK Motor Division     Grow and diversify Pinewood     Disrupt UK used car sales
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
1
STRATEGY
Failure to adopt the right 
strategy, or
Failure of our adopted 
strategy to deliver the 
desired outcomes, or
Failure to implement our 
strategy effectively
Delay to strategic 
delivery and investment 
financial constraints
•	 We miss our profit growth and/
or debt management target, 
alienate key stakeholders and 
are unable to invest adequately 
in our business
•	 We do not meet our customers’ 
needs by not achieving a 
coherent, connected and 
engaging customer journey, 
leading to us to be less 
competitive and losing market 
share
•	 Our strategy is informed by significant research 
and market data
•	 We communicate effectively our adopted strategy 
to our stakeholders. Our strategic priorities were 
fully refreshed during 2021 and refined further in 
2022 and full details are included on pages 25 to 
31 of the Annual Report
•	 We invest appropriately in the technological, 
physical and human resources to deliver our 
strategy, closely monitor performance against 
our objectives, and adjust our actions to meet 
our strategic goals. Our Director of Strategy and 
Transformation, together with other dedicated 
resources, supports the delivery of our strategic 
initiatives and provides robust governance, 
including financial tracking 
•	 Our sophisticated management information 
identifies threats to the success of our strategy 
both during the planning and implementation 
phases, and informs mitigating actions, both 
directionally and operationally
•	 We ensure that we monitor our manufacturer and 
third party customer service measures and take 
action in the event of low scores
•	 We focus strongly on efficient use of working 
capital through embedded disciplines, especially 
in relation to vehicle inventory
•	 We review capital expenditure plans to ensure our 
ROI objectives are achievable
•	 Our business plan has been fully refreshed in 2022 
and has taken into account the latest economic 
predictions
RISK OVERVIEW AND MANAGEMENT

41
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
2
MANUFACTURER RELATIONSHIPS 
Dependence on vehicle 
manufacturers for the 
success of our business
Failure to maintain 
sustainable, mutually 
rewarding relationships 
with our manufacturers
•	 Failure of, or weaknesses in our vehicle 
manufacturers’ financial condition, 
reputation, marketing, production and 
distribution capabilities such as the shortage 
of semi-conductors along with the current 
Ukraine invasion limiting production of 
components, and other disruptions to the 
supply chain; or the effectiveness of the 
supply chain response to EU Trade Deal 
Rules of Origin; or a lack of alignment 
with manufacturers’ reduced new vehicle 
supply due to lack of components and 
manufacturing capability
•	 Failure to adapt to the impact of lower new 
vehicle registrations on future aftersales 
revenue streams within our business
•	 Failure to adapt to manufacturer reductions 
in sale distribution point numbers as 
volumes fall, either planned or by limits to 
production, along with the removal of some 
product lines due to their inability to build 
profitability
•	 Failure of our vehicle manufacturers to 
develop within required timelines to meet 
both regulatory and consumer requirements 
around BEV and hybrid emission vehicles
•	 Introduction of new Chinese manufacturers 
into Europe and UK providing competitively 
priced BEV products in direct competition 
to our traditional OEM partner products
•	 Failure to maintain good relations with 
our franchisors either through day to day 
activities or our strategic decisions impairs 
our ability to generate good quality earnings
•	 Failure to positively adapt to OEM 
consolidation such as the creation of multi 
brand operations and network rationalisation 
•	 Failure to positively adapt to changes 
manufacturers are introducing or may 
make to their business models, including 
the introduction of agency distribution 
models, ensuring agency agreements are 
not infringing any regulatory requirements, 
direct sales to customers, increased 
involvement in the used vehicle market, and 
other changes that may affect the traditional 
dealer franchise model
•	 Failure to positively adapt to changes in 
Competition regulation, for example via the 
outcome of the Aftersales block exemption 
review due in May 2023 which could change 
current protection impacting qualitative 
selective AR agreements, or agency 
introduction
•	 Our diverse franchise representation 
avoids over reliance on any single 
manufacturer
•	 Our close contact with our vehicle 
manufacturers seeks to ensure 
our respective goals and strategic 
decisions are communicated, 
understood and aligned, to deliver 
mutually acceptable performance
•	 To compensate lower volumes, 
margins increased with greater 
demand than availability
•	 Our appropriately targeted 
investment in franchise assets and our 
performance maintains our reputation 
as a quality representative for our 
brand manufacturers
•	 Seeking multi brand representation 
through single sites to mitigate lower 
aftersales opportunities from lower 
new vehicle volumes, and greater new 
volume throughput per store
•	 Build relationships with new OEM 
partners repurposing current 
locations, offering dual representation 
whilst the used and aftersales market 
builds 
•	 Our investment in marketing 
initiatives and our online presence 
supplement and enhance our market 
presence and offering over and above 
manufacturers’ marketing efforts
•	 Our diverse franchise representation 
ensures new vehicle inventory is 
supplied from a wide variety of 
sources
•	 Our model of developing and 
maintaining revenues from used 
vehicles, aftersales, and our software 
and leasing segments reduces our 
overall reliance on new vehicle 
franchises
•	 Our ongoing innovation and 
investment in customer choice as to 
how they wish to purchase a vehicle 
makes us an attractive partner to 
OEMs
•	 Our close contact with our vehicle 
manufacturers ensures we are able 
to identify potential supply issues 
and collaborate to limit any impact 
on our customers and our business 
performance

42
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
3
COMPETITION
Failure to meet 
competitive challenges 
to our business model or 
sector
•	 Customers migrate to 
alternative providers
•	 Intermediary companies 
establish a barrier between us 
and our customers
•	 New forms of competition 
would have less barriers to 
competitors entering the 
market
•	 Revenues and profits could 
decrease owing to competitor 
action
•	 Consolidation of existing 
competitors could provide 
economies of scale, product 
range and customer reach that 
makes our customer offer less 
competitive  
•	 The market could become 
more fragmented as on-line, 
click and collect, home delivery 
and subscription models 
become more attractive ways 
of purchasing to customers 
•	 Emerging distributors activities 
affect our ability to secure 
sufficient used inventory 
•	 New OEM brands entering the 
market with advanced BEV 
technology
•	 Our detailed market and sector monitoring 
systems assist early identification and effective 
response to any competitive or intermediary 
threats
•	 Our scale, expertise and technological capabilities 
enable rapid and flexible response to market 
opportunities
•	 Technical equipment costs and OEM connectivity 
solutions for aftermarket repairs are likely to limit 
the number of intermediary repairers creating 
greater retention levels
•	 Reducing dependency on intermediary companies 
within the new vehicle space, by further investing 
within our own website capability providing 
visibility of all new vehicle unsold physical and 
pipeline inventory
•	 Agency models reduce the risk of new vehicle 
supply leaking out to intermediaries giving greater 
protection to the brand distributor 
•	 Consolidating OEMs, along with the ability to 
multiband key market facilities, help to represent 
more brands through one rooftop, providing 
greater sales and aftermarket volumes
•	 Emerging specialism, such as battery repair 
factories within densely represented market 
regions create future aftermarket opportunities for 
national distributors such as ourselves who have 
the ability to adapt facilities and invest 
•	 Our well-developed customer relationship 
management capabilities and ongoing innovation 
and investment in our online platforms, customer 
offer and fulfilment tools aim to drive industry-
leading service and attract customer loyalty
•	 We continually seek to develop new methods 
of customer interaction, particularly online. This 
enables the business to anticipate changing 
customer needs
•	 Expanding relationships with new emerging 
brands, along with stronger OEM relationships 
allow for greater market area representation and 
coverage for sales and aftersales 
RISK OVERVIEW AND MANAGEMENT

43
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
4
ENVIRONMENTAL
Progression towards 
greener technologies, 
autonomous driving, 
and/or pay-per-use, 
rather than owning a 
vehicle
UK taxes change to 
penalise road use, fuel 
type, vehicle use and to 
increase VAT
Failure to adapt to 
the changes arising 
as a result of the 
Government’s future ban 
on sale of petrol, diesel 
and hybrid powered 
vehicles 
OEMs restricting 
distribution of certain 
vehicle models in the UK 
in response to emission 
targets
Failure to recognise 
and minimise the 
environmental impact of 
our business activities
•	 Customers choose greener 
vehicles we cannot supply
•	 Overall vehicle parc reduces
•	 Increases in electricity costs 
reduces customer demand 
causing used BEV values to fall, 
impacting negatively the overall 
cost of ownership
•	 Vehicle purchase and use 
declines, adversely affecting 
revenue opportunities
•	 Lower demand for petrol, 
diesel and hybrid vehicles and 
potential impact on vehicle 
residual values
•	 Government policy and 
consumer sentiment in respect 
of petrol, diesel and/or hybrid 
vehicles impacts the sale of one 
or all types of these vehicles
•	 Reductions in sales volumes 
or margins due to loss of 
certain product lines and future 
aftersales opportunities
•	 Investment cost to adapt to a 
broad range of BEV products 
by 2030 and PHEV and MHEV 
by 2035 is not adequately 
considered
•	 We represent vehicle brands which are responding 
effectively to the greener technology agenda and 
latest Government timescales
•	 Our represented OEM partners have the ability to 
grow within the light commercial vehicle sector 
offering a blend of hybrid and full electric BEV 
options to satisfy the growing demand of home 
and business delivery 
•	 We identify trends in demand through our 
sophisticated management information and 
analysis tools and tailor our model accordingly
•	 We monitor sales and demand of all vehicles 
by fuel type whilst using our sophisticated 
management information and analysis tools 
ensuring our inventory matches consumer 
demand, and can target supply by territory market 
depending on set emission rules
•	 Our breadth of relationships with asset finance 
companies and geographic footprint help us to 
provide innovative mobility solutions for private 
and business vehicle users, whatever their needs. 
These provisions can be delivered through our 
national footprint locations, or via online platforms
•	 We maintain the right level of tax expertise to 
interpret and assess proposed changes, respond 
with well-informed advice and effectively assist 
our strategic planning and the design and 
implementation of appropriate mitigating actions
•	 The Group’s Environment Policy has recently 
been refreshed, in order to provide further 
specific oversight and direction as to the impact 
of the Company’s activities on climate change, 
nature loss, solid waste (including single use 
plastics) and resource availability.   We continue 
to develop, enhance and monitor our operational 
standards, ensuring that environmental priorities 
are accounted for appropriately in planning and 
decision making, and where possible, the impact 
of our activities on the environment is reduced or 
minimised
•	 We carefully monitor the future product offerings 
of our current and future OEM partners, along 
with emerging brands, ensuring we maintain and 
grow partnerships with those producing relevant 
product meeting consumer demands 

44
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
5
REGULATORY AND COMPLIANCE
Failure to comply 
with legal and other 
requirements and 
respond to changes 
which could have a 
material effect on our 
business model, for 
example, such as our 
ability to provide Finance 
& Insurance products to 
our customers, or adverse 
changes in trade tariffs
Failure to respond to 
changes in legislation, 
in particular in relation 
to environmental, 
employment, and 
governance, which could 
lead to shareholder 
and other stakeholder 
dissatisfaction
•	 This could lead to fines, 
criminal penalties, litigation 
and an adverse impact on our 
reputation, financial results, 
and/or our ability to do 
business
•	 We may be restricted from 
continuing certain business 
activities, such as those 
regulated by the FCA
•	 Resources are diverted to 
address urgent remediation, as 
well as taking proceedings or 
defending legal or regulatory 
action
•	 The ability to obtain 
appropriate inventory is 
impeded and/or purchase costs 
rise
•	 We maintain appropriate expertise to interpret, 
assess and respond to proposed changes in 
regulation, enabling us to adapt our model and 
processes to comply with changes in a seamless 
manner
•	 Our culture focuses strongly on good compliance, 
with emphasis on doing the right thing and 
delivering good performance
•	 We operate a Finance & Insurance Services 
Regulatory Board with a supporting governance 
framework and continue to review and invest in 
systems and processes to minimise the risk of 
non-compliance to FCA regulations
•	 Our team of compliance specialists design, and we 
communicate effectively, processes that support 
our businesses to minimise the risk of non-
compliance across a range of areas
•	 In the case of new vehicles, our diverse 
representation mitigates the risk and for parts 
we maintain alternative sources of supply where 
possible
•	 In September 2021 we implemented a committee 
to provide strategic direction and oversight 
to our Environmental, Social and Governance 
agendas. The work of the committee will be 
informed by our self-assessment of ESG practices, 
which has been completed using an independent 
benchmarking tool. Further information can be 
found at page 51 within our ESG Report
6
TECHNOLOGY AND INFORMATION SYSTEMS
Failure of our IT 
infrastructure or key 
systems, including failure 
to maintain and build 
performance, capacity 
and resilience 
Failure to invest in 
new technologies and 
maintain a cohesive 
and comprehensive 
technological capability
•	 This could lead to an inability 
to operate and communicate 
effectively, loss of information 
and competitive advantage 
and potential regulator action 
resulting in fines and penalties
•	 We adopt and regularly update robust disaster 
recovery measures, including within our dealer 
management systems
•	 We operate a Pendragon Group IT function, 
reporting to the Chief Information Officer, to 
set strategy for technology including cloud-
based systems and processes.  Disaster recovery 
capability and systems availability is in place for 
all core systems
•	 Central control of all Microsoft endpoints is in 
place. A centralised management process for 
mobile devices is being rolled out
RISK OVERVIEW AND MANAGEMENT

45
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
7
INFORMATION AND CYBER SECURITY
Failure to meet our 
business objectives due 
to an inability to protect 
our customers, personnel 
and our assets from 
security threats and 
vulnerabilities associated 
with our business 
activities
•	 This could lead to an inability 
to operate and communicate 
effectively, loss of 
information and competitive 
advantage and potential 
regulator action resulting in 
fines and penalties
•	 The Chief Information Officer has reviewed our 
cyber security measures through an independent 
third party
•	 An Information Security Improvement Plan is in-
flight, which includes identifying opportunities for 
continual improvement
•	 The Information Security Steering Committee 
oversees change and operational activities relating 
to information security. Various improvements have 
been delivered over the last year, including annual 
security training for all staff, improved asset visibility 
and management, onboarding a Security Operations 
Centre to provide centralised monitoring and 
enhanced incident response capabilities, increased 
authentication requirements and reduced technical 
debt, and improved security configurations through 
migration to cloud hosting. Further improvements 
are planned for this year, reviewing approaches to 
privileged access management, ongoing security 
testing to help identify weaknesses across our 
estate, and process improvements
•	 Our Pinewood business monitors cyber security 
threats and has systems and processes in place 
to deal with incidents relating to the services 
they provide. This is demonstrated through their 
continued ISO27001 certification
•	 We have cyber liability insurance in place, that 
includes Cyber Incident Response Centre, providing 
access to expertise to assist during a crisis
8
DATA SECURITY AND DATA PRIVACY
Failure to comply with 
legal or regulatory 
requirements relating 
to data security or data 
privacy in the course of 
our business activities
•	 This could lead to data 
loss or misuse and have a 
significant effect on our 
reputation. Fines and criminal 
penalties could be imposed 
and disruption to business 
operations and our ability to 
serve customers. Financial 
results could be adversely 
affected
•	 We regularly review our data protection policies, 
controls, Associate training and the use of third 
party systems
•	 Our Information Technology teams monitor cyber 
security threats and have systems and processes in 
place to deal with incidents, and we have recently 
established a Security Operations Centre to further 
enhance and develop our ability to monitor for, and 
track cyber security threats to our business
•	 We have cyber liability insurance in place
•	 The Chief Information Officer has reviewed our 
cyber security measures through an independent 
third party. An Information Security Improvement 
Plan is in-flight, supported by an external advisor 
engaged to provide oversight and direction to 
remediation activities
•	 The Information Security Steering Committee has 
been operational since March 2020 to oversee 
change and operational activities relating to 
information security
•	 A Data Protection Governance Forum is in place to 
govern GDPR risk management activities

46
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
9
RELIANCE ON ESTIMATES
Failure to maintain 
reliable systems and 
methods for provision of 
financial estimates
•	 Group’s financial statements 
will be wrong, affecting 
vehicle values where we 
have committed to purchase 
at a pre-set price, and the 
discounted cashflows used to 
test impairment of goodwill, 
expected profit or loss on sale 
of our inventory items with 
particular risk from fluctuating 
used vehicle prices and the 
retirement benefit obligation
•	 Reputational damage and 
inability to raise funding for the 
Group’s business
•	 Revenue and profits all suffer 
damage
•	 We assess actual outturns of previous estimates 
to test the robustness of adopted assumptions, 
and adjust the estimating approach accordingly
•	 We support estimates with reliable external 
research where available
10
PEOPLE
Failure to attract, 
motivate, develop and 
retain the required 
capability and promote 
an appropriate culture 
to deliver our business & 
people strategy
•	 This could lead to an inability 
to deliver our business strategy 
and achieve our focused 
results. 
•	 We could lose market share 
and adversely affect our 
customers owing to poor 
service
•	 Loss of key personnel 
and skilled workers (e.g. 
technicians) would impact 
operational performance, and 
relationships with key brand 
partners and suppliers
•	 Colleague engagement 
deteriorates due to difficulties 
experienced directly or 
indirectly by the wellbeing of 
the workforce
•	 An unprecedented rise in 
salaries could increase our 
fixed costs to a level that 
is unsustainable for the 
organisation to compete
•	 We have a Chief People Officer who is responsible 
for delivering a people strategy 
•	 The HR Transformation Steering Group is 
responsible for overseeing change and all 
operational activities relating to associates 
•	 We are investing in strategic workforce planning 
in order to be ahead of the competition with 
regards to future skills needed
•	 We focus on clear learner journeys and career 
paths to ensure we have the right skills in the 
organisation
•	 We invest in online means of attraction and 
recruitment, targeting the right quality candidates
•	 We continually review our  performance 
management framework, to ensure it remains 
effective and is linked to competencies and career 
pathways
•	 We continually review and adapt for the market 
conditions our employment terms, salaries and 
performance related pay elements at all levels
•	 We adopt and renew responsive succession plans 
for all key roles. Within our Motor Division we 
complete a Talent Review twice yearly
•	 We regularly review our policies, controls & 
associate training. We leverage our scale to afford 
training opportunities and progression within the 
Group
•	 We continuously improve our cultural purpose 
and behaviours to recognise and engage our 
associates beyond monetary reward
RISK OVERVIEW AND MANAGEMENT

47
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
11
MACRO-ECONOMIC AND POLITICAL
European economic 
instability and/or UK or 
Global economic and 
business conditions 
deteriorate
UK Governmental spending 
constraints
Longer term impact of 
higher interest rates on 
consumer purchasing 
habits, and on the cost 
of servicing debt. Higher 
inflation has resulted in a 
current ‘cost of living’ crisis 
which has the potential to 
reduce consumer spending 
on big-ticket items
Longer term 
unemployment resulting in 
lower consumer spending, 
in particular on big-ticket 
items  
•	 Fewer purchasers of vehicles
•	 Spend on luxury purchases 
reduces due to higher interest 
rates, unemployment and job 
insecurity
•	 Vehicle manufacturers 
oversupply into UK market or 
alterations to supply terms, 
damages margins and vehicle 
values
•	 Lower demand for vehicle 
servicing
•	 Our business model derives revenues from 
every stage of the vehicle’s life-cycle and has 
expanded into the older vehicle parc for both 
vehicle sales and aftersales
•	 We carefully control new vehicle inventory 
to mitigate effects of overstocking and work 
closely with our OEM partners, accessing 
support through initiatives such as extended 
stocking finance 
•	 We have right-sized our cost base, completed 
a dealership network review and closed 
loss-making operations, and we continue to 
pursue opportunities to ensure our business 
processes are highly efficient
•	 We invest in and vigorously pursue customer 
retention initiatives to secure longer term 
loyalty
•	 The impact of reduced supply since the 
Covid-19 pandemic in 2020 has resulted in 
a large amount of pent-up demand in the 
market, which together with changes in 
consumer transport habits may underpin the 
market despite lower consumer disposable 
income
12
FINANCE & TREASURY
Lack of availability of debt 
funding
Increasing Pension 
liabilities arising from our 
defined benefit scheme
•	 As set out in more detail in note 
4.2 the Group has an amortising 
Senior Term Facilities Agreement 
of £97m maturing in March 2027, 
and a Revolving Credit Facility 
of £75m maturing in March 2025, 
with extensions at the option of 
the lenders to March 2026 and 
then to March 2027.  Without 
the requisite facilities the Group 
would be unable to meet debt 
obligations
•	 Changes in the strength of the 
employer covenant, discount 
rates, inflation, asset values, 
Pension trustees’ investment 
strategies or mortality 
assumptions could lead to a 
materially higher deficit than our 
current recovery plan is designed 
to fund, and a direct impact on 
valuation, implied credit rating 
and potential additional funding 
requirements at subsequent 
triennial reviews
•	 Our business model produces strong free cash 
flow generation
•	 We maintain adequate committed facilities to 
meet forecast debt funding requirements and 
have recently agreed new facilities to mature 
between March 2025 and March 2027
•	 Diversification of funding sources, monitor 
daily our funding requirements
•	 The Defined Benefit Scheme was closed to 
new entrants in 2000 and for future service 
accrual in 2006
•	 Regular review by our pension trustees of 
investment strategy and liability reduction 
and risk mitigation, taking professional advice, 
including triennial valuations
•	 Deficit funding recovery plan in place

48
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NO.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
IMPACT BEFORE MITIGATION
MITIGATION
13
HEALTH, SAFETY & ENVIRONMENTAL
Failure to provide safe 
working and retail 
environments 
Failure to keep up to date 
with, and put in place 
adequate procedures 
to comply with all HM 
Government laws, 
regulation and guidance 
at both Country and 
local/regional level 
Failure to control the 
environmental hazards 
present within our 
operations
Failure to keep up to 
date with Environmental 
Regulations
•	 This could lead to illness and 
injury, fatalities, lost working 
time, civil claims and clean-up 
costs
•	 Our reputation could be 
adversely affected and 
regulatory action could result in 
prohibition, fines and criminal 
penalties and closure of 
businesses
•	 This could lead to sanctions 
from the Environmental 
Agency in respect of harmful 
substance emissions/ escape 
into the atmosphere, which 
may adversely affect the 
efficiency of our Body Centres 
and SMART repair throughput 
and excessive charging as “End 
User Packaging” levy
•	 We work to the Health & Safety Executive’s ‘Plan, 
Do, Check, Act’ framework for managing risk in 
the workplace
•	 We allocate clear responsibilities for delivery of 
safe places to work and shop
•	 In consultation with the business and where 
appropriate, external specialists we adopt 
process-driven initiatives to mitigate specific risk 
areas
•	 We are well prepared with robust provision for 
safe-working under socially distanced conditions, 
with enhanced hygiene protocols and rapid 
response to localised issue.  Safety remains 
our number one priority and is monitored by a 
centrally coordinated team. Plans are in place 
should the situation escalate again
•	 We measure and review our performance against 
appropriate benchmarks
•	 We allocate local accountability for sites’ 
compliance and provide specialist support to 
responsible leaders
•	 We monitor site conditions and drive corrective 
action through audit follow-up
•	 We operate independent routes for the reporting 
of any concerns (whistle blowing) and have 
a standard procedure for investigation and 
escalation of matters of concern
RISK OVERVIEW AND MANAGEMENT

49
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
VIABILITY STATEMENT
VIABILITY STATEMENT 
In accordance with provision 31 of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code, published by the Financial Reporting 
Council in July 2018 (the ‘Code’), taking into account the 
company’s current position and principal risks, the Directors 
have assessed the viability and prospects of the company 
over the three-year period to 31 December 2025.
The Group normally expects to have in place facilities of three 
years and therefore this remains the appropriate time-frame to 
assess viability.  The three-year review considers the Group’s 
profit and loss, cash flows, debt and other key financial ratios 
over the period.   These metrics are subject to a severe but 
plausible downside scenario which involves flexing several 
of the main assumptions underlying the forecast, including a 
severe downturn to vehicle volumes and margins based on 
externally sourced forecasts and restricted new car supply 
due to manufacturing constraints.  In this scenario, capital 
expenditure has been reduced to run-rate expenditure and 
committed projects.
Based on the results of this analysis, the Directors have a 
reasonable expectation that the company will be able to 
continue in operation, comply with facility covenants and meet 
its liabilities as they fall due over the three-year period of their 
assessment.  The Directors are mindful of the potential impact 
of a macro-economic downturn, a market correction in used 
pricing and shortfalls in both new and used car supply resulting 
from shortages in microchips impacting manufacturing and 
any further risk of disruption to supply chains that the ongoing 
conflict in Ukraine presents, but after assessing the risks do 
not believe there to be a material risk to going concern.  
In addition, further discussion of the principal risks affecting 
Pendragon PLC can be found within the Annual Report and 
Accounts on pages 38 to 48.  The risk disclosures section of 
the consolidated financial statements set out the principal 
risks the Group is exposed to, including strategic, operational, 
economic, market, environmental, credit, technological, 
regulatory and team member resource.  
The Board considers risks during the year on a triannual 
basis through the Risk Control Group and annually at a Board 
meeting with ad hoc reporting as required.
The principal risks and the mitigation steps that the Board 
considered as part of this viability statement were as follows:
•	 	The availability of debt funding, in particular, the successful 
refinancing of both the private placement and revolving 
credit facility, when the revolving credit facility matures in 
March 2025.  The Board intend to seek the right external 
advice to ensure the most appropriate debt funding sources 
are identified as part of any refinancing process.  It is possible 
that the terms of any refinancing may be less favourable for 
the Group than the current facility.
•	 	The ability to adapt to changing environments outside 
our direct control such as macro-economic, political and 
environmental factors, regulation changes, manufacturer 
and competitor behaviour. The Board has specifically 
reviewed the potential impacts and available mitigating 
actions as a result of a downside trading scenario.  We 
mitigate these risks through the diverse revenue generation 
from all parts of the vehicle cycle and wide range of franchise 
representation together with regular monitoring to identify 
changes quickly.
During 2022, the Board carried out a robust assessment of the 
principal risks facing the Group, including those that would 
threaten its business model, future performance, solvency 
or liquidity.  The Directors believe that the Group is able to 
manage its business risks successfully, having taken into 
account the current economic outlook and the results of the 
severe but plausible downside scenario for the three-year 
viability period. Accordingly, the Board believes that, taking 
into account the Group’s current position, and subject to the 
principal risks faced by the business, the Group will be able to 
continue in operation and to meet its liabilities as they fall due 
for the period up to 31 December 2025.
Approved by order of the Board
Mark Willis
Chief Finance Officer
22 March 2023

50
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
51	
Environmental, Social and Governance Report
52    Environmental Report
60    Social Report
63    Corporate Governance Report
66	
Board of Directors
68	
Audit Committee Report
74	
Nomination Committee Report
76     Remuneration Committee Report
77	
Directors’ Remuneration Report
96	
Directors’ Report
DIRECTORS’ REPORTS

51
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
ENVIRONMENTAL, SOCIAL AND GOVERNANCE
In 2021, the Group re-evaluated its responsibilities to our 
customers, investors, associates, suppliers and the public in 
terms of how our activities as a retailer impact the natural 
environment, how we treat people such as our employees, 
customers and those in the communities in which we operate 
and how we control and govern the operation of our Company.
The changes we made meant that we were well placed in 2022 
in terms of our environmental, social and governance (“ESG”) 
objectives, in terms of:- 
•	 monitoring where the Group is today and what has changed 
year on year in terms of our ESG standards and measures;
•	 where the Group aspires to be in the future, in terms of 
future targets and plans to improve our ESG reporting and 
the efficacy of the measures we implement;
•	 how the Group aims to achieve our targets, with 
appropriately defined milestones achievable over the 
medium to long term, against which we can monitor our 
progress, and what action we intend to take where we 
identify our progress has been behind target.
It remains clear that the context in which businesses, including 
our own, now operate is being both informed and transformed 
by climate change, nature loss, social unrest around inclusion 
and working conditions and changing expectations as to 
the role of corporations, such as the part businesses are 
expected to play regarding equality and access to economic 
opportunities.  
Despite the progress made in 2021 and last year, we still 
recognise that in some areas of ESG implementation, we remain 
at the beginning of our journey of continuous improvement. 
However, we have now embedded ESG initiatives into our 
strategic objectives and remuneration incentives, which we 
believe will further enhance and drive progress. 
ENVIRONMENTAL REPORT
The Group continues to operate to a formal Environment 
Policy, pursuant to which our responsibility to protect the 
environment and minimise the environmental impact of our 
activities is explicitly recognised.  In partnership with our 
associates, manufacturers, customers and suppliers, the 
Company aims to operate to high standards of environmental 
protection appropriate to its business activities. The Group’s 
Environment Policy includes specific oversight and direction 
from the Board of directors as to the impact of the Company’s 
activities on climate change, nature loss, solid waste (including 
single use plastics) and resource availability.   We continue to 
develop, enhance and monitor our operational standards, such 
that that environmental priorities are considered in planning 
and decision making, and where possible, the impact of our 
activities on the environment is reduced or minimised.
In accordance with Listing Rule 9.8.6R(8), we have set out 
in the TCFD overview table beginning on page 52 below 
certain climate-related financial disclosures aligned to the four 
recommendations and the eleven recommended disclosures 
contained within the TCFD additional guidance (Implementing 
the Recommendations of the Task Force on Climate Related 
Financial Disclosures (2021 TCFD Annex)).
Within the TCFD overview table, we have also included 
disclosures by each of the recommended disclosures, 
identifying whether we consider such disclosures to be 
either consistent with the recommendations of the TCFD or, 
where disclosures have only been partially made or omitted 
a further description of any steps taken or planned to ensure 
our disclosures are consistent in the future, including relevant 
timeframes.
In particular, of the eleven TCFD recommended disclosures, 
the Company considers that it is consistent with one disclosure 
(under risk management c), partially consistent with one 
disclosure (under metrics and targets b) and has omitted 
disclosure under nine disclosures, as more specifically set out 
in the TCFD Overview table on pages 52 to 55.
Of the omitted disclosures, further work is underway to 
enhance the identification, impact and reporting for climate-
related risks and opportunities, and how these map over the 
short, medium and long term. Scoping work over the next 
12-18 months will provide further clarity and understanding 
as to what is required, having not been able to achieve the 
necessary disclosures at this stage due to our current resource 
base.
Furthermore, although we have now incorporated a carbon 
reduction metric into the performance conditions for our long-
term incentive plan, we recognise that we still have more to 
do in terms of implementing the rest of the 2021 TCFD Annex.

52
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
TCFD OVERVIEW                                Disclosure Level:     Full     Partial     Omitted 
Recommen-
dation
Recommended 
disclosures
Summary of Progress/ Measures planned to ensure 
future consistency with the recommendation
Reference
Disclosure 
Level
GOVERNANCE
Disclose the 
organisation’s 
governance 
around 
climate-
related 
risks and 
opportunities
a) Describe the 
Board’s oversight 
of climate 
related risks and 
opportunities
The Board is responsible for our climate ambition, 
embodied in the Group’s Environment Policy which is 
reviewed annually. We have also embedded a specific 
carbon reduction target metric into our long term 
incentive plan performance conditions, to further 
incentivise and drive progress. 
It is the Company’s intention to further revise the 
Environment Policy within the next 12 months, ensuring 
that a specific focus on climate-related issues becomes 
fully embedded in the Policy. Consideration of climate-
related issues will also become a standing agenda 
item of the Board in the context of the consideration 
of our strategy, including how climate-related 
issues potentially impact our strategy and financial 
performance, together with the monthly submission 
to the Board of our most recent and available metrics 
appertaining to environmental matters.
Annual Report 
Environmental, 
social and 
governance 
report page 51
b) Describe 
management’s 
role in assessing 
and managing 
climate-related 
risks and 
opportunities
The Group’s ESG working group, consisting of 
members of senior management from across the 
Group, including the CFO, CPO, CMO and GGC, 
together with the Risk Control Group (RCG) exercises 
day to day oversight of climate risks. 
The ESG will meet at least quarterly in order to review 
and assess the Company’s progress and management 
of climate related risks. Further to the enhancement of 
the Board’s oversight and ability to consider climate 
related risk described above, within the next 12 months, 
changes will be made to the terms of reference of the 
Company’s Audit Committee in order to formalise 
and strengthen its ability to review and challenge 
environment and climate related reporting, including 
a direct line of oversight of the ESG working group: in 
turn, the ESG will provide reports as to its progress to 
the Audit Committee.
Annual Report 
Environmental, 
social and 
governance 
report page 51
ENVIRONMENTAL REPORT

53
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
TCFD OVERVIEW                                Disclosure Level:     Full     Partial     Omitted 
Recommen-
dation
Recommended 
disclosures
Summary of Progress/ Measures planned to ensure 
future consistency with the recommendation
Reference
Disclosure 
Level
STRATEGY
Disclose the 
actual and 
potential 
impacts of 
climate-
related 
risks and 
opportunities 
on the 
organisation’s 
businesses, 
strategy and 
financial 
planning 
where such 
information is 
material
a) Describe 
the climate-
related risks and 
opportunities 
the organisation 
has identified 
over the short, 
medium and long 
term
The actual and potential impacts climate change 
can make on our business, strategy and financial 
planning are outlined further below.  However, in 
outline, HM Government’s decision to ban the sale of 
all new petrol and diesel vehicles by 2030 presents a 
significant opportunity for the business to harness the 
move to PHEV and BHEV vehicles, initially in the new 
market but, increasingly in the used vehicle market 
as consumers move to these products. Initiatives to 
reduce our impact on the environment are detailed 
further below.  
The Group will continue to monitor climate related 
risks and opportunities to ensure that the Group is 
resilient and well prepared to face any emerging issues; 
we engage regularly with both OEMs and consumers 
to facilitate this, although recognising that as our 
relationship with key OEMs is as a franchisee, our 
ability to influence OEMs is limited.
Annual 
Report Risk 
Management, 
page 43
Environmental, 
social and 
governance 
report page 51
b) Describe the 
impact of climate 
related risks and 
opportunities 
on the 
organisation’s 
businesses, 
strategy and 
financial planning
The Group’s strategy includes harnessing the potential 
of the move to BEV and PEV vehicles, both in sales 
and aftersales.  As outlined above, we will be well 
positioned and prepared for when the sale of new 
petrol and diesel vehicles is no longer permitted in 
2030. Although we consider the move to BEV and 
PEV vehicles the most significant climate related 
opportunity, the ESG, together with the RCG plans to 
undertake a further detailed review of other specific 
climate related risks and opportunities facing the group 
over the next three years.
Annual Report
Risk 
Management, 
page 43
Environmental, 
social and 
governance 
report page 51
c) Describe the 
resilience of the 
organisation’s 
strategy, 
taking into 
consideration 
different climate 
related scenarios, 
including a 2oC 
or lower scenario
We recognise that there is more work to be done in 
this area; the ESG working group will consider this 
further as part of its mandate, and, together with 
the RCG, will commission a resilience review of the 
organisation’s strategy, taking into consideration 
climate related scenarios over the next three years.

54
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
TCFD OVERVIEW                                Disclosure Level:     Full     Partial     Omitted 
Recommen-
dation
Recommended 
disclosures
Summary of Progress/ Measures planned to ensure 
future consistency with the recommendation
Reference
Disclosure 
Level
RISK MANAGEMENT
Disclose 
how the 
organisation 
identifies, 
assesses and 
manages 
climate 
related risks
a) Describe the 
organisation’s 
processes for 
identifying and 
assessing climate-
related risks
Environmental is included as a principal risk as 
part of our risk management overview processes. 
Climate change has been considered as part of the 
environmental risk and is not considered to be a 
standalone principal risk. The ESG working group will 
continue to review, assess and consider any climate 
related risks which may impact upon our operations, 
and report to the RCG, and, ultimately the Audit 
Committee and Board where necessary. 
In addition, within the next 12 months, the Company 
will further revise the Environment Policy, ensuring 
that a specific focus on climate-related issues becomes 
fully embedded in the Policy. Consideration of climate-
related issues will also become a standing agenda 
item of the Board in the context of the consideration 
of our strategy, including how climate-related 
issues potentially impact our strategy and financial 
performance, together with the monthly submission 
to the Board of our most recent and available metrics 
appertaining to environmental matters.
Annual Report 
Risk 
Management, 
page 43
b) Describe the 
organisation’s 
processes for 
managing climate 
related risks.
All areas of the business are subject to regular risk 
identification, assessment and review. As part of our 
annual insurance renewal processes, we continue to 
note sites that are at risk of localised flooding so we can 
react accordingly. 
Further to the enhancement of the Board’s oversight 
and ability to consider climate related risk described 
above, within the next 12 months, changes will be made 
to the terms of reference of the Company’s Audit 
Committee in order to formalise and strengthen its 
ability to review and challenge environment and climate 
related reporting, including a direct line of oversight of 
the ESG working group: in turn, the ESG will provide 
reports as to its progress to the Audit Committee.
c) Describe 
how processes 
for identifying, 
assessing and 
managing climate 
related risks are 
integrated into 
the organisation’s 
overall risk 
management
Environmental is included as a principal risk as 
part of our risk management overview processes. 
Climate change has been considered as part of the 
environmental risk and is not considered to be a 
standalone principal risk. The ESG working group will 
continue to review, assess and consider any climate 
related risks which may impact upon our operations, 
and report to the RCG, and, ultimately, the Audit 
Committee and Board where necessary. 
The ESG receives sector specific information on 
environmental and climate related risks from its OEM 
partners and industry bodies, such as the SMMT. The 
ESG working group will continue to review, assess and 
consider any specific climate related risks which may 
impact upon our operations.
In addition, it is proposed that a specific sub-risk 
designed to identify, manage and assess climate 
related risks be developed and considered within the 
organisation’s risk management framework
Annual Report 
Risk 
Management, 
page 43
ENVIRONMENTAL REPORT

55
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
TCFD OVERVIEW                                Disclosure Level:     Full     Partial     Omitted 
Recommen-
dation
Recommended 
disclosures
Summary of Progress/ Measures planned to ensure 
future consistency with the recommendation
Reference
Disclosure 
Level
METRICS AND TARGETS
Disclose the 
metrics and 
targets used 
to assess 
and manage 
relevant 
climate-
relates risks 
and such 
opportunities 
where such 
information 
is material
a) Disclose the 
metrics used by 
the organisation 
to assess climate-
related risks and 
opportunities 
in line with its 
strategy and risk 
management 
process
Our assessment of climate related risks and 
opportunities is summarised below; as we have 
indicated, although we have a number of high level 
measures already in place, we are still at the beginning 
of our journey in terms of improving and enhancing our 
metrics and targets in relation to (i) climate change; (ii) 
land use and ecological sensitivity; (iii) solid waste and 
single use plastics and (iv) product diversification. 
We anticipate that both our metrics and targets will 
developed and enhanced further over the next 12 to 
24 months as our ability to collect and collate the 
necessary data becomes more sophisticated. In relation 
to climate change, it is now a performance metric of our 
long term incentive scheme to effect reductions in our 
CO2 emissions over successive three year performance 
periods.
Annual Report 
Environmental, 
social and 
governance 
report page 51
b) Disclose Scope 
1, Scope 2 and, 
if appropriate, 
Scope 3 
(greenhouse gas 
(GHG) emissions 
and the related 
risks
See disclosures at page 56 of this ESG Report. Other 
than emissions from emplpyee commuting, we do not 
currently disclose our total Scope 3 (other indirect 
emissions from extraction and production of purchased 
materials and fuels for which the Company does not 
own or control) as further clarity is required as to what 
is applicable for the Group, and how we capture the 
relevant dataset without imposing a disproportionate 
burden on the effective operation of our businesses.
In terms Scope 3 emissions, we propose to undertake 
further scoping work over the next 12-18 months to 
provide further clarity and understanding as to what is 
required and, more importantly, achievable within our 
current resource base.
Annual Report 
Environmental, 
social and 
governance 
report page 51
c) Describe the 
targets used by 
the organisation to 
manage climate-
related risks and 
opportunities 
and performance 
against targets 
Whilst we recognise that whilst we have now 
embedded a specific carbon reduction metric into our 
long term incentive plan performance conditions, we 
recognise that there is significantly more work to do to 
embed other more tangible targets into our process for 
managing climate related risk; we propose to consider 
and review potential targets to be used over the next 
12-18 months.
Annual Report 
Director’s 
Remuneration 
Report, page 
90
Environmental, 
social and 
governance 
report page 51

56
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Source
Tonnes of CO2e
01.01.22 – 31.12.22
01.01.21 – 31.12.21
Scope 1: Direct emissions from activ-
ities for which the company own or 
control – emissions generated by its in-
ternal fleet operations (Scope 1/tCO2e)
2,630
4,452
Scope 2: Indirect emissions from the 
use of purchased electricity and gas 
(Scope 2/ tCO2e)
12,169
14,129
Scope 3: emissions generated by em-
ployee commuting (Scope 3/ tCO2e)
6,548
7,967
TOTAL GROSS SCOPE 1, 2 & 3 
EMISSIONS:/ tCO2e
21,347
26,548
Energy consumption used to calculate 
above emissions:/kWh (Scope 2)
65,517,250
73,269,036
Scope 1, 2 & 3 Intensity Ratio (tonnes 
of CO2 per £m of revenue)
5.9
7.7
GLOBAL GREENHOUSE GAS EMISSIONS DATA
CLIMATE CHANGE: REDUCING CARBON AND WASTE
Recognising the goals of the Paris Agreement to limit global 
warming to well below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and 
pursue efforts to limit global warming to 1.5°C, it remains 
the Company’s objective to achieve annual reductions in the 
amount of CO2  we emit from our facilities and our driving 
activities. 
Our Target:
Our Progress:
Initiatives to ensure continued delivery:
Annual 
reductions 
(where 
possible) in 
the amount 
of CO2 
emitted 
from our 
facilities 
and driving 
activities.
We have reduced the 
tonnes of CO2 emitted 
from our facilities by 
1,960 tonnes year on 
year and the tonnage 
of CO2 emitted from 
driving activities by 
3,241 tonnes year on 
year.
•	 Increased and ongoing electrification or hybridisation of company car fleet, 
and selection of most energy efficient vehicles where possible;
•	 Continued reduction of carbon emissions from commuting activity through 
hybrid and remote working and technological solutions
•	 Setting shorter and measured routes for customer demonstrator vehicle usage 
to reduce emissions;
•	 Improving the energy efficiency of our facilities informed by the results 
of mandatory energy assessments of sites in accordance with the ESOS 
Regulations 2014;
•	 Installation of LED lighting, limit periods when full lighting is used at facilities 
out of hours, auto closure of external doors, installation of insulators to limit 
heat escape, installation of solar panel and solar energy systems on any new 
build developments 
•	 Introducing automatic shut-off valves to compressors and air tools to reduce 
energy usage and increase efficiency
Methodology: (i) Scope 1 and Scope 2 emissions have been reported where the Group has operational control of a property or an asset. This includes emissions from 
driving activities as detailed in note (ii). (ii) CO2 emitted from driving activity comprising of internal vehicle movements (scope 1) and employee commuting (scope 3) is 
the result of analysis of mileage, vehicle and employee commute data over defined three year periods (2019-21 for 2021 data and 2020-2022 for 2022 data) to quantify the 
total mileage and C02 emissions across internal operations (company cars, service loans, demonstrators, parts vans and employee commutes. Vehicle sales are outside 
the scope of the review. The mileage of vehicles was extracted from vehicle stock and sales information. A vehicle master list was provided from CAP HPI to provide 
carbon emissions data for each vehicle. Employee home and work postcode information was used to calculate commuting distances, with an average C02 emissions per 
mile (based on the UK average) used to calculate total emissions; (iii) Other than employee commuting, scope 3 emissions are currently not included, as we currently do 
not have the capability to capture the required additional dataset, and to do so at this stage would require a disproportionate use of resource. (iii) to our methodology to 
calculate greenhouse gas emissions is to use UK Government GHG Conversion Factors for Company Reporting, published by DEFRA on 20 September 2022
ENVIRONMENTAL REPORT

57
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
The Company again engaged Interpath Advisory, a specialist 
financial advisory business to review and quantify the carbon 
emissions generated by its internal fleet and Associates 
commuting to work for the periods 2019-2021 and 2020-
2022 Emissions have been quantified across various business 
dimensions, including division, make, model and usage 
profile in order to understand how our business activity in 
this area contributes to carbon emissions.  Overall, emissions 
for 2022 were 9,178 tonnes, of which 2,630 tonnes was from 
internal fleet operations and 6,548 tonnes from commuting, 
representing a 26.1% decrease on total 2021 emissions.
Over the period 2020 to 2022, emissions have declined by 
40% from 15,308 to 9,178 tonnes, due to a combination of 
structural changes in the business and improved efficiency in 
the vehicle fleet and reduction in mileage driven.  
C02 Emissions,
tonnes 2020 - 22
2022
2,630
6,548
9,178
2020
7,614
7,694
15,308
2021
4,452
7,967
12,419
Emissions from vehicles
Emissions from staff commuting

58
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
LAND USE AND ECOLOGICAL SENSITIVITY
The Group remains conscious as to the impact of its land 
use and dealership footprint on the environment, and, 
consequently, where new dealerships or developments are 
proposed, wherever possible, we continue to prioritise the 
development of brownfield sites or the repurposing of our 
existing estate accordingly.  For the majority of our new 
developments, active steps are taken in conjunction with the 
relevant local authority to prepare and agree a biodiversity 
plan suitable for the location being developed.  In addition, 
the majority of new developments are prepared and assessed 
in accordance with BREEAM ‘Very Good’ standards, as 
required by relevant local authority planning requirements. 
BREEAM ‘Very Good’ standards are intended to  assess the 
design, construction and intended use and future-proofing 
of new building developments, including the local, natural or 
manmade environment surrounding the building. 
Our Target:
Our Progress:
Initiatives to ensure continued delivery:
Prioritise the 
development of 
new dealerships or 
developments on 
brownfield sites or 
by repurposing the 
existing estate
Development of new sites at 
Chesterfield and Warrington 
completed in 2022 and achieved 
Grade B EPC ratings.  Developments 
at Glasgow and Motherwell, 
on brownfield sites ongoing.  
Completion of rebuild of BMW Hull 
achieved Grade B EPC rating. 
•	 In conjunction with the local authority, agreed 
biodiversity plans.
•	 As required by the local authority, assessment of new 
build sites in accordance with BREEAM ‘Very Good’ 
standards.
Our Target:
Our Progress:
Initiatives to ensure continued delivery:
Reduce use of single 
use plastics procured 
through the Group’s 
supply chain and 
increase tonnage of 
single use plastics 
recycled. 
We recycled 74.61 metric tonnes of 
single use plastic in 2022, compared 
to 65.73 metric tonnes of single use 
plastic in 2021.  We recognise this 
is only a marginal improvement and 
are reviewing initiatives to both de-
crease our single use plastics usage 
and increase our single use plastics 
recycling. 
•	 Consider the introduction of new procurement 
standards requiring Group suppliers to demonstrate 
initiatives/steps to reduce single use plastic
•	 Consider imposing requirements on suppliers to 
minimise packaging waste as part of new procurement 
standards
•	 Re-communication to businesses in terms of recycling 
expectations and ethos.
•	 Trialling an initiative in the north-east to increase our 
single use plastics recycling.
SOLID WASTE: SINGLE USE PLASTICS
Although we are not a manufacturer, the Group uses a 
significant volume of single use plastics through our supply 
chain, primarily in terms of aftersales parts.   In 2021, we 
successfully recycled 65.73 metric tonnes of single use 
plastics across all our businesses, and have improved on this 
in 2022 with 74.61 metric tonnes of single use plastic being 
recycled.   However, we estimate that this is only a proportion 
of the total single use plastic used across the Group, and we 
are now trialling an initiative in our dealerships located in the 
north east designed to increase our recycling of single use 
plastics.  If the pilot scheme in the north east is successful, 
we will implement it across the entire Group.  In addition, 
we are actively reviewing our procurement activities with a 
view to developing a set of procurement standards and best 
practice which will include, inter alia, renewing and refreshing 
the recycling expectations across all our businesses, as well as 
the review of supplier packaging to further target a reduction 
of single use plastics forming part of packaging or product 
supplied to us wherever possible.
ENVIRONMENTAL REPORT

59
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Our Target:
Our Progress:
Initiatives to ensure continued delivery:
Increase volume of 
units of electric and 
hybrid vehicles sold. 
Install 500 electric 
vehicle charging 
points by the end of 
2025.
Year on year, we have increased 
sales of new electric and hybrid 
vehicles by 46% and sales of used 
electric and hybrid vehicles by 54%
We have now installed 396 electric 
vehicle charging points across our 
dealership and property estate, 
making significant progress against 
our target of having 500 electric 
vehicle charging points in place by 
2025. 
•	 Close liaison with our OEM partners to promote 
diversification into electric vehicle sales;
•	 Target to install 500 electric vehicle charging points 
across our dealership and property estate by 2025.
PRODUCT DIVERSIFICATION
The UK Government has announced that by 2030, the sale 
of new petrol and diesel powered cars in the UK will end.  In 
line with this Government commitment, and acting primarily 
as a retailer in conjunction with our manufacturer/OEM 
partners, we are actively and consciously working to promote 
and further the sale of battery, electric and hybrid vehicles 
across our businesses.  Although we are pleased to report 
that interest in electric powered vehicles continues to rise 
across the Group, with sales of both PHEV and BHEV vehicles 
increasing year on year, we are also acutely conscious that 
there is still a long way to go before electric vehicles become 
the dominant choice of our customers.  
Notwithstanding our increased and continued efforts to 
diversify the range of products we retail,   including furthering 
the retail and promotion of new electric vehicles, we also 
recognise that as a standalone retailer of used vehicles, the 
retail of petrol and diesel used vehicles will continue for a 
number of years as these legacy vehicles continue to work 
through retail channels.  In time, we anticipate that the 
availability of used electric and hybrid vehicles will increase, as 
these become the pre-dominant, and eventually, only vehicles 
available in the new market, and technology continues to 
improve. 

60
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Number of Group Employees by category 
as at 31 December 2022
as at 31 December 2021
Female
Male
Total
Female
Male
Total
Director
1
6
7
1
7
8
Senior Manager
2
8
10
2
8
10
All employees
1,312
4,022
5,334
1,186
4,068
5,254
OUR PEOPLE
Our associates have a crucial role Driving Beyond the Possible 
and delivering against our strategy to create value.  We aim to 
be a responsible employer through all that we do, supporting 
our new value of ‘Do The Right Thing’.  The health, safety and 
wellbeing of our associates are primary considerations in the 
way we do business. We work to attract, develop and retain 
the best talent, equipped with the right skills for the future. 
As one of our key strategic priorities we are committed to 
advance our current position for our associates.  To support 
the business in achieving this, we have established a dedicated 
Social Dimension (SD) Working Group that reports directly to 
the company’s ESG senior oversight committee.  
The SD working group has undertaken a review of our current 
position and mapped the opportunities for improvement 
aligned to the business’ People strategies. This has led to the 
creation of a Social dimension action plan which prioritises 
areas of focus for 2023 and beyond.  We have  prioritised 
our ability to collect and access accurate and robust diversity 
data  to support our progress against the Social dimension 
framework. 
OUR INCLUSION
We believe that diversity, inclusion and equality of opportunity 
for all our associates, no matter who they are, to be essential 
to our future success. People are the heart of our business, 
and we remain committed to fostering a culture of unity 
that is representative of the societies in which we live. This 
year we have actively supported the development of three 
diversity and inclusion (D&I) associate networks: Pride-
dragon (LGBTQIA+), Gender and Faith and Culture networks. 
Developing associate networks sits at the heart of our D&I 
strategy, enabling the business to learn alongside our diverse 
associate communities and co-create a culture of inclusion. 
It is critical for us that we engage out associates in order to 
accelerate progress and in turn to create real, positive change.
We aim to ensure that our associates can bring their authentic 
selves to work and achieve their full potential and our D&I 
networks are core to this. 
Wellbeing is a key part of our People Strategy in 2022 we 
enabled a programme of activities to support our associates 
and their families, launching a series of financial and personal 
wellbeing initiatives. We encouraged and supported our 
people to recognise Time to Talk Day, National Stress 
Awareness Day, Men’s Health Week and World Menopause 
Awareness Day.
Throughout 
all 
our 
attraction, 
recruitment, 
selection, 
employment and internal promotion processes, all employment 
decisions are taken without reference to irrelevant or 
discriminatory criteria. The company’s diversity and equal 
opportunities policy is available at www.pendragonplc.com. 
As reported last year we continue to have a mandatory 
learning programme for the business to educate our people 
with regards to their responsibilities with in terms of diversity 
and Inclusion.  Since its introduction we have achieved 94% 
completion rate. 
We continue to make appointments at Board and immediately 
below Board level in accordance with a formal, rigorous and 
transparent procedure.  Appointments are based on merit and 
objective criteria, and within this context, we aim to promote 
diversity of gender, social and ethnic backgrounds, alongside 
cognitive and personal strengths in accordance with Principle 
J of the UK Corporate Governance Code (Code).  
GENDER BALANCE
We describe our approach to Board composition diversity in 
the Nomination Committee’s report on page 74. 
SOCIAL REPORT
GENDER PAY GAP REPORTING
The company’s annual report containing data on our gender 
pay gap will be published in full on our website www.
pendragonplc.com in accordance with the statutory timescale.
   
OUR REWARD
Looking after our associates is essential and we continuously 
review our benefits offering.  Our ambition is to offer an 
industry competitive total reward package that values our 
associates and enables us to be a responsible and attractive 
employer. 
This year we have partnered with Benefex to modernise 
the way we approach and provide our associates access to 
benefits. By bringing all associate benefits together under a 

61
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
single platform, we have simplified the pathway meaning 
our associates have improved visibility of their benefits and 
improved accessibility through the single platform. Pendragon 
continues to invest in pension scheme arrangements to support 
its associates, offering a choice of schemes allowing members 
to select the most appropriate for their circumstances.
OUR DEVELOPMENT
Training and development is tailored and targeted to roles 
or services as part of a blended learning offering integrating 
online learning with virtual and classroom training. Training 
is systematically planned and delivered to ensure Pendragon 
meets regulatory and statutory requirements and to ensure 
that both our associates and customers are not exposed to 
any risks. Individual and business development needs are 
identified in real time through performance check-ins and 
responded to as necessary.  Internally we have completed 
over 37,321, thousand hours for our associates, an average 
of 7.15 hours internal learning and development hours per 
associate. This is in n addition to  our collaborative working 
with our manufacturer partners to deliver product and vehicle 
training to a high standard and ensure robust knowledge and 
expertise on the vehicles we sell.  
OUR WORKPLACE
Engagement
During 2022 the business partnered with the Employee 
Engagement Survey Platform provider Peakon to create 
a systematic mechanism to enable our Associates’ voice. 
Associate engagement forms an essential element of our 
people strategy. Providing our Associates with a clear and 
open feedback mechanism to share their views and opinions 
regarding where and how the business is performing well, and 
where and how it could make improvements is core to our 
engagement journey.  We delivered our first survey in June 
and achieved 54% participation levels with 6.9 engagement 
score, improving on both these measures in our November 
survey achieving participation levels of 79% (+25pp) and an 
engagement score of 7.3 (+0.4). Through the Peakon tool we 
will regularly survey our associates and implement local and 
group level actions to celebrate what and where our associates 
tell us we are doing well but importantly to make responses to 
areas that they feel we could improve.
Communication & Hybrid Working
We work to meet the challenges presented by our size 
and nationwide diverse geography through a continuous 
improvement approach, taking opportunities to innovate 
through our internal communications to ensure we reach all 
our associates We  now have an embedded formal hybrid 
working policy across the Group, applicable where job role 
allows, providing our associates with a more flexible and 
considered approach to how and where they perform their 
work, where possible.  This policy has supported our ability 
to attract and retain talent particularly in relation to specialist 
roles within the Group.  We consider that the hybrid working 
model has significantly changed associate perceptions of the 
Company as an employer, as well as increasing productivity 
and efficiency.  
Internal website messaging and electronic newsletters, 
together with social media content, are deployed to keep 
our associates up-to-date with the Company’s strategy and 
performance.  At all levels, communications aim particularly 
to recognise the achievements of individual associates and 
celebrate outstanding personal and business performance, 
through peer recognition.  Each year we review our incentive 
and recognition programmes aligned to the Group’s business 
objectives.

62
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Health and Safety
We take seriously our responsibility to our associates, 
customers and the public. We aim to ensure that all associates 
in the course of their roles, and all who work in or visit our 
facilities or receive our services, so far as is reasonably 
practicable, experience an environment and practices which 
are safe and without risk to their health.   Our policy is to 
identify and assess all potential risks and hazards presented 
by our activities and to provide systems and procedures which 
allow all associates in their daily work to take responsible 
decisions in relation to their own and others’ health and safety. 
We publish a clear hierarchy of responsibility to associates 
and reinforce this through regular monitoring by a variety of 
means.  We promote awareness of potential risks and hazards 
and the implementation of corresponding preventative 
or remedial actions through our on-line health and safety 
systems, operations manuals and regular communications on 
topical issues.  Our health and safety management system 
provides our UK leadership and associates with detailed 
access to information, guidance and control measures. 
Accidents at Work
Historically, we have assessed our health and safety record 
against relevant published benchmarks.   In 2019, as a 
result of changes to the Health & Safety Executive sector 
categorisations, we determined that the natural sector 
comparator for our Group is Wholesale and Retail Trade and 
Repair of Motor Vehicles and Motorcycles.   There has been 
a decrease in RIDDOR1 reported accidents in 2022 dropping 
to 18 (34 per 10,000 employees) from 22 (43 per 10,000 
employees) in 2021. This figure is also significantly lower than 
the pre Covid 2019 figure of 26. We continue to target specific 
hazards and risks for improved results through additional 
monitoring and promotion of safe working processes.   The 
company’s health and safety policy is available at www.
pendragonplc.com .
OUR INFLUENCE, OUR COMMUNITIES
Our strategy considers the impact of the company’s operations 
on the community and our wider societal responsibilities. 
We are predominantly a retail operator, with a tangible 
presence in the many communities our businesses serve. 
We continue to support national charitable campaigns such 
as BBC’s Children in Need appeal and the Save the Children 
Christmas Jumper Day. 
We continue the Car Store partnership with Battersea 
dogs and cats.  Through our Battersea dogs and cats home 
partnership our associates are trained by experts to ensure 
we provide the right and best support for our canine loving 
customers, and through some of our fundraising activities we 
look to support the charity to do their amazing work.  
Over the past year, Pendragon associates have participated 
in community activities giving time, money and knowledge to 
organisations, people and causes both locally and nationally. 
We are proud that our associates are positive active members 
of their local communities.  They work to support both local 
and national initiatives that as a Group means we are able to 
make a widespread contribution to our local areas, for example 
by our associates and businesses organising charity events 
to support schools, hospitals, children and adult grassroots 
sports and local foodbanks.   The company encourages these 
activities and we welcome the opportunities they present to 
engage with the communities our associates live and work in 
and recognition of charitable causes with whom our associates 
and their families have connections  
OUR SOURCING
All our Group’s sites are situated within the UK and at each 
of them we operate in strict compliance with all applicable 
employment laws.  We have no presence, either directly or 
via sub-contractors, in any areas which present any risk of 
the exploitation of men, women or children in the workplace. 
We work with vehicle manufacturers and other suppliers who 
manage their supply chains in a responsible way, free from the 
exploitation of labour. We have adopted an Anti-Slavery and 
Human Trafficking Policy, available to view on our website, 
together with our Anti-Slavery and Human Trafficking 
Statement for the year ended 31 December 2022, and survey 
our key suppliers on a frequent basis to ensure continued 
adherence to our policy.  
SOCIAL REPORT
1 RIDDOR: the Reporting of Injuries, Diseases and Dangerous Occurences Regulations 2013

63
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
The UK Corporate Governance Code (Code) applies to the 
Company and is available on the FRC website at https://www.
frc.org.uk.  Other than where expressly stated, throughout 
the financial year ended 31 December 2022, the Company 
complied in full with the applicable provisions of the Code.  The 
corporate governance statement as required by Disclosure 
and Transparency Rule 7.2.1 is set out below.
OUR BOARD 
The Board sets our Company’s strategy and ensures we 
have in place the financial and human resources to meet our 
objectives.  We take collective responsibility for Pendragon’s 
long term success.  The executive directors, led by the chief 
executive officer, are responsible for running the Company and 
our Group through the executive committee comprising of the 
executive directors and members of senior management to 
effect that strategy, including the environmental, social and 
governance impacts of the same, and work within prescribed 
delegated authority, such as capital expenditure limits.  The 
executives direct and monitor business performance through 
regular operational meetings with their respective leadership 
teams and set and regularly review the effectiveness of key 
operating controls, reporting to the Board on these and 
any variances.  The Board as a whole reviews management 
performance.
Although the Board delegates to the chief executive and chief 
finance officer responsibility for briefing key stakeholders, 
major shareholders and the investor community, the non-
executive chairman holds himself available to engage with 
shareholders, together with the Senior Independent Director, 
where appropriate.  Information from engagement with 
shareholders is shared with the entire Board and taken into 
account in financial planning and strategy.
The Board has three committees: Audit, Nomination and 
Remuneration, each made up entirely of non-executive 
directors. The Risk Control Group (RCG) is a committee of the 
executive directors, the company secretary and Group head of 
internal audit.  Other members from the senior management of 
the Group’s operating group functions are co-opted onto the 
RCG as required from time to time.  Each committee operates 
within delegated authority and terms of reference, set by 
the Board, reviewed annually and available to view on the 
company’s website.  Details of each committee’s work appear 
on the next few pages of this Report.  Executive Directors can 
attend Board committees at times, to assist their business, but 
only with the committee’s prior agreement.
LEADERSHIP AND BOARD COMPOSITION
As at 22nd March 2023, the Board comprises three executive 
directors and four non-executive directors, including the non-
executive chairman.  The respective responsibilities of the 
Board, the non-executive chairman and the chief executive 
are clearly defined by the Board in formal responsibilities 
documents, which the Board reviewed and readopted in 
August 2022.  The  roles of chief executive officer and non-
executive chairman are fully segregated.  The Board remains 
committed to the progressive refreshing of our membership, 
so as to maintain the right balance of skills, experience, 
independence and knowledge of the Company to enable us to 
continue to operate effectively.  
As noted below, in accordance with the Code, all Directors will 
be subject to annual re-election at the Annual General Meeting 
of the company.  Details of the Directors offering themselves 
for election in 2023, together with directors’ brief biographical 
details appear on pages 65 to 67, and gender balance details 
are on page 60.  
NON-COMPLIANCE WITH THE CODE
Until January 2023, the chief operating officer received a 
salary supplement in lieu of a pension contribution which does 
not currently align with the pension contribution available 
to the wider workforce, and was therefore not compliant 
with provision 38 of the Code.  However, the chief operating 
officer’s salary supplement in lieu of pension contribution has 
now been reduced accordingly such that it is now aligned to 
the pension contribution available to the wider workforce; 
compliance with provision 38 of the Code has now been 
achieved.  
The Board is actively seeking to recruit an additional non-
executive director to assume responsibility for chairing the 
company's remuneration committee.  Once this recruitment 
is complete, the Board considers that an appropriate 
combination of executive and non-executive directors will be 
in place in accordance with the Code.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT
PENDRAGON PLC BOARD
MAIN BOARD COMMITTEES
NOMINATION 
COMMITTEE
REMUNERATION
COMMITTEE
AUDIT 
 COMMITTEE
EXECUTIVE 
COMMITTEE
RISK CONTROL 
GROUP
OPERATIONAL MEETINGS
ESG WORKING 
GROUP

64
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
VOTES AGAINST RESOLUTIONS AT THE 2022 AGM
At the 2022 AGM, the Company received votes of 20 per 
cent or more against resolution 2 (annual report on director's 
remuneration for year ended 2021), resolution 3 (re-election 
of Bill Berman and resolution 4 (re-election of Dietmar Exler). 
In relation to resolution 2, we listened to the feedback and 
concerns raised by our shareholders in terms of how our 
remuneration policy was implemented in 2021, and in light 
of that feedback, have ensured that the way the policy was 
implemented in 2022, and the new remuneration policy 
proposed for approval in 2023 was in accordance with best 
practice and contained generally market accepted features. 
In relation to resolutions 3 and 4, we understand that the 
votes accrued against these resolutions were primarily due to 
the position taken by one of our main shareholders; for the 
avoidance of doubt, the majority of our major shareholders 
remained supportive of the re-election of Mr Berman and Mr 
Exler.
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS AND INDEPENDENCE
The non-executive chairman (who, on appointment to that 
role, fulfilled the requirement to be independent) has ensured 
that the Board performs effectively through a well-functioning 
combination of Board and Committee meetings and other 
appropriate channels for strategic input and constructive 
challenge for non-executive directors.  The chairman has 
had meetings with the non-executive directors without the 
executive directors present, where necessary, to assist Board 
effectiveness, and, following the 2022 year end, conducted 
individual meetings with each director to arrive at his and the 
Board’s assessment of the director’s respective contributions, 
training needs and independence.  The Board has routinely 
operated conflict management procedures and has deemed 
these procedures effective.  Through these, and the evaluations 
which are described below, we have concluded that:-  
•	
the Board’s collective skills, experience, knowledge of the 
company and independence allow it and its committees 
to discharge their respective duties properly;
•	
subject to the recruitment of an additional non-executive 
director, the Board and each of its committees is of the 
right size and balance to function effectively;
•	
we have satisfactory plans for orderly succession to 
Board roles;
•	
the non-executive chairman and respective committee 
chairmen are performing their roles effectively;
•	
all non-executive directors are independent in character 
and judgment; 
•	
no director has any relationships or circumstances which 
could affect their exercising independent judgement; and
•	
the non- executive chairman and each of the non-
executive directors is devoting the amount of time 
required to attend to the company's affairs and their 
duties as a Board member
•	
During 2022, the Board received briefings from company 
executives 
to 
familiarise 
directors 
with 
strategic 
developments and key aspects of the Group’s business
BOARD EVALUATION
The Board and its committees conducted formal evaluations 
of their effectiveness in 2022, facilitated by the company 
secretary, addressing questions based closely on the Code, 
applicable good governance topics and drawn from best 
corporate practice. The results were reviewed by the non-
executive chairman, the Committee chairmen and the Board 
as a whole and the non-executive chairman has factored 
suggested improvements into our 2023 Board programme. 
More details on the Board’s approach to individual and Board 
evaluation are on the company’s website. 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT
Current Directors
Board
Audit
Nomination
Remuneration
William Berman 
14/14
N/A
N/A
N/A
Martin Casha
13/14
N/A
N/A
N/A
Dietmar Exler  (I) (SID)
12/14
3/3
0/1
5/6
Ian Filby  1 (N) (I)
13/14
N/A
1/1
6/6
Nikki Flanders (I)
12/14
3/3
1/1
6/6
Brian Small (I) (A)
12/14
3/3
1/1
6/6
Mark Willis
14/14
N/A
N/A
N/A
Mike Wright 2
5/5
1/1
N/A
3/3
(I) Considered by the Board to be independent
(SID) Senior Independent Director
(A) Committee chairman
(N) Committee chairman
(R) Committee chairman
1. Acting Remuneration Committee chairman since 01 June 2022.
2. Resigned from the Board as Non-Executive Director and Chair of the Remuneration Committee on 01 June 2022.
BOARD ATTENDANCE

65
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
RE-ELECTION OF DIRECTORS
In accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code, 
all current Directors will be subject to annual re-election or 
election (in the case of new Directors) at the AGM.
INFORMATION AND SUPPORT 
To ensure our decisions are fully informed and debated, 
the chairman ensures that our Board’s business agenda is 
set timely to allow appropriately detailed information to be 
circulated to all directors before meetings.  The company 
secretary facilitates the flow of information within the Board, 
attends all Board meetings and is responsible for advising the 
Board and its Committees, through their respective chairmen, 
on corporate governance and matters of procedure.  All 
directors have access to support from the group general 
counsel & company secretary on matters of procedure, law 
and governance and in relation to their own induction and 
professional development as Board members.  All directors 
are entitled to take independent advice at the Company’s 
expense, and to have the Company and other Board members 
provide the information required to enable them to make 
informed judgements and discharge their duties effectively. 
HOW THE BOARD MANAGES RISK
The Board and our Committees each operate to a set meeting 
agenda which ensures that all relevant risks are identified and 
addressed by appropriate controls.  We review management 
information which helps us to prescribe operating controls and 
monitor performance against our strategy and business plans. 
The non-executive directors have particular responsibility for 
monitoring financial and performance reporting, to ensure that 
progress is being made towards our agreed goals.  The Board’s 
responsibilities also include assessing the effectiveness of 
internal controls and management of risk.  Specific areas of 
risk assessment and control fall within the remit of committees 
of the Board; details of their work in 2022 appear below and in 
the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 77 to 95.
THE BOARD’S REVIEW OF RISKS AND CONTROLS IN 2022
The accountability framework described on page 39 is 
designed to ensure comprehensive management of risk 
across the Group’s businesses.  A revised, overarching Risk 
Management Policy was introduced in October 2019, which 
is reviewed and renewed annually, setting out the principles 
and approaches by which we implement effective enterprise 
risk management.  The Risk Management Policy remained 
appropriate in 2022.  The RCG, made up of the chief operating 
officer, chief finance officer, group company secretary, group 
head of internal audit and, by invitation, other members of the 
Group’s senior operational and financial management, meets 
regularly to consider the detailed work on risk assessment 
performed by leaders and key business areas and oversees 
the effective implementation of new measures designed to 
mitigate or meet any specific risks or threats.  The chair of 
the Audit Committee, and a representative of the external 
auditors attend by invitation.  The RCG reports to the Audit 
Committee on its work. The Board and any of its committees 
is able to refer specific risks to the RCG for evaluation and for 
controls to be designed or modified; this occurs in consultation 
with executive management.  The executive directors are 
responsible for communicating and implementing mitigating 
controls and operating suitable systems of check.  The RCG 
met three times in 2022.
In addition to reviewing and refining the Group’s corporate 
risk register for Board review and adoption, the RCG continues 
to monitor and review the Group’s anti-bribery controls, 
including the development of e-learning, gifts and hospitality 
training, Consumer Rights Act 2015 training, Modern Slavery 
Act 2015 awareness and further initiatives designed to reduce 
incidences of theft and fraud.  The RCG ensures any internal 
control deficiencies identified are swiftly remediated. 
Internal audit reports have highlighted some areas of control 
that need improving which the Company are addressing. The 
Board considers that the Group’s systems provide information 
which is adequate to permit the identification of key risks 
to its business and the proper assessment and mitigation of 
those risks. Based on the Audit Committee’s and the RCG’s 
work, the Board has performed a high level risk assessment to 
ensure that (i) the principal risks and uncertainties facing the 
Group’s business have been identified and assessed, taking 
into account any adaptations made to the Group’s business 
strategy, and (ii) that appropriate mitigation is in place.

66
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
Bill joined Pendragon on 18 April 2019 as a non-executive director,  and became 
chief executive officer on 19 February 2020.  Formerly the President and Chief 
Operating Officer of AutoNation, the largest automotive retailer in America, Bill 
has extensive executive experience in automotive retail, enabling him to provide 
effective leadership of Pendragon’s Board and advise in relation to the Company’s 
future strategy.  
Brian joined Pendragon on 10 December 2019, following an extensive executive 
career in the retail sector, where most recently he held the position of Chief 
Finance Officer at JD Sports Fashion Plc between 2004 and 2018.  Brian is also 
a non-executive director and chairman of the Audit Committee at online retailer, 
Boohoo.com, and a non-executive director and chairman of the Audit Committee of 
Mothercare Plc.  Brian qualified as a chartered accountant with Price Waterhouse in 
1981, and with industry experience across a range of retailers, he brings additional 
financial and strategic perspectives to the Board.
Nikki has over 25 years in-depth retail experience, from physical to online, leading 
on growth and transformation strategies across multiple goods and services 
categories, including digital services, energy and telco products.  She is currently 
the Managing Director of the Customer division (UK and Ireland) at SSE plc.   Her 
previous roles include that of Chief Operating Officer at Drax plc, Managing Director 
for Digital at Telefonica Plc and other senior leadership roles within Centrica Plc, 
Marks and Spencer plc and WH Smith plc. Nikki is widely recognised as a leading 
advocate for Diversity & Inclusion and in conjunction with her career experience 
brings deep commercial, customer and people leadership experience with valuable 
insights. 
  
Key to memberships, roles and re-election status
* Committee chairman
** Acting Committee chairman from 01 June 2022
(SID) Senior Independent Director
(A) Audit Committee
(N) Nomination Committee
(R) Remuneration Committee
(F) Audit committee member with recent and relevant financial experience
More detailed professional biographies of the Directors are on the Company’s website.www.pendragonplc.com
BILL BERMAN 
Chief Executive Officer
BRIAN SMALL 
Non-Executive Director
(A*) (N) (R) (F) 
NIKKI FLANDERS 
Non-Executive Director
(A) (N) (R)
Ian joined Pendragon on 01 November 2021 as non-executive chairman, following 
a 40 year career in retail, a large proportion of which was spent with Alliance 
Boots.  In his last executive role, Ian was the chief executive officer of furniture 
retailer DFS, which significantly increased its market leadership in both online and in 
physical stores during his tenure; Ian’s extensive executive experience enables him 
to provide effective leadership of Pendragon’s Board and advise in relation to the 
Company’s future strategy.
IAN FILBY
Non-executive Chairman 
(N*) (R**)

67
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Mark joined Pendragon on 08 April 2019 as Chief Finance Officer, from Ten 
Entertainment Group PLC where he held the position of Chief Finance Officer since 
taking it through its IPO in April 2017.  Prior to this, Mark worked at Home Retail 
Group PLC, including roles as Argos Finance Director, Director of Group Finance and 
Investor Relations Director.  Since joining Pendragon, Mark’s wealth of accounting, 
financial and investor relations experience continues to add significant value to the 
Board. 
Having spent his entire career with Pendragon businesses, from apprentice mechanic 
to group general manager, Martin became operations director in September 1995 
and chief operating officer in November 2001.  Martin’s extensive knowledge of 
Pendragon’s operations ensures he continues to be able to advise the Board as to 
the most appropriate operational action and response to changes in the automotive 
retail sector.
Company Secretary                           
Richard Maloney
Registered Office
Loxley House
2 Oakwood Court
Little Oak Drive
Annesley
Nottingham  NG15 0DR
Telephone 01623 725200
Registered in England and Wales
Group motor businesses websites
www.evanshalshaw.com 
www.stratstone.com
www.carstore.com
Group Support business websites
www.pinewood.co.uk
www.pendragonvehiclemanagement.co.uk
www.quickco.co.uk
Registered number 2304195
MARK WILLIS 
Chief Finance Officer
MARTIN CASHA 
Chief Operating Officer 
Dietmar joined Pendragon on 20 April 2020, following an extensive executive 
career including experience in the automotive sector, banking and sports 
management.  Dietmar currently serves as Chief Operating Officer of AMB Sports & 
Entertainment.  Prior to that, he held the position of President and Chief Executive 
Officer of Mercedes-Benz USA and Head of Region, NAFTA Mercedes-Benz.  His 
previous automotive sector specific executive experience, in particular in relation to 
automotive financing enables Dietmar to contribute the industry perspective, and is 
of significant value to the Board.  Dietmar was appointed SID on 24 February 2021.
DIETMAR EXLER 
Non-Executive Director 
(SID) (A) (N) (R) 

68
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
AUDIT COMMITTEE REPORT
The Audit Committee is a committee of the Board and has been chaired by 
Brian Small since January 2020, made up entirely of independent non-executive 
directors.  Their names and qualifications are on pages 66 and 67 and attendance at 
meetings in the table on page 64.
KEY RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE AUDIT COMMITTEE
•	
monitors the integrity of the financial statements and 
formal announcements  
•	
reviews and approves the Annual Report and Accounts 
for adoption by the Board 
•	
recommends to the Board the selection of the external 
auditor and its terms of appointment and monitors its 
effectiveness and independence 
•	
governs policy for the allocation of non-audit work to the 
audit firm
•	
reviews internal controls and risk management 
•	
monitors the effectiveness of the internal audit function 
•	
reviews and monitors whistleblowing arrangements 
Its terms of reference detail its key responsibilities and appear, 
with relevant background information, on the company’s 
website www.pendragonplc.com.
THE COMMITTEE’S WORK IN 2022
The Audit Committee met three times in 2022 and this report 
describes its work and conclusions. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS REVIEW
The Committee received the auditor’s memorandum on 
the company’s 2021 financial statements and the auditor’s 
memorandum on the unaudited 2022 interim results.  In each 
case, it discussed the auditor’s findings with the auditor, 
satisfied itself of the integrity of the financial statements 
and recommended the financial statements for approval by 
the Board. Key aspects of those discussions and relevant 
considerations and conclusions are below.
AUDIT RISK CONSIDERED BY THE COMMITTEE
The table on page 70 sets out the key audit risks and 
judgments applied, for the 2022 year end results, which the 
Committee considered and discussed with the auditor, and 
the Committee’s conclusions.  

69
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022

70
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
These are the key risks considered by the committee. 
Audit risk considered by the Committee
VEHICLE INVENTORY VALUATION
This is the risk that the value of inventory set out in note • to 
the financial statements could be materially overstated and 
whether or not an appropriate provision had been calculated. 
The risk for used vehicles is seen as the most relevant, for 
scrutiny.  Used vehicle prices can vary depending on a number 
of factors, including general economic conditions and the 
levels of new vehicle production.
PENSION SCHEME LIABILITIES
The amounts reflected in the financial statements in respect of 
pension scheme liabilities involve judgements made in relation 
actuarial assumptions, long-term interest rates, inflation, 
longevity and investment returns. The liabilities are set out in 
note • to the financial statements. There is a risk that the value 
of the pension scheme liabilities could be materially under or 
over stated in the context of the sensitivity analysis in that 
note.  
VALUATION OF PARENT COMPANY INVESTMENT
This is the risk that the company has investments in its 
subsidiary companies, which could be overstated when 
considered with current market capitalisation of the company 
and could impact the ability of the company to pay dividends 
should the investment be impaired.  The value of investments 
is underpinned by expectation of discounted future profits and 
net assets of the subsidiary companies.  There is an inherent 
uncertainty in forecasting future profits. 
Evidence considered and conclusion reached
The Committee discussed with the auditors, together with all 
audit findings, the factors relevant to an assessment of used 
inventory valuation,  including the level of inventory held 
across the business, the ageing of the inventory, the stock turn 
of the inventory and an analysis of market factors including 
the parc of used vehicles, the used vehicle market sales rate 
and historic movements in used vehicle prices. 
The Committee was satisfied that a comprehensive assessment 
of inventory valuation had been undertaken and concluded 
that the judgements applied were appropriate.  
The Committee ascertained that judgements made on pension 
scheme were all based on advice from the Group’s pension 
adviser.  The  final calculations in respect of the Group’s 
defined benefit pension scheme liability were performed by 
our pension scheme actuary. The Committee discussed with 
the auditor the assumptions applied, in particular the findings 
of the auditor’s own pension specialist. The Committee 
remained satisfied with the outcomes applied from both a 
balance sheet perspective and actuarial perspective.
The Committee concluded that the judgements applied were 
appropriate.
The Committee reviewed management’s report on the 
valuation of the parent company investments.  
To assess the valuation of parent company investments to 
the value of subsidiary assets, analysis has been performed 
to establish CGU asset impairment as described above.  The 
Committee were satisfied with management’s conclusion 
that the carrying value of the parent company investment is 
supported and therefore no further impairment is needed.  
AUDIT COMMITTEE REPORT

71
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
These are other areas of focus for the committee.
Audit risk considered by the Committee
CGU ASSET VALUATION 
The estimates in relation to asset impairment of the carrying 
value of goodwill, intangible assets, property, plant and 
equipment and right use of assets largely related to the 
achievability of assumptions underlying the calculation of 
the recoverable amount of the business being tested for 
impairment, set out in note • to the financial statements.  Key 
assumptions used are the FY23 budget, growth rate and 
discount rate as well as the EBITDA multiples applied or fair 
value of individual assets.
GOING CONCERN
The company revised both its base case and downside forward 
looking forecasts for the period to 31 March 2024, comparing 
assumptions for revenue and margin, and assumptions for 
working capital in the light of a potential prolonged downturn 
and recessionary environment, double digit inflation and 
ongoing supply issues in terms of global semi-conductor 
chip shortages and supply shortages caused by the war in 
Ukraine.   However, on a positive note, revised credit facilities 
agreed in March 2022 has given much more certainty over 
the availability of facilities with the senior notes of £100m 
in place until 2027 and the £75m revolving credit facility in 
place until March 2025. The Committee will nevertheless 
continue to carefully monitor and review cash flow forecasts 
in the forward looking forecast for a period to 31 March 2024, 
challenging trading and comparing assumptions for revenue 
and margin to externally sourced data, assessing assumptions 
for working capital and challenging management to continue 
to prepare assumptions for a severe, but plausible downside. 
Evidence considered and conclusion reached
The Committee considered the risk that goodwill could be 
materially overstated in the context of the sensitivity analysis, 
also set out in note •. The Committee addressed these matters 
through receiving reports from management outlining the 
basis for the assumptions used, assessing the range and depth 
of information underpinning the assumptions and calculations 
and discussing this with the auditors.
The Committee concluded that the judgements applied were 
appropriate.
The committee reviewed both the forecasts presented by the 
Directors, and further scenarios which had been sensitised 
to reflect severe but plausible downside scenarios.  Those 
forecasts indicate that the Group can continue to operate 
within the existing facilities.  The base and sensitised forecasts 
indicate that the Group will remain in compliance with the 
relevant covenants for a period of at least 12 months from the 
date of approval of these financial statements.
The committee concluded that it remained appropriate to 
prepare the financial statements on a going concern basis. 
Further details can be found within the viability statement at 
page 49 and within the going concern statement on page 118.

72
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
EXTERNAL AUDITOR APPOINTMENT
AND PERFORMANCE EVALUATION
The 
Committee 
considered 
Auditor 
effectiveness 
and 
independence of the audit, during the year. 
The Committee arrived at its recommendation to the Board 
on the auditor’s appointment by:
•	
applying exclusively objective criteria;
•	
evaluating the ability of the audit firm to demonstrate its 
independence; 
•	
assessing the effectiveness of the audit firm in the 
performance of its audit duties; and 
•	
assessing the audit firm’s adherence to applicable 
professional standards.
The Committee chairman oversaw the company’s evaluation 
of the auditor’s performance, and noted that the current 
auditor, KPMG had issued to the company all requisite 
assurances of its independence.  The Committee reported its 
conclusions to the Board, namely, that there are no existing or 
historical relationships or other matters which adversely affect 
the independence of KPMG as the company’s auditor, and no 
performance shortcomings or unresolved issues relating to 
fee levels.
The lead audit partner, Craig Parkin, was appointed in early 
2021.
POLICY ON AUDIT TENDERING
KPMG was appointed as auditor in September 1997, since 
when, audit services have not been tendered competitively. 
Under current EU legislation on audit firm rotation, the current 
auditor cannot be reappointed after 2023.  Consequently, 
2023 will be the final year which KPMG will be reappointed 
as the company’s auditor.  In anticipation of rotation to an 
alternative auditor in 2024, the company, at the request of 
the Committee, commenced some preliminary work to launch 
a competitive tender of the external audit service in autumn 
2022.  
The competitive tender process for audit services will be 
further progressed throughout 2023, with the objective 
of concluding the appointment of the new external auditor 
as soon as practicable, to allow for a smooth and orderly 
transition.   The Committee has concluded none of the 
directors’ independence in considering this matter is impaired 
in any way and none has a potential or actual conflict of 
interest in relation to KPMG or in the consideration of the 
appointment of an alternative auditor pursuant to the tender 
process, whether in regard to  appointment, fees, evaluation 
of performance or potential performance, any decision as to 
competitive tender for audit services, or any other matter.
REVIEW OF NON-AUDIT SERVICES
The Committee reviewed the company’s policy on its use of its 
audit firm for non-audit work. Its main principles are that the 
auditor is excluded from providing certain non-audit services 
the performance of which is considered incompatible with 
its audit duties, but is eligible to tender for other non-audit 
work on a competitive basis and can properly be awarded 
such work if its fees and service represent value for money. 
The policy can be viewed on the company’s website. The 
Committee considered reports on the extent and nature of 
non-audit work available, the allocation during the year of that 
work to accountancy and audit firms, including KPMG LLP, 
and the associated fees. Details of audit and non-audit work 
performed by KPMG and the related fees appear annually 
in the notes to the company’s financial statements.  A full 
statement of the fees paid to KPMG LLP for work performed 
during the year is set out in note 2.5 to the financial statements 
on page 136.  Having satisfied itself on each item for its review, 
the Committee reported to the Board that the only non-audit 
service provided was the review of the half year accounts.
The Board accepted these findings. 
REVIEW OF INTERNAL AUDIT PERFORMANCE
The Committee chairman oversaw the Committee’s evaluation 
of the internal auditor’s performance, using questionnaires 
covering all aspects of the internal auditor work and 
relationship to the audit and received the auditor’s view on 
that performance. He reviewed the results with the Committee 
members and company management and reported the 
Committee’s conclusions to the Board. The Committee 
concluded that the scope and quality of the internal audit 
work done reflects an effective, well-functioning team.
REVIEW OF RISK MANAGEMENT AND INTERNAL CONTROLS
The Committee reviewed the effectiveness of the company’s 
system of internal control and financial risk management. 
It received reports from the auditor on areas considered 
relevant to the audit work performed and from the RCG, 
whose work is described on page 39 on the company’s risk 
register, emerging risks and corresponding internal controls. 
It scrutinised the key risks register, as revised by the RCG, and 
approved it for adoption by the Board. Its work informed and 
supported the Board’s assessments detailed under “How the 
Board manages risk” on page 65.
REVIEW OF ANTI-BRIBERY CONTROLS 
AND WHISTLEBLOWING
The 
Committee 
reviewed 
the 
company’s 
anti-bribery 
processes and controls and evaluated and approved 
these and the company’s bribery risk assessment. On its 
recommendation, the Board readopted the company’s anti-
bribery policy statements and associated controls. The 
AUDIT COMMITTEE REPORT

73
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Committee considered reports on known instances of alleged 
wrongdoing and matters reported on the company’s third party 
operated confidential reporting line and their investigation, 
reviewed the adequacy of whistleblowing procedures and 
commissioned follow-up action and improvements in risk-
related controls.
Our current anti-bribery value statements and our policies 
on the control of fraud, theft and bribery risks appear on 
the company’s website and are drawn to the attention 
of all parties seeking to transact with the Group.  Our 
whistleblowing procedures are published internally on our 
intranet and their existence is regularly reinforced in our team 
member communications.  The policy is available at www.
pendragonplc.com
Approximately one-fifth of our workforce are required to 
complete, on an annual basis, a mandatory training module 
‘Doing the Right Thing and Conflicts of Interest’ which 
provides realistic, scenario based training of conflict situations, 
likely bribery risk and similar appropriate to our business. 
There have been no incidents of actual corruption or bribery 
recorded in our businesses in 2022.  
APPROVAL 
This report was approved by the Committee and signed on 
it’s behalf by:-
Brian Small
Chairman of the Audit Committee
22 March 2023

74
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NOMINATION COMMITTEE REPORT
The Nomination Committee is chaired by Ian Filby, who 
assumed the role following his appointment in November 2021.  
The Nomination Committee is made up entirely of independent 
non-executive directors.  Their names and qualifications are on 
pages 66 and 67 and attendance at meetings in the table at pages 
64 above.
KEY RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE NOMINATION COMMITTEE
•	
reviews the Board’s size, structure and composition and 
leads recruitment to Board positions
•	
undertakes annual Board performance evaluation
•	
satisfies itself on the company’s refreshing of Board 
membership and succession planning
Its terms of reference detail its key responsibilities and appear, 
with relevant background information, on the company’s 
website www.pendragonplc.com .
THE COMMITTEE’S WORK IN 2022 AND EARLY 2023
The Nomination Committee met once in 2022 and in early 
2023 to conclude its ordinary year end business. This report 
describes its work and conclusions.
REVIEW OF BOARD COMPOSITION AND BALANCE
In July 2022, the Committee met to review in detail the 
company’s approach to succession planning, considering in 
detail critical roles and the current health of the succession 
plan, concluding on the steps to be taken to improve our 
succession health and to ensure that our talent strategy 
becomes a critical enabler of our business strategy.  The 
company’s approach to succession planning identified what 
talent is required, identified what talent we currently have and 
planned how to close the gap between required talent and 
currently available talent. 
In early 2023, the Committee completed its year end work 
by reviewing the structure of the Board, in relation to its size 
composition and potential vacancies, the combination of 
executive to non-executive directors and the balance of the 
Board, to ensure that no one individual or group of individuals 
dominated discussion of decision making.  Other than the 
requirement to recruit an additional non-executive director 
to fulfil the role of Remuneration Committee chair, the 
Committee concluded that the size and structure outlined still 
remained appropriate for the Company, and considered that 
both the size, structure and balance of the Board remained 
appropriate, although the structure did not preclude the 
appointment of additional directors, such as non-executive 
directors with specialist skills should the Committee, and 
ultimately the Board, consider it necessary and prudent to do 
so in line with the execution of the Company’s strategy.   The 
adequacy of time devoted by the non-executive directors to 
Board business, and the independence of the non-executive 
directors was also considered and the Committee concluded 
that all non-executive directors were able to devote sufficient 
time to their roles, and all remained independent. In addition 
to the renewal of the appointment of Brian Small as a non-
executive director for a further three years, the Committee 
further noted that that Ms Nikki Flanders and Mr Dietmar Exler 
should be recommended for reappointment as non-executive 
directors on further three year terms on conclusion of their 
current appointments in December 2023. 

75
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
EVALUATION
The annual evaluations of the Board and its members were 
conducted by the Board and are described on page 64. As 
part of that process, the Committee conducted an evaluation 
of its own performance. 
DIVERSITY
All appointments made, including those of Board members, 
adhere to the company’s diversity and equal opportunities 
policy, which can be viewed on the company’s website. For 
non-executive director appointments, where executive search 
consultants are instructed, they are done so in a manner 
in a manner consistent with this policy.   The Committee is 
mindful of the proposals outlined in the FCA Policy Paper: 
Diversity and Inclusion on Company Boards and Executive 
Management, and will aim to consider how the company will 
aim to comply the recommendations where they align with 
its overall business strategy.  At present, the company has 
not adopted a gender balance target for its Board, although 
continues to make appointments at Board and immediately 
below Board level in accordance with a formal, rigorous and 
transparent procedure.  Appointments are based on merit and 
objective criteria, and within this context, we aim to promote 
diversity of gender, social and ethnic backgrounds, alongside 
cognitive and personal strengths in accordance with Principle 
J of the Code.  In order to further this objective, we continue 
to partner with external recruitment agencies, and maintain 
our relationship with agencies committed to reaching and 
providing access to diverse talent pools to assist with these 
processes. 

76
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
The Remuneration Committee is a committee of the Board, and is 
currently chaired by Ian Filby on an interim basis.  It is made up 
entirely of independent non-executive directors.  Their names and 
qualifications are on pages 66 and 67 and attendance at meetings 
in the table on page 64.  
KEY RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE 
REMUNERATION COMMITTEE
•	
has 
delegated 
responsibility 
for 
determining 
the 
policy for Executive Director remuneration and setting 
remuneration for the chairman, executive directors, the 
company secretary and the immediately below board 
level of senior management;
•	
reviews workforce remuneration and related policies and 
the alignment of incentives and rewards with culture, 
taking these into account when setting executive director 
remuneration;
•	
ensures that executive directors are provided with 
appropriate 
incentives 
which 
align 
their 
interests 
with those of shareholders, and encourage enhanced 
performance in the short and medium term, as well as 
achievement of the company’s longer term strategic 
goals;
•	
determines targets for any performance related pay 
schemes;
•	
seeks shareholder approval for triannual renewal of 
remuneration 
policy 
and 
any 
long-term 
incentive 
arrangements
The terms of reference of the Remuneration Committee are 
available at www.pendragonplc.com.
THE COMMITTEE’S WORK IN 2022
The Remuneration Committee met six times in 2022.  The 
Directors’ Remuneration Report, beginning at page 77, 
describes its work and conclusions.
REMUNERATION COMMITTEE REPORT

77
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
REMUNERATION COMMITTEE CHAIRMAN’S LETTER TO SHAREHOLDERS
Dear Shareholder
On behalf of the Remuneration Committee, I am pleased to present the Director’s Remuneration Report for the financial year 
ending 31 December 2022. This report has been prepared by the Remuneration Committee and approved by the Board.
This remuneration report is split into two sections:
•	
the new Directors’ Remuneration Policy; which we propose will apply for financial years 2023-2026; and
•	
the Annual Report on Remuneration.
The proposed directors’ remuneration policy will be subject to a binding vote at the AGM. This new policy, if approved by 
shareholders, will last for a period of three years from the date of the AGM or until another policy is approved in a general meeting. 
The Annual Report on Remuneration describes annual remuneration and the amounts paid in respect of 2022 performance, and 
remains subject to an advisory only shareholder vote at the forthcoming AGM.
As highlighted earlier, in 2022, the Company delivered an underlying profit of £57.6m as a result of the clear execution and 
implementation of our strategy, and market conditions. As a result, for 2022, bonuses will be paid to the executive directors at 
109% of basic salary.  No awards vested under the long term incentive plan in 2022. 
The Remuneration Committee has continued to closely follow the ongoing debate on executive remuneration, fairness and 
corporate culture and has worked diligently throughout the year in the development of a new remuneration policy for both 
Executive Directors and our senior management for the next period of our remuneration policy cycle.
New Directors’ Remuneration Policy
At the 2022 AGM the Remuneration Report failed its vote, with a vote in favour of 34.49%. Our understanding is that this was 
primarily in respect of the 2020 and 2021 LTIP grants, which were granted with a one-year performance period to ensure that 
we retained our key executives.  
  
The Remuneration Report vote, combined with the fact that the Remuneration Policy was last approved at the 2020 AGM, means 
that we are required to renew our Directors Remuneration Policy at the 2023 AGM.  
  
These are our key decisions in respect of remuneration, including the proposed changes to the Director’s Remuneration Policy. 
The Committee strongly believes the suggestions set out below are in the best interests of the company and are aligned to 
corporate governance best practice as well as reflecting the feedback we have received from our shareholders both historically 
and as part of recent engagement..    
  
Base salary (No change to policy) 
Whilst we are making no formal changes to the policy in respect of 2023, there are two items that I wanted to update you on: 
1.	
We are currently proposing no changes to base salary at this stage, but intend to carry out a full review of the current salaries 
for executives, considering appropriate benchmarking data, and internal and external factors following the appointment of 
the new Remuneration Committee Chair.   
2.	
It is our intention to move the salary review process for our executive directors from January each year to May. This aligns 
the process with the wider workforce and will allow us to give greater consideration to the increases we have awarded to 
the wider workforce when considering executive pay arrangements.   
 
Pension (No change to policy) 
1.	
The current policy is such that for newly appointed executive directors the pension provision will be in line with the wider 
workforce. 
2.	
This continues to be true for our proposed policy, and we are also taking the opportunity to complete the alignment of our 
Executive Directors pension arrangements with the wider workforce. Currently each Executive Director is on an individual 
pension arrangement, and these will now be aligned to one approach. 
3.	
During 2022 we undertook a review of the pension provisions available to our wider workforce and increased the company 
contribution to 6% for leaders in the business.
4.	
Our Executive Directors will receive an equivalent pension contribution of 6%, from January 2023 a year later than the 
change for other leaders in the business.  
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

78
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Annual bonus 
1.	
In line with our current Policy the annual bonus will have a maximum opportunity of 150% of salary and the on-target 
opportunity will remain at 100% of salary.
2.	
The threshold opportunity will remain at 25% of salary. 
3.	
From a policy perspective, the annual bonus will continue to be measured against stretching company financial 
performance metrics set and assessed by the Committee on an annual basis. This approach ensures that we retain a 
financial focus within the business, but allows us to set targets appropriately based on the key objectives of the business 
each year.
4.	
For 2023 it is our intention to again use Underlying Profit Before Tax  as our sole measure for the bonus, reflecting the fact 
that it is a key strategic measure for Pendragon and fundamental in measuring our ability to deliver for our shareholders.
5.	
We strongly believe that the targets we set, whilst commercially sensitive, are appropriate for the level of opportunity 
available within the plan at each of the relevant reference points and the level of stretch required to achieve the 
performance metrics that we have set.   
 
Long Term Incentive Plan 
1.	
Under our current policy, the long term incentive plan has a normal maximum opportunity of 150% of salary with an 
exceptional maximum opportunity of 250% of salary.
2.	
The award will normally be subject to performance conditions measured over three years with an additional 2 year post-
vest holding period. As part of the current policy the Committee retained discretion to make awards with a one year 
performance period and an overall three year vesting period in exceptional circumstances
3.	
It is our understanding that these discretions, which we utilised for the 2020 and 2021 LTIP are the main reason why 
shareholders voted against our 2022 Remuneration Report.
4.	
As a result, we are proposing to remove this flexibility, and the proposed LTIP will have a maximum opportunity of 150% 
of salary, with no exceptional maximum. Any awards will also be subject to a three year performance period and two 
year holding period.
5.	
Under the Policy, at least 70% of each award will be based on financial metrics, and for 2023 specifically the measures will 
be 70% EPS, 24% strategic financial metrics and 6% on ESG, focusing equally on carbon and diversity. These measures 
will be suitably stretching to recognise the opportunity available under the plan.   
 
Non-Executive Shareholding requirements (No change to policy) 
1.	
In last year’s annual report, we committed to reviewing whether it was appropriate to introduce Non-Executive 
shareholding requirements.
2.	
The Committee considered this during the year, and as our NEDs actively look to purchase shares, we do not feel it is 
necessary to have a minimum shareholding requirement for non-executives at this time.  We will continue to monitor any 
evolutions in UK best practice to determine if this should change in future.  
 
It is the Committee’s firm belief that the above proposals represent the best interests of the Company and reflect the key 
feedback that we heard from shareholders as a result of last year’s voting outcome. 
 
We hope that the disclosure provided in this report continues to provide clear insight into the Committee’s decisions and we 
look forward to receiving your continued support at the next AGM.
Yours sincerely 
 
Ian Filby 
Non-Executive Chairman, Pendragon Plc 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

79
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
REMUNERATION DISCLOSURE
This report complies with the requirements of The Large and 
Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) 
Regulations 2008, The Large and Medium-sized Companies 
and Groups (Accounts and Reports) (Amendment) Regulations 
2013, the Companies (Miscellaneous Reporting) Regulations 
2018 and The Companies (Directors’ Remuneration Policy 
and Directors’ Remuneration Report) Regulations 2019 (the 
Regulations) and has been prepared in accordance with the 
UK Corporate Governance Code and the UKLA Listing Rules. 
The parts of the report which have been audited in accordance 
with the Regulations have been identified. 
REMUNERATION POLICY 2023 - 2026
The remuneration policy set out in this section of the 
remuneration report will replace the existing policy which 
was approved by shareholders at the 2020 AGM and will take 
effect for all payments made to directors from the date of 
the 2023 AGM. The Remuneration Committee has taken the 
opportunity to conduct a detailed review of the policy, both 
in light of developments in remuneration policy and market 
practice, and also, following consultation with our major 
shareholders, to ensure their feedback is reflected into the 
design of, and any modifications to, the policy going forward. 
The remuneration principles and overarching aim of our 
remuneration policy continues to be framed in such a way as 
to provide and maintain the link between executive pay and 
strategy, aiming to:  
 
•	
ensure 
remuneration 
arrangements 
are 
clear 
and 
transparent, promoting effective engagement with 
shareholders and our associates; 
•	
ensure remuneration structures avoid complexity, with an 
easy to understand rationale and operation; 
•	
avoid reputational and other risks arising from excessive 
rewards, and avoiding or otherwise mitigating behavioural 
risks that may arise from target-based incentive plans; 
•	
clearly explain the range of possible values of rewards 
to individual directors including any other limits or 
discretions; 
•	
provide proportionate awards linked to delivery of 
strategy and long-term performance and ensuring poor 
performance is not rewarded; 
•	
ensure incentive schemes drive behaviours consistent 
with company purpose, values and strategy; 
•	
attract and retain directors of the calibre necessary to run 
the business effectively with levels of remuneration that 
are arrived at responsibly and also reflect their individual 
contribution to the value of the company; 
•	
weight remuneration towards variable pay; 
•	
encourage executives to build significant levels of share 
ownership, through the retention of vested share awards. 
 
Consistent 
with 
market 
practice, 
the 
Remuneration 
Committee will retain full discretion over all elements of 
variable remuneration, both in terms of annual bonus awards 
made and long term incentive awards granted and vesting. 
The extent of this discretion is more particularly described on 
page 84.
 
NEW REMUNERATION POLICY 
The new remuneration policy is detailed in this section. This 
policy will be put to shareholders for approval at the AGM. The 
policy is intended to apply, subject to shareholder approval, 
for three years from the 2023 AGM. Where a material change 
to this policy is considered, the company will consult major 
shareholders prior to submitting to all shareholders for 
approval. 
 
The remuneration policy will be displayed on the company’s 
website (www.pendragonplc.com), following the 2023 AGM. 
 
The table below summarises the individual elements of 
remuneration provided to the executive directors under the 
new policy. 

80
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
REMUNERATION POLICY FOR EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS 
BASE SALARY
PURPOSE AND LINK TO STRATEGY
Provide competitive remuneration that will attract and 
retain executives of the calibre required to take forward the 
company’s strategy. 
OPERATION
Base salaries are reviewed annually, effective from 1 May. The 
Committee sets base salaries taking into account:  
•	
the performance and experience of the individual 
concerned; 
•	
any change in responsibilities; 
•	
appropriate executive	remuneration benchmarking, 
reflecting the size and sector of the company 
Base salaries are paid monthly in arrears.
MAXIMUM OPPORTUNITY
Salary levels are eligible for increases during the three-year 
period that the remuneration policy operates. During this 
time, salaries may be increased each year. 
 
Salary increases are usually determined after taking due 
account of market conditions and typically, any increases 
awarded will be in line with the increase of that of the wider 
workforce. 
 
Significant changes in role scope may require further 
adjustments to bring salaries into line with new responsibilities. 
 
For recent joiners or promotions whose pay was initially 
set below market rate, higher than usual increases may be 
awarded to bring them into line with the market over a phased 
period as they develop in their role. 
PERFORMANCE METRICS
Both individual and company performance is taken into 
account when determining whether any salary increases are 
appropriate.
PROPOSED CHANGES
Base salary review period set to 1 May to align with the salary 
review of wider organisation. This was previously 1 January for 
Executive Directors.
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

81
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
BENEFITS
PURPOSE AND LINK TO STRATEGY
Cost-effective, market competitive benefits are provided to 
ensure executive directors have a reasonable and competitive 
level of protection.  
OPERATION
Life assurance, private health cover, professional subscriptions, 
(at the executive’s option) company cars and fuel, and 
any other benefits from time to time as the Remuneration 
Committee deems appropriate. Relocation benefits, including 
overseas health care cover and tax support may also be 
provided in certain circumstances, where applicable, if 
considered appropriate by the Remuneration Committee.   
PENSION
ELEMENT AND PURPOSE
Provide long-term retirement benefits that will form part of a 
remuneration package that will attract and retain executives 
who are able to take forward the company’s strategy. 
 
OPERATION
Post-2009 executives: participation in a defined contribution 
pension scheme or a Pension contribution in line with the 
relevant wider workforce.  Pre-2009 executives: deferred 
membership of defined benefit pension scheme
MAXIMUM OPPORTUNITY
Benefit levels are set to be competitive relative to companies 
of a comparable size. The cost of some of these benefits is 
not pre-determined and may vary from year to year based 
on the overall cost to the company of securing these benefits 
for a population of employees (this is particularly relevant for 
health insurance and death in service cover). 
PERFORMANCE METRICS
Not applicable. 
PROPOSED CHANGES 
None
MAXIMUM OPPORTUNITY
The maximum opportunity for newly appointed Executive 
Directors will be in line with pension contributions prevailing 
in the relevant wider workforce.
PERFORMANCE METRICS
No performance metrics apply.
PROPOSED CHANGES 
None

82
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
ANNUAL BONUS
PURPOSE AND LINK TO STRATEGY
Incentivises achievement of annual objectives which support 
the short-term goals of the company, as reflected in the 
annual business plan 
OPERATION
Annual bonuses are earned over the year and are paid 
annually in arrears after the end of the financial year to which 
they relate, based on performance against targets over the 
year. A minimum of 25% of after tax bonus earned is subject to 
compulsory deferral into the company’s shares until such time 
as the company’s share ownership guidelines are met. In such 
situations where bonus is deferred into shares, an executive 
director may be entitled to receive dividend payments on 
such shares.  
ALL EMPLOYEE SHARE SCHEME (SHARESAVE)
PURPOSE AND LINK TO STRATEGY
The Sharesave is an all employee share ownership plan which 
has been designed to encourage all employees to become 
shareholders in the company and thereby align their interests 
with shareholders. 
OPERATION
Executive directors are eligible to participate in Sharesave. 
The executive directors are entitled to participate in any other 
all employee arrangements implemented by the company.  
MAXIMUM OPPORTUNITY 
Maximum available bonus is equivalent to 150% of base salary, 
which is available only for material outperformance of the 
company’s annual business plan.  
PERFORMANCE METRICS
Annual bonus is earned based on performance against 
stretching company financial performance measures as set 
and assessed by the Committee. 
 
25% of salary will be payable for threshold performance 
under each measure with 100% of salary payable for target 
performance and 150% of salary for maximum performance. 
The specific measures, targets and weightings may vary from 
year to year in order to align with the company’s strategy and 
the measures will be dependent on the company’s goals over 
the year under review. 
PROPOSED CHANGES 
None
MAXIMUM OPPORTUNITY
The maximum levels of participation set by legislation from 
time to time. 
PERFORMANCE METRICS
No performance conditions.
PROPOSED CHANGES 
A Sharesave scheme has not been introduced to date, but if 
circumstances change this could be reviewed.
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

83
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
LONG TERM INCENTIVE PLAN
PURPOSE AND LINK TO STRATEGY
Promotes retention and incentivisation over the longer term. 
Aligns executive directors’ interests with the company’s share 
price and its shareholders. 
OPERATION 
The core design of the LTIP will be that awards are subject 
to performance conditions measured over three years and a 
service requirement for a further 2 years.
POLICY ON EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR SHARE OWNERSHIP
The company continues to recognise the importance of 
executives building significant holdings of the company’s 
shares to align the long-term interests of management and 
shareholders in the success of the company.
The minimum shareholding requirement for the CEO is 200% 
of salary (100% for all other Executive Directors), to be built 
up within 5 years of appointment to the board.
MAXIMUM OPPORTUNITY 
Maximum opportunity will be 150% of base salary. 
PERFORMANCE METRICS
Stretching performance conditions will be set by the 
Committee each year. At least 70% of each award will be 
based on financial metrics, such as underlying EPS. 
25% of the award will vest for threshold performance with 
100% of awards being achieved for target performance and 
150% being achieved for maximum performance. Vesting 
between target points will be determined on a straight-line 
basis
The Committee may refine the choice of performance metrics 
each year in line with developments in the company’s strategy. 
In the event of a significant or material change of approach, 
the Committee will engage in dialogue with shareholders.  
PROPOSED CHANGES 
Removal of ability to increase maximum opportunity to 250% 
of salary in exceptional circumstances. Removal of discretion 
to implement a one-year performance period. Inclusion of 
ability to satisfy shares through a either a CSOP, nil cost 
options or a combination of both. 
Until such time as the policy is met, Executive Directors will 
be required to hold any vested deferred bonus shares and 
LTIP awards that vest (after sale of shares to cover associated 
personal tax liabilities).
Post-cessation shareholding requirement of 100% of the in- 
employment requirement for 2 years following cessation of 
employment. This provision supports sustained share price 
performance and encourages strong succession processes.

84
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
POLICY ON NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION 
The 
company’s 
policy 
on 
non-executive 
directors’ 
remuneration is reviewed annually by the Board. Remuneration 
for non- executive directors is confined to fees alone, without 
a performance related element. Non-executive directors 
may elect to receive all or part of their fees in the form of 
benefits in kind, typically the provision of a motor vehicle for 
their use. The company considers that the remuneration of 
the non-executive directors remains consistent with the time 
commitments associated with individual positions and wider 
market practice among companies of a comparable size. 
Fee Type
Fee Level
Change in 2022
Chairman fee
£150,000
None
Basic fee:
£50,000
None
Supplementary fees:
Senior Independent Director
£4,000
None
Audit Committee Chairman
£10,000
None
Remuneration Committee Chairman
£5,000
None
Nomination Committee Chairman                           
Nil
None
Notes accompanying the future Remuneration Policy table:
1.	 Malus and clawback – malus and clawback may operate in respect of the annual bonus and long term incentive plan. This approach applies to all executive directors and senior 
management immediately below Board level.  Malus will typically be an adjustment to the cash award or number of shares before an award has been made or released.  Clawback 
requires the executive to make a cash repayment to the company or the surrender of shares or other benefits provided by the company.  The overall intention is that, in exceptional 
circumstances, malus will apply before awards are paid or vest.  Clawback will apply under the annual bonus scheme, for up to three years from when the cash payment is made, 
and malus will apply to any deferred shares (awarded at the same time as the cash payment) for the three-year period of the deferral.  Under the LTIP, clawback will continue to 
apply for up to two years following the three-year vesting period.
As a minimum, the events in which malus and clawback may apply are as follows:
•	
Material misstatement of financial statements.
•	
Gross misconduct/fraud of the participant.
•	
Where there has been an error in the calculation of performance outcomes, the value of awards, or the number of shares under an award.
•	
Participant has caused reputational damage to the Company.
•	
Participant has wholly or in part caused the corporate failure of the Company.
Malus and clawback provisions are kept under review, in the light of prevailing Financial Reporting Council guidance.
2.	 Salary – base salaries are set by reference to the criteria specified in the table above.  If a salary is initially set below the market rate, a phased realignment may be made over time.
3.	 Annual bonus – a target of underlying (adjusted) profit was selected as this measure directly correlates to Company’s overall business plan.   The specific measures, targets and 
weightings may vary from year to year in order to align with the Company’s strategy and the measures will be dependent on the Company’s goals over the year under review. 
Performance measures are determined by the Remuneration Committee who seek external guidance on the appropriateness of any performance targets set relative to the market. 
4.	 Long term incentive plans – LTIP: under the Company’s current long term incentive plan, performance shares are awarded up to a maximum of 150% of salary if significantly chal-
lenging performance targets are attained.  The Remuneration Committee has currently selected two performance metrics for the LTIP, each with an equal weighting (i) EPS: this 
remains the key internal measure of long term financial performance, as well as being well understood by the executives and our investors as providing a clear incentive to deliver 
the Company’s long term growth prospects; and (ii) qualitative strategic performance metrics aligned to the Company's strategic milestones.   The vesting schedule outlines the 
vesting percentages in relation to both the EPS performance targets, which were set after taking into account internal scenario analysis, current market expectations and the 
current trading environment, and delivery against the strategic milestones as detailed in the Group’s published strategic plan. 
5.	 Pensions – The Chief Operating Officer ceased to be an active member of the Pension Plan in 2006.  In accordance with the Code, the company is seeking to align his pension with 
that the wider workforce and is proposing to effect a phased reduction in the salary supplement in lieu of pension contribution received by the Chief Operating Officer such that, 
by 01 January 2023, his salary supplement in lieu of pension contribution will be aligned to the employer pension contribution available to the majority of employees.   
6.	 Benefits - benefit levels are set to be competitive relative to companies of a comparable size.
7.	 Annual Bonus and LTIP Policy - Remuneration Committee Discretions: The Committee will operate the annual bonus plan and LTIP in accordance with their respective rules and 
in accordance with the Listing Rules, where relevant.  Consistent with market practice, the Committee retains discretion in a number of respects with regard to the operation and 
administration of these plans.  These include the following (albeit with quantum and performance targets restricted to the descriptions detailed in the future policy table above):-
•	
who participates in the plans;
•	
the timing of grant of award and/or payment;
•	
the size of an award and/or payment;
•	
the determination of vesting and/or meeting targets with the ability to override the formulaic outcome in light of overall business proposals
•	
discretion required when dealing with a change of control (e.g. the timing of testing performance targets) or restructuring of the Group;
•	
determination of good/bad leaver cases for incentive plan purposes based on the rules of each plan and the appropriate treatment chosen;
•	
adjustments required in certain circumstances (e.g. rights issues, corporate restructuring events, share buybacks and special dividends); and
•	
the annual review of performance measures and weighting, and targets for the annual bonus plan and LTIP from year to year or on award.
The Committee also retains the ability to adjust the targets and/or set different measures and alter weightings for the annual bonus plan and to adjust targets for the LTIP if events 
occur (such as a material divestment of a Group business) which cause it to determine that the conditions are no longer appropriate and the amendment is required so that the con-
ditions achieve their original purpose and are not materially less difficult to satisfy.
The company retains the authority to honour any commitments entered into with current of former directors that have been disclosed to shareholders in previous remuneration 
reports (e.g. all historic awards that were granted under any LTIPs that remain outstanding, as detailed in the company’s latest Annual Report), and which remain eligible to vest 
based on their original award terms.  Details of any payments to former directors will be set out in the Annual Report on remuneration as they arise.  With regard to any promotions 
to executive director positions, the company will retain the ability to honour payments agreed prior to executives joining the Board, albeit any payments agreed in consideration 
of being promoted to the Board will be consistent with the policy on new appointments as an executive director detailed in the Remuneration Policy at www.pendragonplc.com
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

85
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Element
Description
Minimum
On Target
Maximum
Fixed
Fixed (comprises base
salary, benefits, pension)
Included
Included
Included
Annual Bonus
Annual bonus
16.66% of the maximum 
bonus
66.6% of the maximum 
bonus1
100% of the maximum 
bonus1
Long Term Incentive Plan
Long Term Incentive Plan
16.66%  of the maximum 
LTIP
66.6% of maximum LTIP2
100% of the maximum LTIP2
1The maximum bonus available for executive directors is equivalent to 150% of base salary. 
2Awards made under the long term incentive plan (LTIP) will be on an annual basis with a three year performance period and two year holding period.  The maximum LTIP award available 
for executive directors is equivalent to the award of nil-cost options at 150% of base salary.  
3Impact of share price growth on equity based incentives – In accordance with The Companies (Miscellaneous Reporting) Regulations 2018, indications of maximum remuneration 
available do not allow for any share price growth. 
ILLUSTRATION OF OUR REMUNERATION POLICY FOR 2023
The table below illustrates the operation of the remuneration policy and provide estimates of the potential future remuneration 
that Executive Directors would receive, in the scenarios shown, in accordance with the directors’ remuneration policy for 2023. 
 
Potential outcomes based on different performance scenarios are provided for each Executive Director. A significant percentage 
of remuneration is linked to performance, particularly at maximum levels. 
 
The chart illustrates the remuneration that could be paid to each of the executive directors, based on salaries at the start of the 
financial year 2023. 
2.5m
2.0m
1.5m
1.0m
0.5m
0
Minimum
Threshhold
Maximum
0.710m
1.123m
2.360m
(£m)
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
Value of Package (£m)
Minimum
Threshhold
Maximum
0.376m
0.637m
1.419m
CHIEF OPERATING OFFICER
Value of Package (£m)
Minimum
Threshhold
Maximum
0.309m
0.773m
1.237m
CHIEF FINANCE OFFICER
Value of Package (£m)
Fixed Elements
Annual Bonus
LTIP
+
+
=
Fixed
Annual 
Bonus
LTIP
Total
The value of LTIP for the CEO with a share price gain of 50% is £1,237500, the value for the COO with a share price gain of 50% is £720,000 and the value for the CFO with a 
share price gain of 50% is £680,625. Fixed elements take Benefit cost from 2022 and the costs could increase in 2023. Base salary is as at 01.01.23

86
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT
POLICY ON NEW APPOINTMENTS AS AN EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR 
The table below sets out the principles which would be applied by the company when agreeing the components of a remuneration 
package for a newly appointed executive director. 
New appointments as executive director 
Reward Element 
Base Salary 
Base salary in accordance with policy detailed within the remuneration policy table at page 80
Benefits 
Will be provided in accordance with the policy within the remuneration policy table at page 81
LTIP 
Eligible to participate in the LTIP, as described in the remuneration policy table at page 83
Pension 
Pension contributions for new executive directors will not exceed the rate available to the wider workforce. 
Annual Bonus 
Eligible to participate in the annual bonus plan in operation as described in the remuneration policy table at page 82 
SAYE 
Eligible to participate in the SAYE, as described in the remuneration policy table at page 82 
Buy Outs  
In order to facilitate the external recruitment of executive directors, it may be necessary for the Committee to consider 
buying out existing incentive awards which would be forfeit on the individual leaving their current employment. The 
Committee would seek, where possible, to provide a buy out structure which was consistent with the forfeited awards 
in terms of quantum, vesting period and performance conditions. 
POLICY ON NEW APPOINTMENTS AS 
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR
The company’s policy on non-executive director remuneration 
is detailed on page 84. New appointments of non-executive 
directors will be made consistent with this policy.  
HOW EMPLOYEES’ PAY IS TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT IN 
EXECUTIVE REMUNERATION 
Pay and conditions elsewhere in the Group were considered 
when finalising the current remuneration package for executive 
directors, and the Remuneration Committee reviewed 
workforce remuneration and related policies to ensure rewards 
and incentives were aligned with the culture when developing 
and setting the policy for executive director remuneration. 
The Committee continues to be updated throughout the year 
on salary increases and the levels of annual bonus awards, 
and proposed changes to remuneration policy and practice 
for the wider Group, ensuring that changes to remuneration 
policy below board level remain consistent and transparent 
with those implemented or proposed for executive directors. 
In addition, the Committee continues to oversee participation 
in long term incentives for below Board level associates. As a 
result, the Committee is aware of how typical employee total 
remuneration compares to the potential total remuneration of 
executive directors. 
 
During 
2022 
the 
Company 
introduced 
an 
Associate 
Engagement survey, Your Voice, and collected feedback 
from the whole workforce on a range of topics, on both a 
quantitative and qualitative basis. This feedback has been used 
to shape and influence improvements to reward processes, 
including the introduction of an annual pay review process in 
2023. 
The Company continues to ensure associates have regular 
access to updates and information concerning the financial 
performance of the Company through various communication 
channels.
 
HOW ARE SHAREHOLDERS’ VIEWS TAKEN INTO 
ACCOUNT WHEN DETERMINING EXECUTIVE 
COMPENSATION PACKAGES? 
The Board considers shareholder feedback received in relation 
to the AGM each year at a meeting immediately following the 
AGM and any action required is built into the Remuneration 
Committee’s business for the ensuing period. This, and any 
additional feedback received from shareholders from time 
to time, is then considered by the Committee as part of the 
Company’s annual review of remuneration policy. 
 
During 2022 and early 2023, the Remuneration Committee 
undertook a review of the remuneration policy, taking into 
account developments in remuneration policy, as well as 
prevailing market practice and considering the views of our 
major shareholders. The Acting Remuneration Committee 
Chairman continues to make himself available to shareholders 
to discuss specific matters arising from our remuneration 
policy proposals. The outcome of this exercise forms the basis 
of the remuneration policy detailed in the future policy table 
above. The Chairman of the Remuneration Committee aims to 
maintain regular contact with our major shareholders at key 
points during the year to ensure we are fully aware of their 
prevailing thinking on our remuneration policies. 

87
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
DIRECTOR’S SERVICE CONTRACTS AND EXIT PAYMENTS 
Executive directors are appointed under service contracts of 
indefinite duration (with a 12 month notice period), whereas 
non-executive directors each have a fixed term appointment 
letter renewable upon expiry at the company’s discretion. 
Appointments of new non-executive directors and renewals 
of existing appointments are on three-year fixed terms. When 
considering the re-appointment of a non-executive director, 
the Board reviews their attendance at, and participation in, 
meetings and their overall performance, and also takes into 
account the balance of skills and experience of the Board as 
a whole. 
EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR APPOINTMENTS
The service contract of executive director Martin Casha 
commenced on 20 December 1999.
The service contract of Mark Willis commenced on 08 April 
2019, and was also refreshed in December 2019. 
The service contract of Bill Berman commenced on 01 October 
2019 for the purposes of performing the role of interim 
executive chairman, and was also refreshed in December 
2019. On appointment to the role of chief executive officer on 
19 February 2020, Bill Berman was issued with a new service 
contract. 
EXIT PAYMENTS
Each executive service contract may be terminated by the 
company giving one year’s  notice. The company would 
expect any future executive director appointments to contain 
the same terms as to notice periods. Executive director 
appointment terms do not contain any entitlement to any 
predetermined compensation or severance payments in the 
event of cessation in office or employment as a consequence 
of a takeover. Service contracts and letters of appointment 
are kept for inspection at the company’s registered office. 
With regard to the circumstances under which the current 
executive directors might leave service, the possible payments 
that may be anticipated are described in the table below:- 
NATURE OF 
BENEFIT
REASON FOR LEAVING  
“Bad” leaver (e.g. 
resignation) 
“Good” 
leaver 
Departure on 
Agreed Terms 
Change of control
Salary in Lieu 
of notice period
No salary in lieu of notice 
paid on resignations unless 
in the interests of the com-
pany to do so
Up to a maximum of 100% 
of salary (e.g. redundancy). 
Normal practice would be 
for phased payment
Treatment will depend on 
the circum- stances of the 
leaver event, subject to 
the discretion of the Remu-
neration Committee, and 
the terms of any termination 
agreement
Contractual entitlements 
will be honoured
Pension and 
benefits 
Provided for period of 
notice period served. No 
benefits provided for peri-
ods after actual cessation 
of service unless in the 
interests of the company 
to do so
Up to one year’s worth of 
pension and benefits (e.g. 
redundancy). Possible pay-
ment of pension and insured 
benefits triggered by the 
leaver event (this would be 
governed by the terms of 
the benefits provided)
Bonus
None
Yes (discretion to pay 
pro-rata based on compa-
ny’s performance) 
Discretion on the proportion 
of awards vesting based on 
performance against targets 
and the performance period 
that has lapsed 
Long-term 
incentive 
entitlements 
Lapse
Discretion to allow up to full 
vesting, based on com-
pany’s performance, with 
normal practice to be for 
pro rata vesting based on 
the proportion of the per-
formance period served
Other payments 
None
Disbursements such as con-
tribution to legal costs
Disbursements such as con-
tribution to legal costs
FEES FROM EXTERNAL DIRECTORSHIPS
None of the executive directors holds office as a non-executive 
director of other companies. Accordingly, the company does 
not have a formal policy on whether or not an executive 
director may keep fees gained from holding an external non- 
executive directorship or similar. This would be decided on a 
case by case basis.

88
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS’ APPOINTMENTS
THE COMMITTEE’S WORK IN 2022
•	
determined annual bonus awards in respect of 2021 
performance
•	
set and revised the annual bonus plan terms for 2022
•	
determined performance targets and granted LTIP 
awards in July 2022
•	
noted remuneration trends across the Group
•	
considered the gender pay gap report
•	
embarked on  search for a new Remuneration 
Committee Chair
ADVISERS
During 2022, the Committee received external advice from 
PwC, who received fees of £103,000 in respect of the same. 
The Group General Counsel also acts as secretary to the 
Committee. The Group General Counsel and the Chief People 
Officer also provided additional advice. 
Name
Commencement
Expiry/cessation
Unexpired at date of report (months)
Brian Small
10.12.19
31.12.25
33
Nikki Flanders
13.03.20
31.12.23
9
Dietmar Exler
20.04.20
31.12.23
9
Ian Filby
01.11.21
31.12.24
21
HISTORY OF CHIEF EXECUTIVE REMUNERATION 
In terms of the single total figure of remuneration for executive 
directors in 2022, shareholders should be aware that no long 
term incentives vested in 2022.  For 2021, the data in the LTIP 
column in the single total figure of remuneration for executive 
directors table on page 89 for 2021 reflects the outcome of 
the October 2020 and July 2021 LTIP awards at the equivalent 
of base salary, and is included in the table as the applicable 
performance period concluded at the end of the financial year 
2021. The awards themselves do not vest until October 2023 
and July 2024 respectively.
Chief Executive
2022
20211
restated5
2020
20192
2018
2017
2016
2015
 2014
 2013
Total Remuneration £k (single figure)
1,313
3,5611
510
464
589
727
1,605
1,775
3,472
2,961
Annual bonus award (% of maximum
that could have been paid)
73%
100%
100%3
0%
0%
30%
87%
100%
100%
100%
Percentage of LTIP vesting3 
0%
0%4
0%
0%
0%
0%
100%
56%
100%
100%
1. Of the single total remuneration figure attributable to 2021 of £3,561k, £2,016k is the cash equivalent as a percentage of salary for LTIPs awarded in October 2020 
and July 2021, which do not vest until October 2023 and July 2024 respectively. The CEO did not receive a cash payment in 2021 of £3,561k: actual payment received 
in 2021 was £1,545k. 
2. Total remuneration for the chief executive role in 2019 has been calculated based on total remuneration paid to the holder of the role of chief executive officer for 
the period from 01.01.2019 to 30.06.2019, with the total remuneration payable for full reporting period based on extrapolated data assuming the last holder of the role 
of chief executive officer had continued in the role at the same level of remuneration to the end of the full reporting period. 
3. The annual bonus awarded in 2020 was for the period 01 July 2020 to 31 December 2020 with a reduced maximum level of quantum available.
4. Percentage of shares vesting under the Pendragon Long Term Incentive Plan against the maximum number of shares that could have been received; the October 
2020 LTIP vests in October 2023, the July 2021 LTIP vests in July 2024, following the satisfaction of applicable performance conditions, such that it was determined 
that 91.6% of the maximum available under the awards would vest. 
5. As declared at the 2022, AGM William Berman’s expatriate benefit of overseas healthcare and tax support were previously not disclosed and were under reported: 
this has now been rectified above. (For healthcare £144k in 2021 and £118k in 2022, for tax support £2k in 2022 and £7k in 2021, car allowance was £19k in 2021 and 
£23k in 2022).
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

89
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Base Salary
£000
Taxable
benefits1
£000
Pension2
£000
Bonus3
£000
LTIP4
£000
Single total
figure
£000
Total Fixed
Remuneration
£000
Total Variable 
Remuneration
£000
2022
2021
2022
2021
restated
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
(Oct2020 
Award vests 
Oct 2023)
2021
(July 2021 
Award vests 
July 2024)
2022
2021
restated
2022
2021
restated
2022
2021
Current Directors
William Berman
550
550
143
170
17
-
603
825
0
1,260
756
1,313
3,561
710
720
603
2,841
Martin Casha
320
307
8
7
48
61
351
461
0
422
422
727
1,680
376
375
351
1,305
Mark Willis
303
303
15
14
-
-
332
454
0
694
417
650
1,882
318
317
332
1,565
1. Taxable Benefits include life assurance, private health cover in the UK & abroad if applicable, professional subscriptions, the provision of tax support for expatriate associates and the 
provision of up to two cars (at the Director’s election), one of which is fully expensed. As declared at the 2022 AGM, William Berman’s expatriate benefit of overseas healthcare and tax 
support were previously not disclosed and were under reported: this has now been rectified above. (For healthcare £144k in 2021 and £118k in 2022, for tax support £2k in 2022 and 
£7k in 2021, car allowance was £19k in 2021 and £23k in 2022). 
2. Salary supplement in lieu of pension contribution. In 2006, Martin Casha ceased to be an active member of the Pendragon defined benefit pension plan. Martin Casha elected to take 
early retirement benefits from 01.07.16 and is therefore a pensioner member. In accordance with Investment Association (IA) guidance, a phased reduction in the salary supplement 
in lieu of pension contribution received by Martin Casha has now been completed, and, as of 01 January 2023, his salary supplement in lieu of pension contribution is aligned to the 
employer pension contribution received by the relevant wider workforce.
3. Bonus Award paid in 2023 equivalent to 109.6% of base salary based on 2022 performance achievement. 
4. Although no LTIPs vested under the LTIP in 2021, given that LTIPs previously awarded in October 2020 and July 2021 vest in respect of the performance to the end of the financial 
year 2021, the Remuneration Committee assessed the performance conditions applicable to the October 2020 and July 2021 awards and determined that: (i) the EPS targets for both 
the October 2020 and July 2021 awards would be satisfied in full; and (ii) the Company had delivered significantly on stretching strategic metrics set for both awards measured over 
2021, resulting in 91.6% of the total awards vesting. The October 2020 LTIP vests in October 2023 and the July 2021 LTIP vests in July 2024.
5. Of the single total remuneration figure attributable to 2021 of £3,542k, £2,016k is the cash equivalent as a percentage of salary for LTIPs awarded in October 2020 and July 2021, 
which do not vest until October 2023 and July 2024 respectively. The CEO did not receive a cash payment in 2021 of £3,542k: actual payment received in 2021 was £1,526k (inclusive 
of benefits value).
SINGLE TOTAL FIGURE OF REMUNERATION FOR EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS AND THE INTERIM EXECUTIVE CHAIRMAN 2021 
(AUDITED INFORMATION)
SINGLE TOTAL FIGURE OF REMUNERATION FOR NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS 2022 
(AUDITED INFORMATION)
Basic Fee
£000
Taxable
benefits
£000
SID/Committee
Chair Fee
£000
Single total figure
£000
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
Current Directors
Mike Wright1
25 
50 
-
-
5 
10 
30 
60 
Dietmar Exler 
50 
50 
-
-
4 
4 
54 
54 
Ian Filby
150 
25 
-
-
- 
- 
150 
25 
Nikki Flanders
50 
50 
-
-
- 
- 
50 
50 
Brian Small
50 
50 
-
-
10 
10 
60 
60 
1. Mike Wright stood down from the Board on 01.06.22 
PENSIONS
The Pendragon Pension Plan (Pension Plan) is established for 
the benefit of the Group’s eligible employees. The Pension 
Plan operates through a trustee company which holds and 
administers its assets entirely separately from the Group’s 
assets.  There is no direct investment in Pendragon PLC
Martin Casha ceased to be an active member of the Pension 
Plan in 2006.   The non-executive directors are not eligible 
to participate in the Pension Plan. New executive directors 
are invited to participate in the Pension Plan, should they so 
wish, with any pension contributions being in line with wider 
workforce.  

90
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
PERFORMANCE RELATED PAY FOR 2022: ANNUAL BONUS
Given their commercial sensitivity, we do not publish the 
details of targets in advance. However, the Committee 
considered the targets to be measurable and appropriately 
stretching at point of award.  For 2022, the maximum annual 
bonus opportunity was 150% of base salary, only achievable 
for performance 25% in excess of the Company’s target 
underlying profit based on the FY 2021 Corporate Plan. The 
2022 bonus performance metric was set as underlying profit 
for the full year, determined in accordance with a combination 
of the Company’s 2021 Corporate Plan and Broker Consensus, 
this was considered to be both reflective of the continued 
uncertain trading background, but also based on a realistic 
assessment of the Company’s trading prospects for the full 
year at the time of the award.  
Details of percentage of salary payable at threshold, target 
and maximum are set out in the table below, together with the 
actual outturn for 2022.  As the committee determined that 
underlying profit was achieved slightly above the target set, 
bonus was determined to be payable at 109.6% on a straight 
line vesting principle. 
Target aligned to 
2021 Corporate 
Plan
Percentage of basic 
salary payable
Underlying Profit 
Outcome based on 
A Combination of 
the 2021 Corporate 
Plan and Market 
Consensus 
Actual Outturn 
FY2022 Underlying 
Profit
% of Maximum 
Bonus Awarded
Payout: % of basic 
salary payable
Threshold (equal to 
20% below Target)
25%
£43,920,000
Target (Achieving 
Mix of 2021 Corpo-
rate Plan & Market 
Consensus)
100%
£54,900,000
£57,600,000
73%
109.6%
Maximum (Equal to  
25% above Target)
150%
£68,625,000
LONG TERM INCENTIVES VESTING IN 2022
There were no awards vesting in respect of the long-term 
incentive plan for the period ending 2022.
LONG TERM INCENTIVE PLAN AWARDS (“LTIP”) 
AWARDED IN 2022
In August 2022, the Committee granted awards in the form of 
nil cost share options pursuant to the Company’s LTIP to the 
executive directors.  Vesting of the Awards under the LTIP is 
subject to the satisfaction of certain performance conditions. 
70% is based on achieving a defined earnings per share target. 
5%  is based on an ESG metric to achieve a reduction in the 
Company’s overall Carbon Emissions. 25% is based on Strategic 
Metrics aligned to the Company’s Strategy.  Each Strategic 
Metric has a defined financial metric outlining the achievement 
required for both target and maximum pay out.  All metrics 
are based over a 3 year performance period, commencing 
on 01 January 2022 and measured at year end 2024. 
The committee discussed the opportunity to introduce 
a relative TSR metric as part of the 2022 LTIP.  Upon 
receiving advice and benchmarking data from our advisors 
it was identified that finding a relative group was extremely 
difficult. The committee was unable to find a relative 
group that’s TSR had moved in the same direction (when 
measured over a 5 year period) as Pendragon’s TSR. 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

91
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Element of Pay 
Implementation of Policy
BASE SALARY 
Other than potential adjustments to take account of market conditions and changes in role scope to reflect 
additional responsibilities undertaken, base salary will continue to be set in accordance with the remuneration 
policy.  We intend to carry out a full review of the current salaries for executives, considering appropriate 
benchmarking data, and internal and external factors following the appointment of the new Remuneration 
Committee Chair. 
 
Base salaries for 2023: 
•	
Chief Executive Officer: £550,000 
•	
Chief Finance Officer: £302,500 
•	
Chief Operating Officer: £347,582 
BENEFITS 
No changes are expected to be made to these elements of remuneration within the financial year ending 31 
December 2023. 
PENSION 
Currently each Executive Director is on an individual pension arrangement, and these will now be aligned to 
one approach. 
During 2022 we undertook a review of the pension provisions available to our wider workforce and increased 
the company contribution to 6% for leaders in the business.  
Our Executive Directors will receive an equivalent pension contribution of 6%, from January 2023 a year later 
than the change for other leaders in the business. 
The Chief Operating Officer ceased to be an active member of the Pension Plan in 2006. In accordance 
with the Code, the company is seeking to align his pension with that the wider workforce and has effected 
a phased reduction in the salary supplement in lieu of pension contribution received by the Chief Operating 
Officer such since 01 January 2023, his salary supplement in lieu of pension contribution is aligned to the 
employer pension contribution available to the relevant wider workforce. 
ANNUAL BONUS 
The bonus opportunity for the executive directors remains at a maximum opportunity of 150% of base salary, 
payable at the maximum level only for significant outperformance against the corporate plan. 
The targets for the 2023 annual bonus will be disclosed retrospectively in the 2023 Director’s Remuneration 
Report as the Committee deems them to be commercially sensitive. 
The bonus metric for 2023 will be based on achieving underlying profit before tax against the corporate plan. 
25% of after tax bonus earned will be subject to compulsory deferral into the company’s shares until such 
time as the company’s share ownership guidelines are met. 
LONG TERM INCENTIVE 
PLAN 
The proposed LTIP will have a maximum opportunity of 150% of salary, with no exceptional maximum. Any 
awards will also be subject to a three year performance and two year holding period.  
For 2023 specifically the measures will be 70% EPS, 24% strategic, financial metrics and 6% on ESG, focusing 
equally on carbon and diversity.  
The committee is currently considering the appropriate financial metrics as performance conditions for the 
strategic element.   
SHAREHOLDING 
GUIDELINES 
The minimum shareholding requirement for the CEO is 200% of salary (100% for all other Executive Direc-
tors), to be built up within 5 years of appointment to the board. 
Until such time as the policy is met, Executive Directors will be required to hold any vested deferred bonus 
shares and LTIP awards that vest (after sale of shares to cover associated personal tax liabilities). 
MALUS AND CLAWBACK 
Malus and clawback will continue to operate in respect of the annual bonus and long-term incentive plan, in 
accordance with the parameters detailed in the remuneration policy.  
IMPLEMENTATION OF THE REMUNERATION POLICY IN THE FINANCIAL YEAR ENDING 31 DECEMBER 2023 
The Committee envisages that there will be limited changes arising from the implementation of the remuneration policy during 
financial year ending 31 December 2023. The policy in respect of the executive directors will be applied as follows: 

92
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
2012            2013            2014            2015             2016            2017           2018            2019            2020            2021	
2022	
         
 PENDRAGON PLC - TOTAL RETURN INDEX    
 FTSE SMALL CAP EX INV. TRUSTS - TOTAL RETURN INDEX
PENDRAGON PLC TSR 2012 - 2022
1. This report is required, pursuant to the Large and Medium sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) (Amendment) Regulations 2013, regulation 18, Performance Graph. 
2. Total Shareholder Return (“TSR”) is calculated over the ten years ended on 31 December 2022 and reflects the theoretical growth in the value of a shareholding over that period, 
assuming dividends (if any) are reinvested in shares in the company. The price at which dividends are reinvested is assumed to be the amount equal to the closing price of the shares on 
the ex- dividend date plus the gross amount of annual dividend. The calculation ignores tax and reinvestment charges. For each company in the index, the TSR statistics are normalised 
to a common start point, which gives the equivalent to investing the same amount of money in each company at that time. The percentage growth in TSR is measured over the chosen 
period. To obtain TSR growth of the relevant index over the chosen period, the weighted average of TSR for all the companies in the index is calculated. In this case, it is the FTSE Small 
Cap Index (excluding investment companies) as explained in Note 3. The weighting is by reference to the market capitalisation of each company in the index in proportion to the total 
market capitalisation of all the companies in the index at the end of the chosen measurement period. 
3. The FTSE Small CAP index has been selected as it represents the equity market in which the Company was a constituent member for the majority of the relevant seven year period 
ending 31 December 2022 detailed above. 
TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN1    
The graph below shows the total shareholder return (“TSR”)2 
on the company’s shares in comparison to the FTSE Small 
Cap Index (excluding investment companies).3 TSR has been 
calculated as the percentage change, during the relevant 
period, in the market price of the shares, assuming that any 
dividends paid are reinvested on the ex-dividend date. The 
relevant period is the ten years ending 31 December 2019. The 
notes at the foot of the graph provide more detail of the TSR 
calculation. 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

93
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
DIRECTORS’ SHAREHOLDINGS (AUDITED)
Number of shares 
held outright
Awards over 
nil-cost options
Shareholding 
requirement 
(% of base 
salary)
Shareholding as 
at 31 December 
2022 incl 
shares not 
subject to 
performance 
requirements
(% of base 
salary)
As at 31 
December 
2022
As at 31 
December 
2021
Vested but 
not exer-
cised
Unvested 
and subject 
to continued 
employment
Unvested and subject 
to performance 
conditions and continued 
employment
Executive Directors
William Berman
1,462,114
Nil
-
12,910,581
3,478,077
200%
501%
Martin Casha
11,098,524
9,559,780
-
5,135,844
2,026,003
100%
974%
Mark Willis
804,163
Nil
-
7,100,785
1,912,942
100%
500%
Non Executive Directors
Dietmar Exler
210,000
210,000
-
-
-
N/A
N/A
Nikki Flanders
Nil
N/A
-
-
-
N/A
N/A
Brian Small
400,000
400,000
-
-
-
N/A
N/A
Ian Filby
Nil
N/A
-
-
-
N/A
N/A
PERCENTAGE CHANGE IN CHIEF EXECUTIVE REMUNERATION
The table below illustrates the percentage change in the remuneration awarded to the Directors over the last 3 years and that 
of the group’s employees across its entire UK business. 
DIRECTORS’ SHAREHOLDINGS (AUDITED)
The shareholdings of all Directors, including the shareholdings of their connected persons as at 31 December 2022, are set out 
below. There have been no changes in the Directors’ interests from 31 December 2022 to the date of this report. 
The CEO has a shareholding requirement of 200% of salary, with other Executive Directors having a shareholding requirement 
of 100% of salary.  There is no company policy on non-executive director share ownership.  This was considered by the 
Remuneration Committee during 2022 and as our NEDs actively look to purchase shares, we do not feel it is necessary to have 
a minimum shareholding requirement for non-executives at this time. We will continue to monitor any evolutions in UK best 
practice to determine if this should change in future. 
Salary/Fees
Benefits
Bonus (Including deferred 
amount)(% of base salary)
2022
2021
2020
2022
2021
2020
2022
2021
2020
Executive Directors
Chief Executive
0.0%
7.8%
105.6%
-15.9%
-
-
-26.9%
99.8%
100.0%
Chief Operating 
Officer
4.2%
7.0%
-1.7%
14.3%
-22.2%
0.0%
-23.9%
103.1%
-
Chief Finance 
Officer
0.0%
3.8%
30.9%
15.4%
30.0%
400.0%
-26.9%
101.8%
-
Non Executive Directors
Ian Filby
0.0%
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Dietmar Exler
0.0%
42.9%
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Nikki Flanders
0.0%
38.9%
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Brian Small
0.0%
-3.8%
1633.3%
-
-
-
-
-
-
All Employees 
(average)
8.7%
7.0%
8.1%
-27.0%
-33.3%
0.0%
12.1%
39%
-
1.Additional benefits allowance for 2022 inclusive of car allowance for CFO. The high percentage relates to the relatively low figures of £4k for 2021 and £15k for 2022 resulting in this 
percentage appearing inflated. As declared at the 2021 AGM William Berman’s expatriate benefit of overseas healthcare and tax support were previously not disclosed in error and were 
under reported this has now been rectified in the calculation above.

94
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SHAREHOLDERS’ VOTE ON REMUNERATION AT THE 2022 AGM
SHARE PRICE INFORMATION AND PERFORMANCE
Other than those detailed above, there are no share option or long term incentive schemes in which the directors are eligible to 
participate. The middle market price of Pendragon ordinary shares at 31 December 2022 was 19.2 pence and the range during 
the year was 17.6 pence to 28.8 pence. 
2021 Directors’ Remuneration Report
Number
Proportion of votes cast
Votes cast in favour
380,612,034 
34.49 
Votes cast against
722,783,233 
65.51 
Total votes cast in favour or against
1,103,395,267 
100% 
Votes withheld
23,063,508  
0% 
RELATIVE IMPORTANCE OF SPEND ON PAY
The table below illustrates the year-on-year change in total team member pay (being the aggregate of staff costs as set out in 
note 2.4 to the financial statements and distributions to shareholders (being declared dividends). 
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER PAY RATIO
The table below shows our chief executive officer pay ratio at 25th, median and 75th percentiles of our UK associates. The ratios 
have been calculated based on the single total figure of remuneration for the chief executive officer and the total pay for the 
associates based on our gender pay gap data under Option B of The Companies (Miscellaneous Reporting) Regulations 2018. 
We have used Option B as the Company has already completed comprehensive data collection and analysis for the purposes 
of gender pay gap reporting, and continues to do so on a monthly basis. The gender pay gap data used was collated on 31 
December 2022. 
Financial year
Method
25th percentile pay ratio 
(lower quartile)
Median pay ratio
(median)
75th percentile pay ratio 
(upper quartile)
2022
Option B
 26:1
25:1
16:1
2021
Option B
30:1
25:1
19:1
2020
Option B
30:1
26:1
20:1
1. Total pay for the percentile employees taken from our gender pay gap data includes the following pay elements: base salary, holiday pay, hourly pay, national minimum wage top ups, car 
allowance, acting up allowance, monthly advances, team member vouchers subject to national insurance, benefit schemes, statutory sick pay, maternity pay and paternity pay. Associates 
w ho have not received pay (in terms of salary and adjustments) but has still received other salary payments are excluded from our gender pay gap data.
Team member pay
Distribution to shareholders
2022 (£m)
2021 (£m)
% change
2022
2021
% change
£241.5m
£210.3m
14.8%
£0m
£0m
-
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT

95
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
AREA 
Implementation
CLARITY 
The committee is committed to providing transparent disclosures to shareholders and the workforce about 
executive remuneration arrangements. The director’s remuneration report sets out the detail of such ar-
rangements in a clear and transparent way. Our AGM allows shareholders to ask questions on remuneration 
arrangements 
SIMPLICITY  
Our remuneration arrangements for executive directors are simple in nature and understood by all partic-
ipants, having operated in a similar manner for a number of years. Executive directors receive fixed pay 
(salary, benefits, pension) and participate in a single short term annual bonus and a single long-term incentive 
plan (LTIP) 
PREDICATABILITY 
Payouts under the annual bonus and LTIP schemes are dependent on Company performance over the short 
and long term and are governed by achievement against set targets. These schemes have strict maximum 
opportunities, which are outlined in the directors remuneration report. 
RISK 
The committee has designed incentives that do not encourage inappropriate risk-taking. The committee 
retain discretion in both the annual bonus and LTIP schemes to adjust payouts where the formulaic outcomes 
are not considered reflective of underlying performance and individual contribution. Robust withholding and 
recovery provisions apply to variable incentives.  
PROPORTIONALITY  
Payouts from variable incentive schemes require strong performance against challenging conditions over the 
short and longer term. Performance conditions have been selected to support group strategy and consist of 
both financial and non-financial metrics. The committee retains discretion to override formulaic outcomes in 
both schemes to ensure they are appropriate and reflective of overall performance.
ALIGNMENT TO CULTURE 
Performance measures used in our variable incentive schemes are selected to be consistent with the Compa-
ny’s purpose, values and strategy. The use of annual bonus deferral, LTIP holding periods and our sharehold-
ing requirement provide a clear link to the ongoing performance of the group and ensures alignment with 
shareholders.  
SHAREHOLDER APPROVED REMUNERATION POLICY 
The following table summarises how our shareholder approved remuneration policy fulfills the factors set out in provision 40 of 
the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code. 
APPROVAL
This report was approved by the Committee and signed on its behalf by:
Ian Filby
Acting Chairman of the Remuneration Committee
22 March 2023

96
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
STRATEGIC REVIEW AND PRESCRIBED REPORTING
Our Strategic Review at pages 25 to 32 contains the information, 
prescribed by the Companies Act 2006, required to present 
a fair review of the company’s business, a description of the 
principal risks and uncertainties it faces, and certain of the 
information on which reports and statements are required by 
the UK Corporate Governance Code. The Board approved the 
Strategic Review set out on pages 25 to 32 and the Viability 
Statement set out on page 49. Additional information on 
which the directors are required by law to report is set out 
below and in the following:-
•	
Environmental, Social and Governance Report
•	
Board of Directors
•	
Audit Committee Report
•	
Nomination Committee Report
•	
Directors’ Remuneration Report
•	
Directors’ Report
•	
Directors’ Responsibility Statement
In the interests of increasing the relevance of the Report 
and reducing the environmental impacts of over-lengthy 
printed reports, we have placed on our website at certain 
background information on the company the disclosure of 
which, in this Report, is not mandatory.  We monitor reaction 
to the publication of shareholder information on our website, 
to help shape our shareholder communication and future 
improvements.
RESULTS AND DIVIDENDS
The results of the Group for the year are set out in the financial 
statements on pages 112 to 196. No interim dividend was 
paid during the year, and the directors are not proposing to 
recommend a final dividend for the year ended 31 December 
2022.  
APPOINTMENT AND POWERS
OF THE COMPANY’S DIRECTORS
Appointment and removal of directors is governed by the 
company’s articles of association (the Articles), the UK 
Corporate Governance Code (the Code), the Companies 
Acts and related legislation. Subject to the Articles (which 
shareholders may amend by special resolution), relevant 
legislation and any directions given by special resolution, the 
company and its group is managed by its board of directors. 
By resolutions passed at company general meetings, the 
shareholders have authorised the directors: (i) to allot and 
issue ordinary shares; (ii) to offer and allot ordinary shares in 
lieu of some or all of the dividends; and (iii) to make market 
purchases of the company’s ordinary shares (in practice, 
exercised only if the directors expect it to result in an increase 
in earnings per share). Details of movements in the company’s 
share capital are given in note 4.4 to the financial statements. 
From time to time, Pendragon provides financial assistance 
to its independent employee benefits trust to facilitate the 
market purchase of ordinary shares in the company for use in 
connection with various of the company’s employee incentive 
schemes.  The company did not purchase any shares in this 
way in 2022. 
BUSINESS AT THE AGM
At the AGM, a separate shareholders’ resolution is proposed 
for each substantive matter.  We will issue to our shareholders 
the company’s annual report and financial statements together 
with the notice of AGM, giving not less than the requisite period 
of notice. The notice sets out the resolutions the directors are 
proposing and has explanatory notes for each. At the AGM, 
directors’ terms of appointment are available for inspection 
and, as well as dealing with formal AGM business, the Board 
takes the opportunity to give an update to shareholders on 
the company’s trading position.   The Chairman and each 
committee chairman are available to answer questions put by 
shareholders present.
DIRECTORS AND THEIR INTERESTS IN SHARES
Current directors are listed on pages 66 and 67. Details of the 
terms of appointment and notice period of each of the current 
directors, together with executives directors’ respective 
interests in shares under the company’s long term incentive 
plan (non-executive directors have none), appear in the 
Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 77 to 95. Directors 
who served during 2022 and their respective interests in the 
company’s issued ordinary share capital are shown in the 
table below.  All holdings shown are beneficial. None of the 
directors holds options over company shares, other than nil 
paid options pursuant to the LTIP as described on page 93 in 
the director’s remuneration report. Executive directors will aim 
to fulfil the requirements of the company’s share ownership 
policy applicable to them within five years of appointment. 
There is no company policy requiring non-executive directors 
to hold a minimum number of company shares.
DIRECTORS’ ROTATION
The UK Corporate Governance Code (July 2018) imposes an 
obligation that all Directors should be subject to annual re-
election.  
DIRECTORS’ REPORT

97
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEMNITIES TO DIRECTORS
In line with market practice and the company’s Articles, 
each director has the benefit of a deed of indemnity from 
the company, which includes provisions in relation to duties 
as a director of the company or an associated company, 
qualifying third party indemnity provisions and protection 
against derivative actions.  Copies of these are available for 
shareholders’ inspection at the AGM.
SHARE CAPITAL
As at 31 December 2022, Pendragon’s issued share capital 
comprised a single class: ordinary shares of 5 pence each. The 
Articles permit the creation of more than one class of share, 
but there is currently none other than ordinary shares. Details 
of the company’ share capital are set out in note 4.4 to the 
accounts.  All issued shares are fully paid. The company did 
not issue any new shares during the period under review.  The 
rights and obligations attaching to the company’s ordinary 
shares are set out in the Articles.    The Company is currently 
authorised to issue up to two-thirds of its current issued share 
capital pursuant to a resolution passed at its 2022 AGM.
SIGNIFICANT DIRECT OR INDIRECT SHAREHOLDINGS
At 6 March 2023 the directors had been advised of the 
following interests in the shares of the company:- 
VOTING RIGHTS, RESTRICTIONS ON VOTING RIGHTS 
AND DEADLINES FOR VOTING RIGHTS
Shareholders (other than any who, under the Articles or the 
terms of the shares they hold, are not entitled to receive such 
notices) have the right to receive notice of, and to attend and 
to vote at, all general and (if any) applicable class meetings of 
the company. A resolution put to the vote at any general or 
class meeting is decided on a show of hands unless (before 
or on the declaration of the result of the show of hands or 
on the withdrawal of any other demand for a poll) a poll is 
properly demanded. At a general meeting, every member 
present in person has, upon a show of hands, one vote, and on 
a poll, every member has one vote for every 5 pence nominal 
amount of share capital of which they are the holder.  In the 
case of joint holders of a share, the vote of the member whose 
name stands first in the register of members is accepted to 
the exclusion of any vote tendered by any other joint holder. 
Unless the Board decides otherwise, a shareholder may not 
vote at any general or class meeting or exercise any rights in 
relation to meetings whilst any amount of money relating to 
his shares remains outstanding.
A member is entitled to appoint a proxy to exercise all or any 
of their rights to attend and speak and vote on their behalf 
at a general meeting.  Further details regarding voting can 
Directors’ shareholdings
Number at 31.12.22
Number at 31.12.21
William Berman
1,462,114
nil
Martin Casha
11,098,524
9,559,780
Dietmar Exler
210,000
210,000
Ian Filby
nil
n/a
Nikki Flanders
nil
n/a
Mark Willis
804,163
nil
Brian Small
400,000
400,000
Shareholder
Number of shares
Percentage of voting rights 
of the issued share capital 
Anders Hedin Invest AB    
366,424,322 
27.59
Schroders
163,016,559
11.69
Briarwood Chase Management
140,127,084
10.03
Odey Asset Management
137,411,576
9.84
Hosking Partners
67,176,942
4.81
Bank of America
44,910,795
3.21
Dimensional Fund Advisors
44,886,911
3.21
Farringdon Capital Management
31,298,235
2.24
Barclays Bank
30,693,280
2.20
Huntington Partners
28,058,810
2.01

98
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
By order of the Board
Richard Maloney
Company Secretary
22 March 2023
be found in the notes to the notice of the AGM.  Details of 
the exercise of voting rights attached to the ordinary shares 
held by the company’s Employee Benefit Trust are set out 
below.  None of the ordinary shares, including those held by 
the Employee Benefit Trust, carries any special voting rights 
with regard to control of the company.  
To be effective, electronic and paper proxy appointments 
and voting instructions must be received by the company’s 
registrars not later than 48 hours before a general meeting.
The Articles may be obtained from Companies House in the 
UK or upon application to the company secretary. Other 
than those prescribed by applicable law and the company’s 
procedures for ensuring compliance with it, there are no 
specific restrictions on the size of a holding nor on the transfer 
of shares, which are governed by the Articles and prevailing 
legislation. The directors are not aware of any agreement 
between holders of the company’s shares that may result 
in restrictions on the transfer of securities or the exercise of 
voting rights. No person has any special rights of control over 
the company’s share capital.
SHARES HELD BY THE PENDRAGON
EMPLOYEE BENEFIT TRUST
As at 31 December 2022, the company’s Employee Benefit 
Trust with Accuro Trustees (Jersey) Limited (the Trustee) held 
1,541,801 shares, representing 0.11% of the total issued share 
capital at that date (2021: 5,846,832; 0.46%).  The Trustee has 
waived its voting rights attached to these shares.  It holds these 
shares to enable it to satisfy entitlements under the company’s 
share schemes. During the year, the Trustee transferred 
500,000 shares to satisfy such entitlements (2021:573,258). 
In addition, a further 5,918,024 shares were transferred by the 
Trustee in respect of the award of the director’s 2020 bonus 
as deferred shares.  
   
CONTRACTS
None of the directors had an interest in any contract with the 
Group (other than their service agreement or appointment 
terms and routine purchases of vehicles for their own use) 
at any time during 2022.  The company and members of its 
group are party to agreements relating to banking, properties, 
employee share plans and motor vehicle franchises which alter 
or terminate if the company or group company concerned 
undergoes a change of control. None is considered significant 
in terms of its likely impact on the business of the Group as a 
whole.
POLITICAL DONATIONS
The company and its group made no political donations (2021: 
£ nil).
AUDITOR
The directors who held office at the date of approval of this 
directors’ report confirm that: so far as they are each aware, 
there is no relevant audit information of which the Group’s 
auditors are unaware; and each director has taken all the steps 
that they ought to have taken as a director to make themself 
aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that 
the Group’s auditors are aware of that information.  
DIRECTORS’ REPORT

99
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
100	 Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities in Respect 
	
of the Annual Report and Financial Statements
101 Independent Auditor’s Report to the Members of 
	
Pendragon PLC
112	
Consolidated Income Statement	
113	
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
114	 Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
115	
Consolidated Balance Sheet	
116 
Consolidated Cash Flow Statement
117 
Reconciliation of Net Cash Flow to Movement 
	
in Adjusted Net Debt	
118	
Notes to the Financial Statements	
197	 Company Balance Sheet	
198	 Company Statement of Comprehensive Income
199	 Company Statement of Changes in Equity
200	 Notes to the Financial Statements of the Company
209	 Advisors, Banks and Shareholder Information
210 5 Year Group Review
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

100
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
The directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report 
and the Group and parent Company financial statements in 
accordance with applicable law and regulations.  
Company law requires the directors to prepare Group and 
parent Company financial statements for each financial year. 
Under that law they are required to prepare the Group financial 
statements in accordance with UK-adopted international 
accounting standards and applicable law and have elected 
to prepare the parent Company financial statements in 
accordance with UK accounting standards and applicable law, 
including FRS 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework. 
Under company law the directors must not approve the 
financial statements unless they are satisfied that they give 
a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and 
parent Company and of the Group’s profit or loss for that 
period.  In preparing each of the Group and parent Company 
financial statements, the directors are required to:  
•	
select suitable accounting policies and then apply them 
consistently;  
•	
make judgements and estimates that are reasonable, 
relevant, reliable and prudent;  
•	
for the Group financial statements, state whether they 
have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted 
international accounting standards;  
•	
for the parent Company financial statements, state 
whether applicable UK accounting standards have been 
followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and 
explained in the parent Company financial statements;   
•	
assess the Group and parent Company’s ability to 
continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, 
matters related to going concern; and  
•	
use the going concern basis of accounting unless 
they either intend to liquidate the Group or the parent 
Company or to cease operations, or have no realistic 
alternative but to do so.  
The directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting 
records that are sufficient to show and explain the parent 
Company’s transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy 
at any time the financial position of the parent Company and 
enable them to ensure that its financial statements comply 
with the Companies Act 2006.  They are responsible for such 
internal control as they determine is necessary to enable the 
preparation of financial statements that are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and have general 
responsibility for taking such steps as are reasonably open to 
them to safeguard the assets of the Group and to prevent and 
detect fraud and other irregularities.  
Under applicable law and regulations, the directors are also 
responsible for preparing a Strategic Report, Directors’ Report, 
Directors’ Remuneration Report and Corporate Governance 
Statement that complies with that law and those regulations.  
The directors are responsible for the maintenance and 
integrity of the corporate and financial information included 
on the company’s website.  Legislation in the UK governing 
the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may 
differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.  
In accordance with Disclosure Guidance and Transparency 
Rule 4.1.14R, the financial statements will form part of the 
annual financial report prepared using the single electronic 
reporting format under the TD ESEF Regulation.  The auditor’s 
report on these financial statements provides no assurance 
over the ESEF format.
Responsibility statement of the Directors in respect of the 
annual financial report    
We confirm that to the best of our knowledge:  
•	
the financial statements, prepared in accordance with 
the applicable set of accounting standards, give a true 
and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position 
and profit or loss of the company and the undertakings 
included in the consolidation taken as a whole; and  
•	
the strategic report includes a fair review of the 
development and performance of the business and the 
position of the issuer and the undertakings included 
in the consolidation taken as a whole, together with a 
description of the principal risks and uncertainties that 
they face.      
We consider the annual report and accounts, taken as a 
whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the 
information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s 
position and performance, business model and strategy.  
Approved by order of the Board
Mark Willis
Chief Finance Officer
22 March 2023
STATEMENT OF DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITIES IN RESPECT 
OF THE ANNUAL REPORT AND THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 

101
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
1. Our opinion is unmodified
We have audited the financial statements of Pendragon plc (“the Company”) for the year ended 31 December 2022 which comprise 
the Consolidated Income Statement, the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income, the Consolidated and Company 
Balance Sheets, the Consolidated and Company Statements of Changes in Equity, the Consolidated Cash Flow Statement, and the 
related notes, including the accounting policies.  
In our opinion:  
•	
the financial statements give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s and of the parent Company’s affairs as at 31 
December 2022 and of the Group’s profit for the year then ended;  
•	
the Group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with UK-adopted international accounting 
standards;  
•	
the parent Company financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with UK accounting standards, 
including FRS 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework; and  
•	
the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. . 
Basis for opinion  
We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and applicable law.  Our 
responsibilities are described below.  We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is a sufficient and appropriate basis 
for our opinion.  Our audit opinion is consistent with our report to the audit committee. 
We were first appointed as auditor by the shareholders on 28 April 1997.  The period of total uninterrupted engagement is for 
the 26 financial years ended 31 December 2022.  We have fulfilled our ethical responsibilities under, and we remain independent 
of the Group in accordance with, UK ethical requirements including the FRC Ethical Standard as applied to listed public interest 
entities.  No non-audit services prohibited by that standard were provided.  
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC
Overview
Materiality: group financial 
statements as a whole   
£3.45m (2021: £4.0m)
5.0% of normalised group profit before tax 
(2021: 0.1% of normalised group revenue)*        
Coverage
92% (2021: 90%) of Group profit before tax**
Key audit matters                                                 
vs 2021
Recurring risks
Used vehicle inventory provision
Valuation of post retirement benefit obligation
Parent Company’s key audit matter: Carrying value of parent 
company's investments in subsidiaries and debt due from group 
entities
* In 2021 our materiality was based with reference to a benchmark of Group revenue, normalised by averaging over a five year period. Materiality 
represented 0.1% of this benchmark. **This is the profit and losses as a percentage of total profits and losses that made up the group profit before tax.

102
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
2. Key audit matters: including our assessment of risks of material misstatement
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in the audit of the financial 
statements and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) identified 
by us, including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; 
and directing the efforts of the engagement team.  We summarise below the key audit matters, in decreasing order of audit 
significance, in arriving at our audit opinion above, together with our key audit procedures to address those matters and, as 
required for public interest entities, our results from those procedures.  These matters were addressed, and our results are based 
on procedures undertaken, in the context of, and solely for the purpose of, our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and 
in forming our opinion thereon, and consequently are incidental to that opinion, and we do not provide a separate opinion on 
these matters. 
The risk
Our response
Used vehicle inventory 
provision (£6.9 million 
(2021: £8.0 million)
Refer to page 70 Audit 
Committee report, page 
152 (accounting policy)
and page 153 (financial   
disclosures)
Subjective valuation
The Group holds significant levels of 
used vehicle inventory. Used vehicle 
selling prices vary depending upon a 
number of factors including general 
economic conditions, the availability 
of used vehicles and the levels of 
new vehicle production.
Accounting standards require 
inventory to be held at the lower of 
cost and net realisable value. History 
has shown that the average price of 
a used vehicle may decline signifi-
cantly over a short period of time, 
and therefore the estimation of the 
net realisable value of used vehicles 
is a significant area of estimation 
uncertainty. The risk increases as the 
age of the used vehicle inventory 
increases.
The effect of these matters is that, 
as part of our risk assessment, we 
determined that the provision held 
against the carrying amount of used 
vehicles has a high degree of esti-
mation uncertainty, with a potential 
range of reasonable outcomes which 
approximates to our materiality for 
the financial statements as a whole. 
The financial statements (note 3.4) 
disclose the sensitivity estimated by 
the Group.     
Our procedures included:
• Test of controls: Evaluating the management review 
controls over the used vehicle inventory valuation 
process;
• Historical comparisons: We challenged the assump-
tions made in the used vehicle inventory provision by 
comparison to the Group’s historical trading patterns, 
including performing an analysis of the number of days 
used inventory is held by the Group. We performed a 
retrospective review of actual profits and losses made 
during 2022 in respect of inventory held at 31 December 
2021 and considered the implications for the appropri-
ateness of management's provision policy
• Independent reperformance: We considered an 
alternative methodology for assessing the valuation 
of used inventory, with reference to the fuel type and 
brand of the vehicles within used vehicle inventory at 
the year end;
• Tests of details: We assessed the appropriateness of 
the related inventory provision by comparing the losses 
incurred on used car sales subsequent to the year end 
to the level of the year end provision. We also assessed 
the Group’s methodology for calculating the provision 
by comparing net profit per unit achieved at different 
points during the financial year; and
• Assessing transparency: We assessed the adequacy of 
the Group’s disclosures about the degree of estimation 
involved in arriving at the UK used vehicle inventory 
provision, including the sensitivity disclosures included 
in note 3.4.
Our results: We found the group's estimate of the used 
vehicle inventory provision to be acceptable (2021 
result: acceptable).
    

103
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
2. Key audit matters: including our assessment of risks of material misstatement continued
The risk
Our response
Valuation of post 
retirement benefit 
obligation
(£368.9 million (2021: 
£569.2million))
Refer to page 70 Audit 
Committee report, page 
185 (accounting policy)
and page 190 (financial   
disclosures)
Subjective valuation
Small changes in the assumptions 
and estimates used to value the 
Group’s pension obligation (before 
deducting scheme assets) would 
have a significant effect on the 
Group’s pension obligation.
The significant risk specifically 
relates to the areas of estimation 
uncertainty in the calculation of 
the liability including the discount 
rate, rate of inflation and forecast 
mortality.
The effect of these matters is that, 
as part of our risk assessment, we 
determined that the valuation of the 
Group pension obligation has a high 
degree of estimation uncertainty, 
with a potential range of reasonable 
outcomes greater than our material-
ity for the financial statements as a 
whole, and possibly many times that 
amount. The financial statements 
(note 5.1) disclose the sensitivity 
estimated by the Group.
We performed the tests below rather than seeking to 
rely on any of the group's controls because the nature 
of the balance is such that we would expect to obtain 
audit evidence primarily through the detailed procedures 
described.
Our procedures included:
• Benchmarking assumptions: We challenged, with 
the support of our own actuarial specialists, the key 
assumptions applied, being the discount rate, inflation 
rate and mortality/life expectancy against externally 
derived data;
• Sensitivity analysis: We performed sensitivity analysis 
on input assumptions noted above;
• Assessing actuaries’ credentials: We evaluated the 
scope, competency and objectivity of the Group’s ex-
perts who assisted in determining the actuarial assump-
tions used to determine the defined benefit obligation;
• Tests of details: We evaluated the calculations pre-
pared by management’s external actuaries to assess the 
impact of the assumptions used on the Group Financial 
Statements;
• Assessing transparency:
We considered the adequacy of the Group’s disclosures 
in respect of the sensitivity of the obligation to the dis-
count rate, inflation and mortality assumptions, including 
the sensitivity disclosures included in note 5.1.
Our results:
We found the valuation of the pension obligation to be 
acceptable (2021 result: acceptable).    

104
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
2. Key audit matters: including our assessment of risks of material misstatement continued
The risk
Our response
Carrying value of 
parent company's 
investments in subsid-
iaries (£981.2 million; 
2021: £981.2 million) 
and debt due from 
group entities (£90 
million; 2021: £90 
million)
Refer to page 70 Audit 
Committee report, page 
202 (accounting policy)
and page 204 (financial  
disclosures)
Forecast-based assessment
The carrying amount of the parent 
Company’s investments in subsidiar-
ies and debt due from group entities 
are significant and at risk of irre-
coverability due to the requirement 
for future trading profits to recover 
such balances. The estimated re-
coverable amount of these balances 
is subjective due to the inherent 
uncertainty in forecasting trading 
conditions and cash flows used in 
the budgets.
The effect of these matters is that, 
as part of our risk assessment 
for audit planning purposes, we 
determined that the carrying value 
of parent company's investments 
in subsidiaries and debt due from 
group entities had a high degree of 
estimation uncertainty, with a poten-
tial range of reasonable outcomes 
greater than our materiality for the 
financial statements as a whole. In 
conducting our final audit work, we 
concluded that reasonably possi-
ble changes to the value in use of 
subsidiaries cash flow assumptions 
would not be expected to result in 
material impairment.
     
We performed the tests below rather than seeking to 
rely on any of the Company’s controls because the 
nature of the balance is such that we would expect to 
obtain audit evidence primarily through the detailed 
procedures described. 
Our procedures included:
• Tests of detail: Comparing the carrying amount of 
100% of investments and debt due from group entities 
with the relevant subsidiaries’ draft balance sheet to 
identify whether their net assets, being an approxi-
mation of their minimum recoverable amount, were in 
excess of their carrying amount;
• Comparing valuations: For the investments, where 
the carrying amount exceeded the net asset value, 
comparing the carrying amount of the investment with 
the expected value of the business based on value in use 
calculations;
• Benchmarking assumptions: Challenging the 
assumptions used in the cash flows included in the 
budgets based on our knowledge of the Group and 
the markets in which the subsidiaries operate; 
• Historical comparisons: Assessing the reasonableness 
of the budgets by considering the historical accuracy of 
the previous forecasts;
• Assessing transparency: Assessing the adequacy 
of the parent Company’s disclosures in respect of the 
investment in subsidiaries, including the sensitivity dis-
closures included in note 5.
Our results:
We found the Company’s conclusion that there is no 
impairment of its investments in subsidiaries and group 
debtor balance to be acceptable (2021: acceptable).
 
We continue to perform procedures over going concern. However, following the improved level of performance of the Group and 
its refinancing in the year, we have not assessed this as one of the most significant risks in our current year audit and, therefore, it 
is not separately identified in our report this year.

105
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
3. Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope of our audit
Materiality for the Group financial statements as a whole was set at £3.45m (2021: £4m), determined with reference to a benchmark 
of normalised Group profit before tax (2021: with reference to a normalised benchmark of Group revenue). We normalised profit 
before tax by adding back adjustments that do not represent the normal, continuing operations of the Group and by averaging over 
2 years. We selected 2 years to average profit before tax (2021: revenue averaged over 5 years) to account for the fluctuations in the 
Group's performance due to changes in market conditions. We adjusted for the items disclosed in Note 2.6, except for termination 
and severance costs, and net interest on pension scheme obligations. 
Materiality for the parent Company financial statements as a whole was set at £2.6m (2021: £1.8m), determined with reference to a 
benchmark of the parent Company total assets, of which it represents 0.2% (2021: 0.6% of net assets).
In line with our audit methodology, our procedures on individual account balances and disclosures were performed to a lower 
threshold, performance materiality, so as to reduce to an acceptable level the risk that individually immaterial misstatements in 
individual account balances add up to a material amount across the financial statements as a whole. 
Performance materiality was set at 75% (2021: 75%) of materiality for the financial statements as a whole, which equates to £2.6m 
(2021: £3.0m) for the Group and £2.0m (2021: £1.4m) for the parent Company. We applied this percentage in our determination of 
performance materiality because we did not identify any factors indicating an elevated level of risk.
We agreed to report to the Audit Committee any corrected or uncorrected identified misstatements exceeding £0.2m (2021: 
£0.2m), in addition to other identified misstatements that warranted reporting on qualitative grounds.
Of the Group’s 35 (2021: 38) reporting components, we subjected 11 (2021: 13) to full scope audits for group purposes and 5 (2021: 
none) to specified risk-focused audit procedures. The latter were not individually financially significant enough to require a full 
scope audit for group purposes, but did present specific individual risks that needed to be addressed. We subjected 3 (2021: none) 
components to specified risk-focused audit procedures over revenue, inventory and cost of sales, 1 (2021: none) to specified risk-
focused audit procedures over vehicle stocking loans and 1 (2021: none) to specified risk-focused audit procedures over pension 
assets. The components within the scope of our work accounted for the percentages illustrated on the following page. The remaining 
0% (2021: 8%) of total group revenue, 8% (2021: 10%) of the total profits and losses that made up the Group profit before tax and 
1% (2021: 7%) of total Group assets is represented by 19 (2021: 25) reporting components, none of which individually represented 
more than 3% (2021: 3%) of any of total Group revenue, the total profits and losses that made up the Group profit before tax or total 
group assets. 
For these components, we performed analysis at an aggregated Group level to re-examine our assessment that there were no 
significant risks of material misstatement within these.
The Group team performed procedures on the items excluded from normalised Group profit before tax. 
The Group audit team performed all of the audit work in relation to the 16 (2021: 13) components, including the audit of the parent 
company.

106
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
3. Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope of our audit continued
Normalised group profit before tax
£69.8m
(2021: normalised revenue of £3,784m)
Group revenue
Normalised profit before tax
Group materiality
Group materiality
£3.45m (2021: £4.0m)
£3.45m
Whole financial statements materiality 
(2021: £4.0m)
£2.6m
Whole financial statements performance materiality 
(2021: £3.0m)
£2.6m
Range of materiality at 16 components 
(£0.7m to £2.6m) 
(2021: £0.6m to £2.2m)
£0.2m
Misstatements reported to the audit committee 
(2021: £0.2m)
Total profits and losses that made 
up Group profit before tax
Group total assets 
Full scope for group audit purposes 2022
Specified risk-focused procedures for group audit purposes 2022
Full scope for group audit purposes 2021
Residual components
100%
(2021 92%)
92%
(2021 90%)
99%
(2021 93%)
92
96
4
90
79
13
93
96
3

107
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
4. Going concern
The directors have prepared the financial statements on the going concern basis as they do not intend to liquidate the Group 
or the parent Company or to cease their operations, and as they have concluded that the Group’s and the parent Company’s 
financial position means that this is realistic. They have also concluded that there are no material uncertainties that could have 
cast significant doubt over their ability to continue as a going concern for at least a year from the date of approval of the 
financial statements (“the going concern period”).  
We used our knowledge of the Group, its industry, and the uncertain economic environment to identify the inherent risks to 
the Group’s business model and analysed how those risks might affect the Group’s and parent Company’s financial resources 
or ability to continue operations over the going concern period. The risk that we considered most likely to adversely affect 
the Group’s and parent Company’s available financial resources and metrics relevant to debt covenants over this period was 
adverse macroeconomic conditions resulting in lower than expected trading volumes and deterioration in gross profit per unit 
(“GPU”) for vehicles sold.
We considered whether these risks could plausibly affect the liquidity or covenant compliance in the going concern period by 
comparing severe, but plausible downside scenarios that could arise from these risks individually and collectively against the 
level of available financial resources and covenants indicated by the Group’s financial forecasts.
Our procedures also included:
•	
Agreeing current facilities available to the relevant facility agreements. We inspected the existing and new loan agreements 
in order to determine the covenants attached to the loan and we considered compliance with the financial covenants in the 
context of the cash flow forecasts
•	
Comparing past budgets to actual results to assess the directors' track record of budgeting accurately.
•	
Discussing key trends within the sector with our automotive sector specialists in order to identify the critical assumptions in 
the cash flow forecasts and challenged the directors by applying additional specific sensitivities to the calculation;
•	
Comparing the assumptions behind the Group’s cash flow forecasts for key variables, such as new car volumes to externally 
derived data including market forecasts on future new and used car sales as well as macroeconomic data on projected 
growth;
•	
Evaluating the achievability of the mitigating actions the Directors consider they would take to improve the position should 
the risks materialise. We considered the extent to which the intent and ability of the Directors to pursue mitigating actions 
and implement these in the time frame required, should such actions be required, were reasonable by assessing whether the 
actions were entirely within the Directors’ control and consistent with Board approved plans;
•	
We considered whether the going concern disclosure in ‘Section 1 – Basis of Preparation’ section in the notes to the financial 
statements set out on page 118 gives a full and accurate description of the directors’ assessment of going concern, including 
the identified risks. 
Our conclusions based on this work:
•	
we consider that the directors’ use of the going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the financial statements 
is appropriate;
•	
we have not identified, and concur with the directors’ assessment that there is not, a material uncertainty related to events 
or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group’s or parent Company's ability to 
continue as a going concern for the going concern period;
•	
we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors’ statement in the in the notes to the 
financial statements set out on page 118 on the use of the going concern basis of accounting with no material uncertainties 
that may cast significant doubt over the Group and parent Company’s use of that basis for the going concern period, and 
we found the going concern disclosure in ‘General Information’ section in the notes to be acceptable; and
•	
the related statement under the Listing Rules set out on page 49 is materially consistent with the financial statements and 
our audit knowledge.
However, as we cannot predict all future events or conditions and as subsequent events may result in outcomes that are 
inconsistent with judgements that were reasonable at the time they were made, the above conclusions are not a guarantee that 
the Group or the parent Company will continue in operation. 

108
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
5. Fraud and breaches of laws and regulations – ability to detect
Identifying and responding to risks of material misstatement due to fraud
To identify risks of material misstatement due to fraud (“fraud risks”) we assessed events or conditions that could indicate an 
incentive or pressure to commit fraud or provide an opportunity to commit fraud. Our risk assessment procedures included:
•	
Enquiring of directors, the audit committee and internal audit and inspection of policy documentation as to the Group’s 
high-level policies and procedures to prevent and detect fraud, including the internal audit function, and the Group’s channel 
for “whistleblowing”, as well as whether they have knowledge of any actual, suspected or alleged fraud. 
•	
Reading Board, audit committee and Risk Control Group minutes.
•	
Considering remuneration incentive schemes and performance targets for directors.
•	
Using analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships.
We communicated identified fraud risks throughout the audit team and remained alert to any indications of fraud throughout 
the audit.
As required by auditing standards, and taking into account possible pressures to meet profit targets, we perform procedures to 
address the risk of management override of controls and the risk of fraudulent revenue recognition, in particular:
•	
the risk that Group and component management may be in a position to make inappropriate accounting entries; and
•	
the risk that new vehicle revenue for the year is misstated as a result of revenue being recorded in the wrong period
We did not identify any additional fraud risks.
We performed procedures including: 
•	
Identifying journal entries to test for all full scope components based on risk criteria and comparing the identified entries to 
supporting documentation. These included those posted to unusual accounts.  
•	
Evaluated the business purpose of significant unusual transactions.
•	
Assessing whether the judgements made in making accounting estimates are indicative of a potential bias.
Identifying and responding to risks of material misstatement due to non-compliance with laws and regulations
We identified areas of laws and regulations that could reasonably be expected to have a material effect on the financial 
statements from our general commercial and sector experience through discussion with the directors and other management 
(as required by auditing standards), and discussed with the directors and other management the policies and procedures 
regarding compliance with laws and regulations.  
We communicated identified laws and regulations throughout our team and remained alert to any indications of non-compliance 
throughout the audit. 
The potential effect of these laws and regulations on the financial statements varies considerably.
Firstly, the Group is subject to laws and regulations that directly affect the financial statements including financial reporting 
legislation (including related companies legislation), distributable profits legislation, taxation legislation and pensions legislation 
and we assessed the extent of compliance with these laws and regulations as part of our procedures on the related financial 
statement items.  
Secondly, the Group is subject to many other laws and regulations where the consequences of non-compliance could have a 
material effect on amounts or disclosures in the financial statements, for instance through the imposition of fines or litigation. 
We identified the following areas as those most likely to have such an effect: health and safety, anti-bribery, employment law 
and certain aspects of company legislation recognising the financial nature of the Group’s activities.  Auditing standards limit 
the required audit procedures to identify non-compliance with these laws and regulations to enquiry of the directors and other 
management and inspection of regulatory and legal correspondence, if any. Therefore if a breach of operational regulations is 
not disclosed to us or evident from relevant correspondence, an audit will not detect that breach.

109
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
5. Fraud and breaches of laws and regulations – ability to detect continued
Context of the ability of the audit to detect fraud or breaches of law or regulation
Owing to the inherent limitations of an audit, there is an unavoidable risk that we may not have detected some material misstatements 
in the financial statements, even though we have properly planned and performed our audit in accordance with auditing standards. 
For example, the further removed non-compliance with laws and regulations is from the events and transactions reflected in the 
financial statements, the less likely the inherently limited procedures required by auditing standards would identify it.  
In addition, as with any audit, there remained a higher risk of non-detection of fraud, as these may involve collusion, forgery, 
intentional omissions, misrepresentations, or the override of internal controls. Our audit procedures are designed to detect material 
misstatement. We are not responsible for preventing non-compliance or fraud and cannot be expected to detect non-compliance 
with all laws and regulations.
6. We have nothing to report on the other information in the Annual Report
The directors are responsible for the other information presented in the Annual Report together with the financial statements.  Our 
opinion on the financial statements does not cover the other information and, accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion or, 
except as explicitly stated below, any form of assurance conclusion thereon.  
Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether, based on our financial statements audit work, 
the information therein is materially misstated or inconsistent with the financial statements or our audit knowledge.  Based solely on 
that work we have not identified material misstatements in the other information.
Strategic report and directors’ report 
Based solely on our work on the other information:  
•	
we have not identified material misstatements in the strategic report and the directors’ report;  
•	
in our opinion the information given in those reports for the financial year is consistent with the financial statements; and  
•	
in our opinion those reports have been prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006.  
Directors’ remuneration report  
In our opinion the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the 
Companies Act 2006.  
Disclosures of emerging and principal risks and longer-term viability  
We are required to perform procedures to identify whether there is a material inconsistency between the directors’ disclosures in 
respect of emerging and principal risks and the viability statement, and the financial statements and our audit knowledge. 
Based on those procedures, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to:   
 
•	
the directors’ confirmation within the viability statement on page 49 that they have carried out a robust assessment of the 
emerging and principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business model, future performance, 
solvency and liquidity; 
•	
the Principal Risks disclosures describing these risks and how emerging risks are identified, and explaining how they are 
being managed and mitigated; and  
•	
the directors’ explanation in the viability statement of how they have assessed the prospects of the Group, over what 
period they have done so and why they considered that period to be appropriate, and their statement as to whether they 
have a reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due 
over the period of their assessment, including any related disclosures drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or 
assumptions.  

110
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
6. We have nothing to report on the other information in the Annual Report continued
We are also required to review the viability statement, set out on page 49 under the Listing Rules.   Based on the above procedures, 
we have concluded that the above disclosures are materially consistent with the financial statements and our audit knowledge.
Our work is limited to assessing these matters in the context of only the knowledge acquired during our financial statements 
audit.  As we cannot predict all future events or conditions and as subsequent events may result in outcomes that are inconsistent 
with judgements that were reasonable at the time they were made, the absence of anything to report on these statements is not 
a guarantee as to the Group’s and Company’s longer-term viability.
Corporate governance disclosures  
We are required to perform procedures to identify whether there is a material inconsistency between the directors’ corporate 
governance disclosures and the financial statements and our audit knowledge.
Based on those procedures, we have concluded that each of the following is materially consistent with the financial statements 
and our audit knowledge:    
•	
the directors’ statement that they consider that the annual report and financial statements taken as a whole is fair, 
balanced and understandable, and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and 
performance, business model and strategy; 
•	
the section of the annual report describing the work of the Audit Committee, including the significant issues that the audit 
committee considered in relation to the financial statements, and how these issues were addressed; and
•	
the section of the annual report that describes the review of the effectiveness of the Group’s risk management and internal 
control systems.
We are required to review the part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating to the Group’s compliance with the provisions 
of the UK Corporate Governance Code specified by the Listing Rules for our review. We have nothing to report in this respect. 
7. We have nothing to report on the other matters on which we are required to report by exception 
Under the Companies Act 2006, we are required to report to you if, in our opinion:  
•	
adequate accounting records have not been kept by the parent Company, or returns adequate for our audit have not been 
received from branches not visited by us; or  
•	
the parent Company financial statements and the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited are not in 
agreement with the accounting records and returns; or  
•	
certain disclosures of directors’ remuneration specified by law are not made; or  
•	
we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit.  
We have nothing to report in these respects. 

111
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT 
TO THE MEMBERS OF PENDRAGON PLC (CONTINUED)
8. Respective responsibilities  
Directors’ responsibilities  
As explained more fully in their statement set out on page 100, the directors are responsible for: the preparation of the financial 
statements including being satisfied that they give a true and fair view; such internal control as they determine is necessary 
to enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; 
assessing the Group and parent Company’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to 
going concern; and using the going concern basis of accounting unless they either intend to liquidate the Group or the parent 
Company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so. 
Auditor’s responsibilities  
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a whole are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue our opinion in an auditor’s report.  Reasonable assurance is a high 
level of assurance, but does not guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material 
misstatement when it exists.  Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in 
aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of the financial 
statements.
A fuller description of our responsibilities is provided on the FRC’s website at www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. 
The Company is required to include these financial statements in an annual financial report prepared using the single electronic 
reporting format specified in the TD ESEF Regulation.  This auditor’s report provides no assurance over whether the annual 
financial report has been prepared in accordance with that format.
9.  The purpose of our audit work and to whom we owe our responsibilities 
This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 
2006.  Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are required 
to state to them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose.  To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or 
assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the Company’s members, as a body, for our audit work, for this 
report, or for the opinions we have formed. 
Craig Parkin (Senior Statutory Auditor)  
for and on behalf of KPMG LLP, Statutory Auditor  
Chartered Accountants  
One Snowhill
Snow Hill Queensway 
Birmingham
B4 6GH
22 March 2023

112
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT
Year ended 31 December 2022
Notes
2022
£m
Continuing 
operations
£m
Discontinued
operations*
£m
2021
£m
Revenue
2.1
3,620.0 
 3,421.3 
 28.6 
 3,449.9 
Cost of sales
 (3,162.8)
 (2,984.0)
 (24.6)
 (3,008.6)
Gross profit
457.2 
 437.3 
 4.0 
 441.3 
Operating expenses
2.2
 (363.9)
 (326.5)
 (9.9)
 (336.4)
Operating profit/(loss) before other income
93.3 
110.8 
(5.9)
 104.9 
Other income - gains on the sale of 
businesses and property, plant and 
equipment
2.6
7.7 
 1.8 
 0.9 
 2.7 
Operating profit/(loss)
101.0 
112.6 
 (5.0)
 107.6 
Analysed as:
Underlying operating profit/(loss)
98.5 
 117.4 
(1.1) 
 116.3 
Non-underlying operating profit/(loss)
2.6
2.5 
 (4.8)
 (3.9)
 (8.7)
Finance expense
4.3
 (44.8)
 (34.9)
 (0.3)
 (35.2)
Finance income
4.3
1.0 
 0.9 
 -   
 0.9 
Net finance costs
 (43.8)
 (34.0)
 (0.3)
 (34.3)
Analysed as:
Underlying net finance costs
 (40.9)
 (33.0)
 (0.3)
 (33.3)
Non-underlying net finance costs
2.6
 (2.9)
 (1.0)
 -   
 (1.0)
Profit/(loss) before taxation
57.2 
 78.6 
(5.3)
 73.3 
Analysed as:
Underlying profit before taxation
57.6 
 84.4 
 (1.4) 
 83.0 
Non-underlying (loss) before taxation
2.6
 (0.4)
 (5.8)
 (3.9)
 (9.7)
Income tax (expense)/credit
2.7
 (11.7)
 (13.1)
 1.3 
 (11.8)
Profit/(loss) for the year
45.5 
 65.5
 (4.0) 
 61.5 
Analysed as:
Underlying profit/(loss) after taxation
44.5 
 70.0
(1.0) 
 69.0 
Non-underlying profit/(loss) after taxation
2.6
1.0 
 (4.5)
 (3.0)
 (7.5)
Earnings per share
Basic earnings per share
2.8
3.3p
4.7p
(0.3p)
4.4p
Diluted earnings per share
2.8
3.1p
4.6p
(0.3p)
4.3p
*  The discontinued operations in 2021 are in respect of the Group's US business. 
**  The Basic earnings per share and diluted earnings per share measure for the current year apply to continuing and total operations.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
**
**
	
	
	
The notes on pages 118 to 196 form part of these financial statements
	
	
	
	

113
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
Year ended 31 December 2022
Notes
2022
£m
2021
£m
Profit for the year
45.5 
 61.5 
Other comprehensive income
Items that will never be reclassified to profit and loss:
Defined benefit plan remeasurement gains and (losses)   
 
5.1
8.2 
 40.1 
Income tax relating to defined benefit plan remeasurement (gains) and losses 
2.7
 (1.6)
 (6.9)
6.6 
 33.2 
Items that are or may be reclassified to profit and loss:
Foreign currency translation differences of foreign operations 
0.5 
-
0.5 
-
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 
7.1 
33.2 
Total comprehensive income for the year 
52.6 
94.7 
Total comprehensive income for the period attributable to equity 
shareholders of the company arises from:
Continuing operations
52.6 
 98.7 
Discontinued operations - see note 3.3
 - 
 (4.0)
52.6 
94.7
	
	
	
The notes on pages 118 to 196 form part of these financial statements
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	

114
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
Year ended 31 December 2022
Share 
capital
£m
Share 
premium
£m
Capital 
redemption
reserve
£m
Other
reserves
£m
Translation
differences
£m
Retained
earnings
£m
Total
£m
Balance at 1 January 2022 
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 12.6 
 -
80.7 
225.6 
Total comprehensive income for 2022 
Profit for the year 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
45.5 
45.5 
Other comprehensive income for the year, 
net of tax 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
0.5 
6.6 
7.1 
Total comprehensive income for the year  
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
0.5 
52.1 
52.6 
 
Share based payments 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
3.3 
3.3 
Income tax relating to share based payments 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 (0.1)
 (0.1)
Own shares issued by EBT 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
0.1 
0.1 
Own shares purchased by EBT 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 (0.5)
 (0.5)
Balance at 31 December 2022
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 12.6 
0.5 
135.6 
281.0 
  
Balance at 1 January 2021 
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 12.6 
 (1.0)
 (17.2)
126.7 
Total comprehensive income for 2021 
Profit for the year 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
61.5 
61.5 
Translation differences taken to profit and 
loss on termination of operation 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
1.0 
 - 
1.0 
Other comprehensive income for the year, 
net of tax 
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 - 
33.2 
33.2 
Total comprehensive income for the year  
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
1.0 
94.7 
95.7 
Share based payments   
 -  
 -   
- 
 -   
 -   
2.9 
2.9 
Income tax relating to share based pay-
ments   
 -  
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -  
0.3 
0.3 
Balance at 31 December 2021 
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 12.6 
 -  
80.7 
225.6 
	
	
	
The notes on pages 118 to 196 form part of these financial statements
	
	
	
	

115
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Approved by the Board of Directors on 22 March 2023 and signed on its behalf by:
W Berman	
M S Willis
Chief Executive 
Chief Finance Officer
 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
At 31 December 2022
Notes
2022
£m
Restated 
see note 1 
2021
£m
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment
3.2
515.9 
 499.5 
Goodwill
3.1
144.6 
 150.3 
Other intangible assets
3.1
12.4 
 11.1 
Finance lease receivables
14.8 
 15.5 
Deferred tax assets
2.7
11.6 
 22.1 
Total non-current assets
699.3 
 698.5 
Current assets
Inventories
3.4
620.3
 512.8 
Trade and other receivables
3.6
115.7 
101.3 
Finance lease receivables
2.4 
 2.1 
Current tax assets
3.3 
 4.5 
Cash and cash equivalents
4.2
171.9 
200.1 
Assets classified as held for sale
3.3
6.1 
 10.4 
Total current assets
919.7
831.2
Total assets
1,619.0
1,529.7
Current liabilities
Bank overdraft
4.2
 (102.5) 
(162.5) 
Interest bearing loans and borrowings
4.2
 (1.7)
 - 
Lease liabilities
4.7
 (20.0)
 (26.7)
Trade and other payables
3.7
 (812.0)
 (692.7)
Deferred income
3.8
 (38.2)
 (37.2)
Total current liabilities
(974.4)
(919.1)
Non-current liabilities
Interest bearing loans and borrowings
4.2
 (91.0)
 (87.3)
Lease liabilities
4.7
 (197.9)
 (195.4)
Trade and other payables
3.7
 (35.7)
 (41.9)
Deferred income
3.8
 (36.4)
 (36.8)
Retirement benefit obligations
5.1
 (2.6)
 (23.6)
Total non-current liabilities
 (363.6)
 (385.0)
Total liabilities
(1,338.0)
(1,304.1)
Net assets
281.0 
 225.6 
Capital and reserves
Called up share capital
4.4
69.9 
 69.9 
Share premium account
4.4
56.8 
 56.8 
Capital redemption reserve
4.4
5.6 
 5.6 
Other reserves
4.4
12.6 
 12.6 
Translation reserve
4.4
0.5 
 -   
Retained earnings
135.6 
 80.7 
Total equity attributable to equity shareholders of the Company
281.0 
 225.6 
The notes on pages 118 to 196 form part of these financial statements
Registered Company Number: 02304195

116
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT
Year ended 31 December 2022
Notes
2022
£m
2021
£m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit for the year
45.5 
 61.5 
Adjustment for taxation
11.7 
 11.8 
Adjustment for net financing expense
43.8 
 34.3 
101.0 
 107.6 
Depreciation and amortisation
33.5 
 36.1 
Share based payments
3.3 
 2.9 
Profit on sale of businesses and property, plant and equipment
 (7.7)
 (2.7)
Impairment of goodwill
3.6 
 -   
Impairment of property, plant and equipment
1.2 
 9.6 
Contribution into defined benefit pension scheme
 (13.1)
 (12.8)
Changes in inventories
3.4
(119.8)
 107.8 
Changes in trade and other receivables
 (15.2)
 (1.1) 
Changes in trade and other payables
150.8
(111.1)
Movement in contract hire vehicle balances
3.5
 (20.9)
 (36.8)
Cash generated from operations
116.7 
 99.5 
Taxation paid
 (1.4)
 (7.1)
Bank and stocking interest paid
 (25.5)
 (17.5)
Lease interest paid
 (14.7)
 (12.6)
Finance lease interest received
1.0 
 0.9 
Net cash from operating activities
76.1 
 63.2 
Cash flows from investing activities
Proceeds from sale of businesses
6.1
3.9 
 27.2 
Purchase of property, plant, equipment and intangible assets
3.1, 3.2
 (44.3)
 (18.6)
Proceeds from sale of property, plant, equipment and intangible assets
3.1, 3.2
13.3 
 5.4 
Receipt of lease receivables
2.0 
 2.2 
Net cash (used in)/from investing activities
 (25.1)
16.2
Cash flows from financing activities
Payment of lease liabilities
 (22.2)
 (27.2)
Repayment of loans
 (90.5)
 (88.8)
Proceeds from issue of loans (net of directly attributable transaction costs)
93.8 
18.7 
Disposal of shares by EBT
0.1 
 - 
Purchase of shares by EBT
 (0.5)
 - 
Net cash outflow from financing activities
 (19.3)
 (97.3)
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents	
	
31.7 
 (17.9)
Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January
37.6 
 56.0 
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash held
0.1 
 (0.5)
Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December
4.2
69.4 
 37.6 
The notes on pages 118 to 196 form part of these financial statements.

117
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
RECONCILIATION OF NET CASH FLOW TO MOVEMENT
IN ADJUSTED NET DEBT
2022
£m
2021
£m
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents	
	
31.7 
 (17.9)
Repayment of loans
90.5 
 88.8 
Proceeds from issue of loans (net of directly attributable transaction costs)	 	
 (93.8)
 (18.7)
Non-cash movements
 (2.0)
 (1.5)
Decrease in adjusted net debt in the year	
26.4 
 50.7 
Opening adjusted net debt
 (49.7)
 (100.4)
Closing adjusted net debt
 (23.3)
 (49.7)
The reconciliation of net cash flow to movement in adjusted net debt is not a primary statement and does not form part of the consolidated cash flow statement but forms part of the 
notes to the financial statements. Adjusted net debt is defined in note 4.2.
The notes on pages 118 to 196 form part of these financial statements.
	
	

118
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Presented below are those accounting policies that relate to the financial statements as a whole and includes details of 
new accounting standards that are or will be effective for 2022 or later years. To facilitate the understanding of each note 
to the financial statements those accounting policies that are relevant to a particular category are presented within the 
relevant notes.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Pendragon PLC is a Group domiciled in the United Kingdom. The consolidated financial statements of the Group for 
the year ended 31 December 2022 comprise the Group and its subsidiaries and the Group’s interest in jointly controlled 
entities, together referred to as the ‘Group’.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
 
The consolidated financial statements of the Group as at and for the year ended 31 December 2022 are prepared in 
accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted in the United Kingdom ("adopted IFRS"). 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group has elected to prepare its parent Company financial statements in accordance with FRS 101. These are presented 
on pages 197 to 208.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The financial statements are presented in millions of UK pounds, rounded to the nearest £0.1m. They have been prepared 
under the historical cost convention and where other bases are applied these are identified in the relevant accounting 
policy in the notes below. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
Going concern
 
Notwithstanding net current liabilities of £54.7m as at 31 December 2022 for the Group, the Directors are, at the time 
of approving the financial statements, satisfied that the Group and Company has adequate resources to continue in 
operational existence for the foreseeable future.  Thus, they continue to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in 
preparing the financial statements.  The Directors have considered the potential impact of a macro-economic downturn, 
a market correction in used pricing and shortfalls in both new and used car supply resulting from shortages in microchips 
impacting manufacturing.
 
The Group meets its day-to-day working capital requirements from a revolving credit facility of £75m and senior note 
of £97m together with cash balances and a requirement for ongoing access to rolling vehicle credit stocking facilities 
amounting to £582.7m at 31 December 2022 as disclosed in note 4.2.  The senior note is due for renewal in March 2027 and 
the revolving credit facility is due for renewal in March 2025, with a further two, one-year options available at the election 
of lenders to March 2026 and then March 2027.  The senior note and revolving credit facility have quarterly leverage and 
fixed charge covenants, as well as an absolute EBITDA covenant, a breach of which would result in the amounts drawn 
becoming repayable on demand.  The Group remained compliant with its banking covenants throughout the year to 31 
December 2022.  
 
In the context of the above, the directors have prepared cash flow forecasts for the period to 31 March 2024 which indicate 
that, taking account of reasonably possible downsides, the Group will have sufficient funds to meet its liabilities as they fall 
due for that period. The Directors have modelled scenarios as follows:
 
1. A base cash flow forecast.  The 2023 figures in this forecast are based on the Group’s 2023 budget, which reflect current 
run-rates and expected strategic improvements.  The 2024 figures in the base cash flow forecast are based on the 2023 
budget with a modest growth rate applied to gross profit and operating costs.
 
2. A severe, but plausible downside scenario.  The directors have also prepared a sensitised forecast which considers the 
impact of certain severe but plausible downside events, when compared to the base case.  This scenario reflects a severe 
downturn to vehicle volumes and margins.  This considers both a worsening in economic conditions and restricted new car 
supply due to manufacturing constraints.  In this scenario, capital expenditure has been reduced to run-rate expenditure 
and projects committed to and the directors have assessed that the business would operate with lower staffing levels

119
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Going concern Continued
	
through the non-replacement of leavers.  This scenario demonstrates that the Group would remain well within its facility 
limits and would retain significant headroom on liquidity covenants. The scenario shows that the Group would also 
remain within its minimum EBITDA covenant although this is dependant upon the mitigating actions referred to above. 
 
Based on the above, the directors are confident that the Group and Company will have sufficient funds to continue 
to meet its liabilities as they fall due for at least 12 months from the date of approval of the financial statements, and 
therefore the directors believe it remains appropriate to prepare the financial statements on a going concern basis.
	
Prior year adjustment 	
	
The Group has made adjustments to the presentation of the comparative Balance Sheet. The directors have considered 
that the overdraft balances of Group entities should be separately presented gross on the Consolidated Balance Sheet, 
rather than netted off against cash and cash equivalents held either by the same entity, or other Group entities, with the 
same bank. As a result, the Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31 December 2021 has been restated as follows.
 
The restatement did not result in any change to reported profit, earnings per share, net assets or cash flows reported in 
the 2021 financial year. 
 
The impact on the opening Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31 December 2020 is as follows:
	
 
The restatement did not result in any change to reported profit, earnings per share, net assets or cash flows reported in 
the 2020 financial year.
 
As these individual overdraft accounts are an integral part of the Group's cash management they are still classified as cash 
and cash equivalents (see note 4.2) in the Consolidated Cash Flow Statement and therefore this reclassification has no 
effect on total cash flows in the comparative period.
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2021
as reported
£m
restatement
£m
2021
restated
£m
Current Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
37.6
162.5
200.1
Current liabilities
Bank overdraft
 - 
(162.5) 
 (162.5) 
 37.6 
 - 
 37.6
2020
as reported
£m
restatement
£m
2020
restated
£m
Current Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
56.0
187.6
243.6
Current liabilities
Bank overdraft
 - 
(187.6) 
 (187.6) 
56.0 
 - 
56.0

120
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Judgements	
 
The Group applies judgement in how it applies its accounting policies, which do not involve estimation, but could materially 
affect the numbers disclosed in these financial statements. There are no key accounting judgements, without estimation, 
that have been applied in these financial statements. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
Accounting Estimates	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with adopted IFRSs requires the use of estimates and assumptions 
that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of 
revenues and expenses during the reporting year. Although these estimates are based on management’s best knowledge 
of the amount, events or actions, actual results ultimately may differ from those estimates.	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis. The estimates and associated assumptions 
are based on historical experience and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. 
Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only 
that period, or in the period of the revision and future periods if the revision affects both current and future periods. The 
directors consider the following to be the key estimates applicable to the financial statements, which have a significant risk 
of resulting in a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year or in the 
long term:
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Key estimate area
Key assumption
Potential 
impact within 
the next 
financial year
Potential 
impact in 
the longer 
term
Note 
reference
Inventory fair value 
(UK used inventory 
of £388.6m (2021: 
£351.4m))
The Group assessment of fair values of used 
inventory involves an element of estimation. The key 
assumption is estimating the likely sale period and 
the expected profit or loss on sale for each of our 
inventory items that are held at the year end point. 
We conduct this analysis by looking at stock by age 
category and comparing historical trends and our 
forward expectations on these assumptions.
3
3.4
Retirement benefit 
obligations	
	
The main assumptions in determining the Group’s 
Retirement Benefit Obligations are: discount rate, 
mortality and rate of inflation. Full detail is included 
in the pension note, 5.1.
3
3
5.1

121
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Basis of consolidation
 
The consolidated financial statements include the financial statements of Pendragon PLC, all its subsidiary undertakings 
and investments. Consistent accounting policies have been applied in the preparation of all such financial statements. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Subsidiaries are entities controlled by the Group. The Group controls an entity when it is exposed to, or has rights to, 
variable returns from its involvement with the entity and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the 
entity. The financial statements of subsidiaries are included in the consolidated financial statements from the date that 
control commences until the date that control ceases.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
Intragroup balances and any unrealised gains or losses or income and expenses arising from intragroup transactions, are 
eliminated in preparing the consolidated financial statements.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
Foreign currencies  	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Transactions in foreign currencies are translated to the respective functional currency of Group entities at the foreign 
exchange rate ruling at the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies at the 
balance sheet date are translated to the functional currency at the foreign exchange rate ruling at that date. Non-monetary 
assets and liabilities that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange 
rate at the date of the transaction. Non-monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies that are stated 
at fair value are translated to sterling at foreign exchange rates ruling at the dates the fair value was determined. Foreign 
currency differences arising on retranslation are recognised in profit or loss.   
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
The assets and liabilities of foreign operations, including goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on consolidation, are 
translated to sterling at foreign exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet date. The revenues and expenses of foreign 
operations are translated to sterling at rates approximating to the foreign exchange rates ruling at the dates of the 
transactions.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Foreign currency differences arising on the retranslation of a financial liability designated as a hedge of a net investment 
in a foreign operation are recognised directly in equity, in the foreign currency translation reserve, to the extent the hedge 
is effective. To the extent the hedge is ineffective, such differences are recognised in profit or loss. When the hedged net 
investment is disposed of, the cumulative amount in equity is transferred to profit and loss on disposal.  
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
In respect of all foreign operations, any differences that have arisen after 1 January 2004, the date of transition to IFRS, are 
presented as a separate component of equity.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
Cash and cash equivalents 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
For the purposes of the cash flow statement, cash and cash equivalents comprise deposits with banks and financial 
institutions, bank and cash balances, and liquid investments, net of bank overdrafts. Bank overdrafts that are repayable 
on demand and form an integral part of the Group's cash management are included as a component of cash and cash 
equivalents for the purpose of the statement of cash flows. In the balance sheet, bank overdrafts are included in current 
borrowings.
	
Government grants 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Government grants are recognised when there is reasonable assurance the grants will be received and the conditions 
of the grant will be complied with. There was no income from government grants during 2022 (2021: £1.6m, being the 
Coronavirus Job Retention Scheme, is included within payroll expenses). No business rates relief was received in 2022 
(2021: £8.7m was received by way of business rates relief by way of waiver of these charges)  
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

122
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Impairment
	
The carrying amounts of the Group's assets, other than inventories (see note 3.4) and deferred tax assets (see note 2.7), 
are reviewed at each balance sheet date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment. If any such indication 
exists, the asset's recoverable amount is estimated.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
 
For goodwill the recoverable amount is estimated at each balance sheet date. The recoverable amount is the higher of fair 
value less costs to sell and value in use. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their 
present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the 
risks specific to the asset for which the estimates of future cash flows have not been adjusted.  
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
In assessing fair value less costs to sell, the estimated future cash flows are multiplied by an appropriate trading multiple 
or by assessing the fair value of the individual assets.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
For the purpose of impairment testing, assets are grouped together into the smallest group of assets that generates 
cash inflows from continuing use that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other groups of assets ('the cash 
generating unit'). The goodwill acquired in a business combination, for the purpose of impairment testing is allocated to 
cash generating units. Management have determined that the cash generating units of the Group are the motor franchise 
groups and other business segments.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
 
An impairment loss is recognised whenever the carrying amount of an asset or its cash generating unit exceeds its 
recoverable amount. Impairment losses are recognised in the income statement.	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Impairment losses recognised in respect of cash generating units are allocated first to reduce the carrying amount of any 
goodwill allocated to cash generating units and then, to reduce the carrying amount of the other assets in the unit on 
a pro-rata basis.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
An impairment loss in respect of goodwill is not reversed. In respect of other assets, an impairment loss is reversed if there 
has been a change in the estimates used to determine the recoverable amount. An impairment loss is reversed only to the 
extent that the asset's carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of 
depreciation or amortisation, if no impairment loss had been recognised. The impact of the current year impairment review 
can be seen in note 3.1.		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Adoption of new and revised standards and new standards and interpretations not yet adopted  
 
No new or amended standards and interpretations have been adopted during the year. 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts is effective for annual periods beginning after 1 January 2023 and is not expected to have a 
significant impact on the Group’s consolidated financial statements.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Alternative performance measures	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group uses a number of key performance measures ('KPI’s') which are non-IFRS measures to monitor the performance 
of its operations. The Group believes these KPIs provide useful historical financial information to help investors and 
other stakeholders evaluate the performance of the business and are measures commonly used by certain investors for 
evaluating the performance of the Group. In particular, the Group uses KPIs which reflect the underlying performance on 
the basis that this provides a more relevant focus on the core business performance of the Group. The Group has been 
using the following KPIs on a consistent basis and they are defined and reconciled as follows:

123
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Operating profit reconciliation	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Underlying operating profit 
98.5 
116.3
Gains on the sale of businesses and property, plant and equipment (see note 2.6)
7.7 
2.7 
Impairment of goodwill (see note 2.6)
 (3.6)
 - 
Impairment of property, plant and equipment (see note 2.6)
 (1.0)
 - 
Impairment of right of use assets (see note 2.6)
 (0.2)
 (9.6)
Aborted transaction related expenses (see note 2.6)
 (0.4)
 - 
Termination and severance payments (see note 2.6)
 (0.2)
 (1.8)
Business closure income (see note 2.6)
0.2 
 - 
Non-underlying operating profit/(loss) items
2.5 
 (8.7)
Operating profit
101.0 
107.6 
Profit before tax reconciliation
2022
£m
2021
£m
Underlying profit before tax 
57.6 
83.0 
Non-underlying operating profit/(loss) items (see reconciliation above)
2.5 
 (8.7)
Non-underlying net finance costs (see note 2.6)
 (2.9)
 (1.0)
Non-underlying operating profit/(loss) and finance costs items
 (0.4)
 (9.7)
Profit before tax
57.2 
73.3 
Profit after tax reconciliation
2022
£m
2021
£m
Underlying profit after tax  
44.5 
69.0 
Non-underlying operating profit/(loss) and finance costs items (see reconciliation above)
 (0.4)
 (9.7)
Non-underlying tax (see note 2.6)
1.4 
2.2 
Non-underlying operating profit/(loss), finance costs and tax items
1.0 
 (7.5)
Profit after tax
45.5 
61.5 
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Dividend per share - dividend per share is defined as the interim dividend per share plus the proposed final year dividend 
per share for a given period.	
	
Gross margin % - gross margin is defined as gross profit as a percentage of revenue. 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Operating margin % - operating margin is defined as operating profit as a percentage of revenue. 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Underlying operating profit/profit before tax - results on an underlying basis exclude items that have non-trading 
attributes due to their size, nature or incidence. The detail of the non-underlying results is shown in note 2.6 and this is also 
shown on the face of the consolidated income statement to reconcile from the underlying to total results. 

124
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION
 
Underlying basic earnings per share ('underlying earnings per share') – the Group presents underlying basic earnings per 
share as the directors consider that this is a better measure of comparative performance. Underlying basic earnings per 
share is calculated by dividing the underlying profit or loss attributable to ordinary shareholders by the weighted average 
number of ordinary shares in issue during the period. A full reconciliation of how this is derived is found in note 2.8. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Underlying diluted earnings per share – the Group presents underlying diluted earnings per share as the directors consider 
that this is a better measure of comparative performance.  Underlying diluted earnings per share is calculated by dividing 
the underlying profit and loss attributable to ordinary shareholders by the weighted average number of ordinary shares 
in issue taking account of the effects of all dilutive potential ordinary shares, which comprise of share options granted to 
employees, LTIPs and share warrants. A full reconciliation of how this is derived is found in note 2.8. 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Adjusted net debt – All loans and borrowings less cash and cash equivalents less IFRS 16 lease liabilities less vehicle 
stocking loans.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
Leverage ratio – the Group uses the ratio of adjusted net cash/(debt) to underlying EBITDA to assess the use of the 
Group’s financial resources.  The reconciliation of this and the composition of underlying EBITDA is shown in note 4.2.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Like-for-Like reconciliations	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
 
Like for like (LFL) results only include trading businesses which have comparative trading periods in two consecutive 
financial years. We use like-for-like results to aid in the understanding of the like-for-like movement in revenue, gross profit 
and operating profit in the business. The difference to underlying results are those businesses which are not like-for-like 
which have recently commenced operation and therefore do not have a full current year and prior year history plus any 
retail points closed during the current or previous period.  The like-for-like adjustments are split between those in relation 
to businesses disposed and those other adjustments which relate to the elimination of results for a period in a year which 
does not have a corresponding amount in the comparative year.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

125
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Revenues by Department - UK Motor
Group 
revenue 
2022
£m
Disposals 
revenue
2022
£m
Other non 
like-for-like 
revenue
2022 
£m
Like-for-like
revenue
2022
£m
Group 
revenue 
2021
£m
Disposals 
revenue
2021
£m
Other non 
like-for-like 
revenue
2021 
£m
Like-for-like
revenue
2021
£m
 Aftersales revenue 
276.1 
 - 
 - 
276.1 
261.9 
 (5.1)
 - 
256.8 
 Used vehicle revenue  
1,808.6 
 (0.2)
 (0.7)
1,807.7 
1,708.4 
 (10.8)
 - 
1,697.6 
 New vehicle revenue 
1,451.5 
 - 
 - 
1,451.5 
1,362.4 
 (12.2)
 - 
1,350.2 
 Total Revenue 
3,536.2 
 (0.2)
 (0.7)
3,535.3 
3,332.7 
 (28.1)
 - 
3,304.6 
Revenues by Department - US Motor
Group 
revenue 
2022
£m
Disposals 
revenue
2022
£m
Other non 
like-for-like 
revenue
2022
£m
Like-for-like
revenue
2022
£m
Group 
revenue 
2021
£m
Disposals 
revenue
2021
£m
Other non 
like-for-like 
revenue
2021 
£m
Like-for-like
revenue
2021
£m
 Aftersales revenue 
 - 
 - 
 -   
 - 
2.8 
 (2.8)
 -   
 - 
 Used vehicle revenue  
 - 
 - 
 -   
 - 
3.0 
 (3.0)
 -   
 - 
 New vehicle revenue 
 - 
 - 
 -   
 - 
22.8 
 (22.8)
 -   
 - 
 Total Revenue 
 - 
 - 
 -   
 - 
28.6 
 (28.6)
 -   
 - 
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

126
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 1 - BASIS OF PREPARATION
Gross profit by Department - UK Motor
Group 
gross profit
2022
£m
Disposals 
gross profit
2022
£m
Other non 
like-for-like
gross profit
2022 
£m
Like-for-like
gross profit
2022
£m
Group 
gross profit
2021
£m
Disposals 
gross profit
2021
£m
Other non 
like-for-like
gross profit
2021 
£m
Like-for-like
gross profit
2021
£m
 Aftersales gross profit 
139.5 
0.3 
 - 
139.8 
133.2 
 (2.4)
 -
130.8 
 Used vehicle gross profit 
143.6 
 - 
 - 
143.6 
164.2 
 (0.2)
 -
164.0 
 New vehicle gross profit  
132.6 
 - 
 - 
132.6 
99.9 
 (0.9)
 -
99.0 
  Total Gross profit  
415.7 
0.3 
 - 
416.0 
397.3 
 (3.5)
 -
393.8 
Gross profit by Department - US Motor
Group 
gross profit
2022
£m
Disposals 
gross profit
2022
£m
Other non 
like-for-like
gross profit
2022 
£m
Like-for-like
gross profit
2022
£m
Group 
gross profit
2021
£m
Disposals 
gross profit
2021
£m
Other non 
like-for-like
gross profit
2021 
£m
Like-for-like
gross profit
2021
£m
 Aftersales gross profit 
 - 
 - 
 -   
 - 
 1.6
 (1.6)
 -   
 - 
 Used gross profit
 - 
 - 
 -   
 - 
0.2
(0.2)
 -   
 - 
 New vehicle gross profit  
 - 
 - 
 -   
 -
2.2
 (2.2)
 -   
 -
 Total Gross profit 
 - 
 - 
 -   
 - 
4.0
 (4.0)
 -   
 - 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Underlying operating profit
Group 
underlying 
operating 
profit/
(loss)
2022
£m
Disposals 
underlying 
operating 
profit
2022
£m
Other non 
like-for-like 
underlying 
operating 
profit
2022
£m
Like-for-like
underlying 
operating 
profit
2022
£m
Group 
underlying 
operating 
profit/
(loss)
2021
£m
Disposals 
underlying 
operating 
profit
2021
£m
Other non 
like-for-like 
underlying 
operating 
profit
2021 
£m
Like-for-like
underlying 
operating 
profit
2021
£m
 UK Motor 
69.1 
1.0 
0.2 
70.3 
87.4 
1.1 
 - 
88.5 
 Software 
11.0 
 - 
 - 
11.0 
12.5 
 - 
 - 
12.5 
 Leasing 
19.9 
 - 
 - 
19.9 
17.5 
 - 
 - 
17.5 
 US Motor 
 (1.5)
1.5 
 - 
 - 
 (1.1)
1.1 
 - 
 - 
 Total underlying 
 operating profit 
98.5 
2.5 
0.2 
101.2 
116.3 
2.2 
 - 
118.5 

127
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
	
This section contains the notes and information to support the results presented in the income statement: 
	
2.1	
Revenue		
	
	
2.5	
Audit fees	
	
2.2	
Net operating expenses	
	
2.6	
Non-underlying items 
	
2.3	
Operating segments	
	
2.7	
Taxation	
	
2.4	
Staff costs	
	
	
2.8	
Earnings per share	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
2.1	Revenue	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Revenue is measured based on the consideration specified in a contract with a customer and excludes amounts collected 
on behalf of third parties. The Group recognises revenue when it transfers control over a product or service to a 
customer.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
 
The following is a description of principal activities from which the Group generates its revenue categorised by the 
reportable segments as detailed in note 2.3.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
UK Motor segment and US Motor segment
 
The UK Motor and US Motor segments principally generate revenue from the sale of new and used motor vehicles, together 
with the supply of motor vehicle parts, servicing and repair activities, collectively referred to as aftersales.  Products and 
services may be sold separately or in bundled packages. Examples of a bundled package will include the supply of a vehicle 
with an extended warranty or a servicing plan. For bundled packages, the Group accounts for individual products and 
services separately as they are distinct items, as each performance obligation within that contract is separately identifiable 
from other items in the bundled package. The consideration is proportionately allocated between separate products and 
services in a bundle based on their stand-alone selling prices. The stand-alone selling prices are determined based on the 
list prices at which the Group sells these items and are separately identified on the customer's invoice. 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group has a number of manufacturer partners who will provide goods/services to customers, for example a warranty 
or free servicing when purchasing a new vehicle. Such items do not have a contractual obligation on the Group as the 
obligation lies with the manufacturer and therefore no revenue is recognised in respect of these items. 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

128
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Products 
and services	
Nature, timing of satisfaction of performance obligations and significant payment terms 
New and used 
vehicles, parts and 
accessories
	
The Group recognises revenue on the sale of motor vehicles and parts revenue when they have 
been supplied to the customer. The satisfaction of the performance obligation occurs on delivery 
or collection of the product. Vehicles are usually paid for prior to delivery though selected 
corporate operators may be granted terms of up to seven days. Parts are either paid for on 
delivery or within one month, dependant upon whether or not the customer is retail or has trade 
terms.
Aftersales service 
and repairs	
	
The Group recognises revenue when the one time service has been completed.  Revenue is 
recognised at this point provided that the revenue and costs can be measured reliably, the 
recovery of the consideration is probable and there is no continuing management involvement 
with the goods. Payment terms are upon completion of the service or within one month, 
dependant upon whether or not the customer is retail or trade.
Commissions 
received	
The Group receives commissions when it arranges finance and insurance packages for its 
customers to purchase its products and services, acting as agent on behalf of various finance and 
insurance companies. Any commission earned is recognised when the customer draws down the 
finance or commences the insurance policy from the supplier which coincides with the delivery of 
the product or service. Commissions receivable are paid typically in the month after the finance is 
drawn down.
Vehicle warranty 
	
The Group offers a warranty product on vehicles supplied with a guarantee period typically 
ranging from 3 months to 3 years. The Group recognises revenue on warranties on a straight-line 
basis over the warranty period. The performance obligation of the Group, being the rectification 
of mechanical faults on vehicles sold, will be the period over which the customer can exercise 
their rights under the warranty and therefore revenue should be recognised over the period of 
the warranty. Warranties are paid for prior to the commencement of the policy. The unrecognised 
income is held within deferred income (see note 3.8). There were no such warranties offered for 
sale in the US Motor segment.
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.1	Revenue continued
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

129
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.1	Revenue continued	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Leasing	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The leasing segment generates revenue from the provision of vehicle leasing services, principally to fleets run by various 
commercial operators. Vehicles are supplied to customers on operating leases and may include servicing and maintenance 
agreements, which are bundled into the overall contract.  For bundled packages, the Group accounts for individual products 
and services separately as they are distinct items, as each performance obligation within that contract is separately 
identifiable from other items in the bundled package. At the end of each contract the Group will generate revenue from 
the disposal of the vehicle, recovery of any rectification work and in some instances additional rentals beyond the original 
contract term.
	
	 	
	
	
Products 
and services	
Nature, timing of satisfaction of performance obligations and significant payment terms 
Leasing
	
Where vehicles are supplied to a leasing group for contract hire purposes and the Group 
undertakes to repurchase the vehicle at a predetermined date and value the transfer of control is 
deemed not to have transferred outside the Group and consequently no sale is recognised. As a 
result the accounting for the arrangement reflects the Group's retention of the asset to generate 
future rentals and, in accordance with IFRS 16 Leases, the Group is considered to be an operating 
lessor for all arrangements in place. The initial amounts received in consideration from the 
leasing group are held as deferred income allocated between the present value of the repurchase 
commitment, held within trade and other payables and a residual amount of deferred revenue held 
within deferred income. A finance charge is accrued against the present value of the repurchase 
commitment and recorded as a finance expense in the income statement. The remaining deferred 
revenue, which effectively represents rentals received in advance, is taken to the income 
statement on a straight line basis over the related lease term. No additional disclosures are made 
under IFRS 16 as there are no future rentals receivable. These vehicles are held within 'property, 
plant and equipment' at their cost to the Group and are depreciated to their residual values over 
the terms of the leases. These assets are transferred into inventory at their carrying amount when 
they cease to be rented and they become available for sale as part of the Group's ordinary course 
of business. Rentals are billed and paid for on a monthly basis.
Maintenance
	
	
The Group offer a maintenance contract to customers to cover routine servicing and unexpected 
repairs of vehicles under a leasing contract. Revenue is recognised over the period of the contract 
on a straight line basis. Maintenance contracts are billed and paid for on a monthly basis.
Used Vehicles
	
The Group recognises revenue on the sale of ex contract hire motor vehicles when they have been 
supplied to the customer. This occurs on delivery or collection of the product. Vehicles are paid for 
on delivery.
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

130
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.1	Revenue continued	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Software	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group, through its Pinewood business, supplies dealer management systems to motor vehicle dealers. These systems 
include consultancy, training and installation services and the right to use the Group's software over a contractual period. 
Products and services may be sold separately or in bundled packages. Examples of a bundled package will include system 
consultancy, on and off site training for users together with the right for a number of users to use the software.  For 
bundled packages, the Group accounts for individual products and services separately as they are distinct items, as 
each performance obligation within that contract is separately identifiable from other items in the bundled package. 
The consideration is allocated between separate products and services in a bundle based on their stand-alone selling 
prices. The stand-alone selling prices are determined based on the list prices at which the Group sells these items and are 
separately identified on the customer's contract and subsequent invoice.
Products 
and services	
Nature, timing of satisfaction of performance obligations and significant payment terms 
Software
	
Pinewood supply its software on a hosting basis and licence specific numbers of users to access 
this service. As such Pinewood supply 'Software as a Service' (SaaS). The software licences 
are provided only in conjunction with a hosting service, the customer cannot take control of 
the licence or use the software without the hosting service and as such the customer cannot 
benefit from the licence on its own and the licence is not separable from the hosting services. 
Therefore, the licence is not distinct and would be combined with the hosting service. The Group's 
assessment of its performance obligation under IFRS 15 of providing SaaS is that revenue is 
recognised over the period of the contract. SaaS is billed one month in advance of a quarterly 
billing cycle ensuring payment is received prior to commencement of usage.
Training, 
Installation and 
Consultancy
The Group recognises revenue on the provision of any consultancy time, training and installation 
at the point of providing and delivering the service. Consultancy hours are billed at the time of 
delivery. Training courses are billed at the time of booking which may be in advance of the date 
the training is scheduled for. Installation hours are billed at the time of completion of the service. 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

131
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.1	Revenue continued	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Disaggregation of revenue	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
In the following table, revenue is disaggregated by primary geographical market, major products/service lines and timing 
of revenue recognition. The table also includes a reconciliation of the disaggregated revenue with the Group’s four strategic 
divisions, which are its reportable segments, see note 2.3
__UK Motor __
__Software__ 
__Leasing__
     discontinued      
__US Motor__
____Total____ 
 
2022
£m
 
2021
£m
 
2022
£m
 
2021
£m
 
2022
£m
 
2021
£m
 
2022
£m
 
2021
£m
2022
£m
2021
£m
Primary geographical 
markets
Europe 
3,536.2 
3,332.7 
18.1 
18.8 
64.7 
69.1 
 - 
 - 
3,619.0 
3,420.6 
North America
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
28.6 
 - 
28.6 
Africa
 - 
 - 
0.6 
0.5 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.6 
0.5 
Asia
 - 
 - 
0.4 
0.2 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.4 
0.2 
Revenue from external 
customers
3,536.2 
3,332.7 
19.1 
19.5 
64.7 
69.1 
 - 
28.6 
3,620.0 
3,449.9 
Major products/service 
lines
Aftersales revenue
276.1 
261.9 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
2.8 
276.1 
264.7 
Used vehicle revenue 
1,808.6 
1,708.4 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
3.0 
1,808.6 
1,711.4 
New vehicle revenue
1,451.5 
1,362.4 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
22.8 
1,451.5 
1,385.2 
Software revenue
 - 
 - 
19.1 
19.5 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
19.1 
19.5 
Leasing revenue
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
64.7 
69.1 
 - 
 - 
64.7 
69.1 
Revenue from external 
customers
3,536.2 
3,332.7 
19.1 
19.5 
64.7 
69.1 
 - 
28.6 
3,620.0 
3,449.9 
  
Timing of revenue 
recognition
At point in time
3,526.7 
3,322.7 
1.4 
1.9 
30.9 
32.1 
 - 
28.6 
3,559.0 
3,385.3 
Over time
9.5 
10.0 
17.7 
17.6 
33.8 
37.0 
 - 
 - 
61.0 
64.6 
Revenue from external 
customers
3,536.2 
3,332.7 
19.1 
19.5 
64.7 
69.1 
 - 
28.6 
3,620.0 
3,449.9 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

132
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
2.1	Revenue continued
 
Movements in the deferred income balance in respect of the warranty policies is presented in note 3.8 which shows the 
value of policies sold during the year and the income recognised during the year. 
2.2	Net operating expenses
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
Contract liabilities
The Group recognises the following contract liabilities:
2022
£m
2021
£m
Deposits received from customers
30.4 
26.2 
Unearned proportion of warranty policies sold
21.2 
16.5 
2022
£m
2021
£m
Net operating expenses:
Distribution costs
 (185.2)
 (171.5)
Administrative expenses
 (181.3)
 (166.5)
Impairment loss on trade receivables
 (0.3)
 (0.2)
Rents received
2.9 
1.8 
 (363.9)
 (336.4)
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

133
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
2.3	Operating segments	
	
The Group has revised its reporting segments.  In January 2022 the Group re-organised its management and reporting 
structure.  The significant changes were that the Franchised UK Motor and Car Store operations were brought under the 
management of the UK Motor operation. This revised segmental structure is reflected in the internal reporting structure as 
presented to the Chief Operating Decision Maker.  In the 2022 financial statements therefore, the Franchised UK Motor and 
Car Store segments are no longer reported separately.  	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
The results of the Franchised UK Motor and Car Store segments for the comparative period have been aggregated into the 
new UK Motor Group segment and is re-presented as follows for the period ended 31 December 2021: 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
UK Motor segment restatement
	
Following the revisions to the Group’s operating segments as outlined above there are now four reportable segments, 
as described below, which are the Group's strategic business units. The segments offer different ranges of products and 
services and are managed separately because they require their own specialism in terms of market and product. For 
each of these segments, the Executive Committee which is deemed to be the Chief Operating Decision Maker (CODM), 
reviews internal management reports on at least a monthly basis. The review of these management reports enables the 
CODM to allocate resources to each segment and form the basis of strategic and operational decisions, such as acquisition 
strategy,closure programme or working capital allocation. The following summary describes the operations in each of the 
Group's reportable segments: 
 
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
Franchised 
UK Motor 
£m
Car Store
£m
UK Motor 
segment as 
restated 
31 Dec 21 
£m
Total gross segment revenue
3,191.2 
141.5 
3,332.7 
Inter-segment revenue
 - 
 - 
 - 
Revenue from external customers
3,191.2 
141.5 
3,332.7 
   
Operating profit before non-underlying 
items
85.8 
1.6 
87.4 
Other income and non-underlying items
 (4.5)
 (0.3)
 (4.8)
Operating profit
81.3 
1.3 
82.6 
Finance expense
 - 
 - 
 - 
Finance income
 - 
 - 
 - 
Segmental profit before tax
81.3 
1.3 
82.6 
Other items included in the income statement are as follows:
Depreciation and impairment
 (31.1)
 (0.1)
 (31.2)
Impairment of property, plant and equipment
 (4.3)
 (0.3)
 (4.6)
Amortisation
 (0.4)
 - 
 (0.4)
Share based payments
 (2.9)
 - 
 (2.9)
Termination and severance costs
 (1.8)
 - 
 (1.8)
Business closure costs
 (0.2)
 - 
 (0.2)
Other income - profit on the sale of business-
es and property, plant and equipment
1.8 
 - 
1.8 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

134
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
2.3	Operating segments continued
	
UK Motor. This segment comprises the Group's motor vehicle retail, parts wholesale and fleet operations from its 
franchised dealer network and the Group's used vehicle retail operation branded Car Store. These encompass the sale 
of new and used motor cars, motorbikes, trucks and vans, together with associated aftersales activities of service, body 
repair and parts sales. 	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Software. This segment comprises the Group's activities as a dealer management systems provider. 	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Leasing. This segment comprises the Group's contract hire and leasing activities.	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
US Motor. This segment comprises the Group's retail operation in California in the United States encompassing the sale 
of new and used motor cars, together with associated aftersales activities of service and parts sales. This segment ceased 
trading in 2021 following the sale of its remaining stores. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
 
The tables of financial performance presented in the Operational and Financial Review on pages 24 to 37 are based upon 
these segmental reports.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
Inter-segment transfers and transactions are entered into under normal commercial terms and conditions that would also 
be available to unrelated third parties.
	
	
Year ended 31 December 2022
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
UK Motor
£m
Software
£m
Leasing
£m
Group
interest
£m
Continuing
operations
Sub total
£m
Discontinued
operations
US Motor
£m
Total 
£m
Total gross segment revenue
3,536.2 
25.4 
83.7 
 - 
3,645.3 
 - 
3,645.3 
Inter-segment revenue
 - 
 (6.3)
 (19.0)
 - 
 (25.3)
 - 
 (25.3)
Revenue from external customers
3,536.2 
19.1 
64.7 
 - 
3,620.0 
 - 
3,620.0 
Operating profit/(loss) before non-underlying 
items
69.1 
11.0 
19.9 
 - 
100.0 
 (1.5)
98.5 
Non-underlying items
2.5 
 - 
 - 
 - 
2.5 
 - 
2.5 
Operating profit/(loss)
71.6 
11.0 
19.9 
 - 
102.5 
 (1.5)
101.0 
Finance expense
 - 
 - 
 (2.5)
 (42.3)
 (44.8)
 - 
 (44.8)
Finance income
 - 
 - 
 - 
1.0 
1.0 
 - 
1.0 
Segmental profit/(loss) before tax
71.6 
11.0 
17.4 
 (41.3)
58.7 
 (1.5)
57.2 
Other items included in the income statement are as follows:
Depreciation and impairment
 (28.5)
 (0.1)
 (36.1)
 -   
 (64.7)
 - 
 (64.7)
Impairment of property, plant and equipment
1.2 
 - 
 - 
 -   
1.2 
 - 
1.2 
Amortisation
 (0.6)
 (4.2)
 (0.1)
 -   
 (4.9)
 - 
 (4.9)
Share based payments
3.3 
 - 
 - 
 -   
3.3 
 - 
3.3 
Termination and severance costs
 (0.2)
 - 
 - 
 -   
 (0.2)
 - 
 (0.2)
Business closure costs
0.2 
 - 
 - 
 -   
0.2 
 - 
0.2 
Other income - profit on the sale of businesses 
and property, plant and equipment
7.7 
 - 
 - 
 -   
7.7 
 - 
7.7 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING

135
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2.3	Operating segments continued	
	
Year ended 31 December 2021
	
Geographical information.	
	
	
All segments, with the exception of the US Motor Group in the United States originate in the United Kingdom. The US Motor 
Group segment is a discontinued operation.
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
UK Motor
£m
Software
£m
Leasing
£m
Group
interest
£m
Continuing
operations
Sub total
£m
Discontinued
operations
US Motor
£m
Total 
£m
Total gross segment revenue
3,332.7 
24.4 
89.9 
 - 
3,447.0 
28.6 
3,475.6 
Inter-segment revenue
 - 
 (4.9)
 (20.8)
 - 
 (25.7)
 - 
 (25.7)
Revenue from external customers
3,332.7 
19.5 
69.1 
 - 
3,421.3 
28.6 
3,449.9 
Operating profit before non-underlying items
87.4 
12.5 
17.5 
 - 
117.4 
 (1.1)
116.3 
Non-underlying items
 (4.8)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (4.8)
 (3.9)
 (8.7)
Operating profit
82.6 
12.5 
17.5 
 - 
112.6 
 (5.0)
107.6 
Finance expense
 - 
 - 
 (2.7)
 (32.2)
 (34.9)
 (0.3)
 (35.2)
Finance income
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.9 
0.9 
 - 
0.9 
Segmental profit before tax
82.6 
12.5 
14.8 
 (31.3)
78.6 
 (5.3)
73.3 
Other items included in the income statement are as follows:
Depreciation and impairment
 (31.2)
 (0.6)
 (38.5)
 -   
 (70.3)
 (0.1)
 (70.4)
Impairment of property, plant and equipment
 (4.6)
 - 
 - 
 -   
 (4.6)
 (5.0)
 (9.6)
Amortisation
 (0.4)
 (3.7)
 (0.1)
 -   
 (4.2)
 - 
 (4.2)
Share based payments
 (2.9)
 - 
 - 
 -   
 (2.9)
 - 
 (2.9)
Termination and severance costs
 (1.8)
 - 
 - 
 -   
 (1.8)
 - 
 (1.8)
Business closure costs
 (0.2)
 - 
 - 
 -   
 (0.2)
0.2 
 - 
Other income - profit on the sale of businesses 
and property, plant and equipment
1.8 
 - 
 - 
 -   
1.8 
0.9 
2.7 

136
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
2.4	Staff costs
	
 
The average number of people employed by the Group in the following areas was:
	
Costs incurred in respect of these employees were:
	
	
Information relating to directors' emoluments, share options and pension entitlements is set out in the Directors' 
Remuneration Report on pages 77 to 95.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
During the previous year the Group appropriately used government assistance from the Coronavirus Job Retention 
Scheme and has benefitted from £1.6m of furlough support during 2021, which was recognised against the wages and 
salaries expense. The furlough support is included in the underlying result as the Group do not consider it to meet the 
definition of non-underlying when taken together with the payroll costs that the amount compensates for. No Government 
grants were received in 2022. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	
2.5	Audit fees
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2022
Number
2021
Number
Sales
1,823 
1,811 
Aftersales
2,487 
2,470 
Administration
1,216 
1,208 
5,526 
5,489 
2022
£m
2021
£m
Wages and salaries
192.1 
182.9 
Less -  receipts from the Government Coronavirus Job Retention Scheme
 - 
 (1.6)
Social security costs
20.4 
17.9 
Contributions to defined contribution plans (see note 5.1)
11.7 
7.2 
Cost recognised for defined benefit plans (see note 5.1)
0.3 
1.0 
Share based payments (see note 4.6)
3.3 
2.9 
227.8 
210.3 
Auditor’s remuneration:
2022
£000
2021
£000
Fees payable to the company's Auditor for the audit of the company's annual accounts
770.0 
513.0 
Fees payable to the company's Auditor and its associates for other services:
Audit of the company's subsidiaries pursuant to legislation
385.0 
300.0 
Audit-related assurance services
155.0
140.0 
1,310.0 
953.0 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

137
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.6	Non-underlying items	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Non-underlying income and expenses are items that are not incurred in the normal course of business and are sufficiently 
significant and/or irregular to impact the underlying trends in the business.
 
The following amounts have been presented as non-underlying items in these financial statements: 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Goodwill has been reviewed for any possible impairment and as a result of this review there was an impairment charge of 
£3.6m made during the year (2021: £nil) (see note 3.1). The £3.6m impairment related to the goodwill in respect of the DAF 
business which was classified for sale when the Group presented its interim results at 30 June 2022, prior to its eventual 
sale in October 2022.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Group property, plant and equipment and assets held for sale have been reviewed for possible impairments. As a result of 
this review there was no impairment charge against assets held for sale made during the year (2021: £nil) and property, 
plant and equipment of £1.2m (of which £0.2m was in respect of right of use assets) (2021: £9.6m all right of use assets). 
There were no reversals of previous impairment charges in respect of assets held for sale where anticipated proceeds less 
costs to sell have increased over their impaired carrying values (2021: £nil).	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Within operating expenses:
Impairment of goodwill
 (3.6)
 - 
Impairment of property, plant and equipment
 (1.0)
 - 
Impairment of right of use assets
 (0.2)
 (9.6)
Termination and severance costs
 (0.2)
 (1.8)
Aborted transaction related expenses
 (0.4)
 - 
Business closure income
0.2 
 - 
 (5.2)
 (11.4)
Within other income - gains on the sale of businesses, property, plant and equipment:
Gains on the sale of businesses
0.3 
0.7 
Gains on the sale of property 
7.4 
2.0 
7.7 
2.7 
Within net finance expense:
Costs incurred on refinancing
 (2.6)
 - 
Net interest on pension scheme obligations
 (0.3)
 (1.0)
 (2.9)
 (1.0)
Total non-underlying items before tax
 (0.4)
 (9.7)
Non-underlying items in tax
1.4 
2.2 
Total non-underlying items after tax
1.0 
 (7.5)
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

138
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.6	Non-underlying items continued 
	
There were termination and severance costs of £0.2m in FY22 (2021: £1.8m of which £1.3m related to the transfer of 
Finance process from dealerships to a centralised shared service centre as part of the Finance Transformation in the UK). 
This cost is driven by a combination of a small number of redundancy payments and relocation costs.	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
During the year approaches and subsequent bids were made by external parties to the purchase the Company. As a 
consequence professional and advisory fees of £0.4m were incurred in assisting with the due diligence process undertaken 
by the parties.  No internal costs have been allocated against this process as non-underlying in respect of time and 
resource of Group management.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
Following the disposal of the US business in 2021 a release of an over accrued settlement resulted in a credit of £0.2m 
being recognised in the year.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
Other income consists of the profit or loss on disposal of businesses and property, plant and equipment. This comprises a 
£0.3m gain (2021: £0.7m gain in respect of discontinued operations ) on disposals of motor vehicle dealerships during the 
year, a £7.4m profit on sale of properties (2021: £2.0m). These do not include routine transactions in relation to the disposal 
of individual assets, and only relates to the disposal or closure of motor vehicle dealerships and associated properties.	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
During the year, upon the successful completion of the refinancing of the Group in March 2022, a net loss of £2.6m was 
recorded which comprised of settlement of obligations under the previous arrangement.   
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The net financing return on pension obligations in respect of the defined benefit schemes closed to future accrual is shown 
as a non-underlying item due to the irregularity of this amount historically and it is not incurred in the normal course of 
business. A net expense of £0.3m has been recognised during the year (2021: £1.0m).	 	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

139
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.7	Taxation	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Income tax comprises current and deferred tax. Income tax is recognised in the income statement except to the extent 
that it relates to items recognised directly in other comprehensive income, in which case it is recognised in the statement 
of comprehensive income.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
Current tax is the expected tax payable on the taxable income for the year, using tax rates enacted or substantively 
enacted at the balance sheet date, and any adjustment to tax payable in respect of previous years.	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Deferred tax is recognised using the balance sheet liability method, recognising temporary differences between the 
carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for taxation purposes. 
The following temporary differences are not recognised: initial recognition of goodwill, the initial recognition of assets or 
liabilities in a transaction that is not a business combination that affect neither accounting nor taxable profit. The amount 
of deferred tax recognised is based on the expected manner of realisation or settlement of the carrying amount of assets 
and liabilities, using tax rates enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
A deferred tax asset is recognised only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against 
which the asset can be utilised. Deferred tax assets are reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that the related 
tax benefit will be realised. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
Estimates and judgements	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The actual tax on the Group's profits is determined according to complex laws and regulations. Where the effect of 
these laws and regulations is unclear, estimates are used in determining the liability for the tax to be paid on profits 
which are recognised in the financial statements. The Group considers the estimates, assumptions and judgements to be 
reasonable but this can involve complex issues which may take a number of years to resolve. The final determination of tax 
liabilities could be different from the estimates reflected in the financial statements but the Group believes that none have 
a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amount of the liability within the next financial year. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Deferred tax assets and liabilities require management judgement in determining the amounts to be recognised. In particular, 
judgement is used when assessing the extent to which deferred tax assets should be recognised with consideration given 
to the timing and level of future taxable income. The unrecognised deferred tax assets are disclosed below. 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

140
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.7	Taxation continued
Taxation - Income statement	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
UK corporation tax:
Current tax on profit for the year
2.6 
3.9 
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
0.3 
 - 
2.9 
3.9 
Overseas taxation:
Current tax on profit for the year
 - 
1.1 
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
 - 
 (0.9)
 - 
0.2 
Total current tax 
2.9 
4.1 
Deferred tax expense:
Origination and reversal of temporary differences
8.3 
8.2 
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
0.5 
 (0.5)
Total deferred tax
8.8 
7.7 
Total income tax expense in the income statement
11.7 
11.8 
Factors affecting the tax charge for the period:
The tax assessed is different from the standard rate of corporation tax in the UK of 
19.00% (2021: 19.00%)
The differences are explained below:
2022
£m
2021
£m
Profit before taxation
57.2 
73.3 
Tax on profit at UK rate of 19.00% (2021: 19.00%)
10.9 
13.9 
Differences:
Tax effect of expenses that are not deductible in determining taxable profit
0.6 
0.5 
Permanent differences arising in respect of fixed assets
0.5 
0.8 
Unrecognised losses
0.3 
0.1 
Tax rate differential on overseas income
 - 
 (0.1)
Non-underlying items (see below)
 (1.4)
 (0.4)
Impact of UK corporation tax rate change
 - 
 (1.6)
Adjustments to tax charge in respect of previous periods
0.8 
 (1.4)
Total income tax expense in the income statement
11.7 
11.8 
Taxation - Other comprehensive income
2022
£m
2021
£m
Relating to defined benefit plan remeasurement gains
 (1.6)
 (6.9)
Other short term temporary differences
 (0.1)
0.3 
 (1.7)
 (6.6)
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

141
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.7	Taxation continued
	
Tax rate	
	
 
The UK tax rate applying throughout 2022 was 19%, this rate is set to increase to 25% on 1 April 2023.  The rate change 
to 25% was substantively enacted on 24 May 2021 and as such in the prior year the portion of the deferred tax assets and 
liabilities forecast to remain at 31 March 2023 were revalued to 25% which gave a tax credit to the 2021 income statement 
of £1.6m. 
 
In 2021 the US operations ceased trading following the disposal of the remaining two dealerships.  During 2022 the US 
operations incurred winding-up costs on which no deferred tax asset has been recognised.
	
Factors affecting the tax charge	
	
	
The tax charge is decreased by the release of prior year provisions relating to UK corporation tax returns.  The tax charge 
is increased by the incidence of non-deductible expenses including the impairment of goodwill and non-qualifying 
depreciation. 
	
	
Non-underlying tax credit	
	
	
The tax credit in relation to non-underlying items referred to in note 2.6 is £1.4m (2021: £2.2m). The tax credit is higher than 
the non-underlying loss multiplied by the tax rate (19%) due to a portion of gains on disposal of property being covered by 
capital losses or roll-over relief (which consitute utilisation of previously unrecognised deferred tax assets, see below).
	
	
Unrecognised deferred tax assets	
	
 
There are unutilised tax losses within the Group of £13.8m (2021: £13.8m) relating to former overseas businesses for 
which no deferred tax asset has been recognised pending the clarity of the availability of intra-EU losses. There are also 
unrecognised capital losses net of rolled over gains of £52.5m (2021: £46.7m).  During 2021 Pinewood established an 
operation in Sweden, this Swedish subsidiary has been loss making in its start-up phase and no deferred tax asset has 
been recognised on the cumulative losses of £0.1m.  Operations in the USA are now in a winding-down phase following 
the disposal of the remaining two car dealerships in 2021.  No deferred tax asset has been recognised on the US losses of 
£1.2m.  The unrecognised carried forward losses related to operations in Sweden and the USA carry forward indefinitely. 
The UK capital losses carry forward indefinitely but are subject to restriction on their use when capital gains are realised. 
	
	
Deferred tax assets/(liabilities) 	
	
 
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets 
against current tax liabilities and when the deferred income taxes relate to the same fiscal authority. The deferred tax 
assets all relate to the UK.
2022
£m
2021
£m
Deferred tax assets
11.6 
22.1 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

142
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.7	Taxation continued
 
The table below outlines the deferred tax assets/(liabilities) that are recognised on the balance sheet, together with their 
movements in the year; 
 
The Group remained profitable in 2022 after returning to profit in 2021.  During 2022 £3.4m of the deferred tax asset in 
respect of losses was utilised.  The use of losses is restricted to 50% of taxable profits over £5.0m resulting in a spreading 
of losses across periods where brought forward losses are over £5.0m.  The deferred tax asset on losses remaining at 31 
December 2022 is £3.9m.  This deferred tax asset on losses has been recognised as it is considered probable that the losses 
will be utilised.  In order to support the recognition of the £3.9m asset on losses, modelling was undertaken to review 
the recovery period of the deferred tax asset.  The modelling was based on management forecasts and showed that the 
deferred tax asset on losses is expected to be recovered by 2024.  A plausible downside case was also modelled which 
included reduced sales volumes and margins and is the same model used for going-concern analysis; this downside case 
modelling showed that the deferred tax asset on losses would also be recovered by 2024.
	
	
	 	
	
	
 
At 1
January
 2021
 £m 
(Charged)/
Credited to 
consolidated
 income
 statement
 £m 
(Charged)/
Credited
to other
comprehensive
income
 £m 
 At 31 
 December 
 2021 
 £m 
Property, plant and equipment
5.8 
2.2 
 - 
8.0 
Retirement benefit obligations
14.5 
 (2.5)
 (6.9)
5.1 
Other short term temporary differences
0.7 
0.7 
0.3 
1.7 
Losses
15.4 
 (8.1)
 - 
7.3 
Tax assets	
36.4 
 (7.7)
 (6.6)
22.1 
 
At 1
January
 2022
 £m 
(Charged) to 
consolidated
 income
 statement
 £m 
(Charged)
to other
comprehensive
income
 £m 
 At 31 
 December 
 2022 
 £m 
Property, plant and equipment
8.0 
 (1.7)
 - 
6.3 
Retirement benefit obligations
5.1 
 (2.5)
 (1.6)
1.0 
Other short term temporary differences
1.7 
 (1.2)
 (0.1)
0.4 
Losses
7.3 
 (3.4)
 - 
3.9 
Tax assets/(liabilities)	
22.1 
 (8.8)
 (1.7)
11.6 
    
  
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

143
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 2 - RESULTS AND TRADING
2.8	Earnings per share	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
The Group presents basic and diluted earnings per share (‘EPS’) data for its ordinary shares. Basic EPS is calculated by 
dividing the profit or loss attributable to ordinary shareholders of the Group by the weighted average number of ordinary 
shares in issue during the period. The shares held by the EBT have been excluded from the calculation until such time 
as they vest unconditionally with the employees. Diluted EPS is calculated by dividing the profit and loss attributable to 
ordinary shareholders by the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue taking account of the effects of all 
dilutive potential ordinary shares, which comprise of share options granted to employees and LTIPs.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
Earnings per share calculation	
 2022
Earnings 
per share 
 pence 
 2022
Earnings
 Total 
 £m 
 2021
Earnings 
per share 
 pence 
 2021
Earnings
 Total 
 £m 
Basic earnings per share from continuing operations
3.3 
45.5 
4.7 
65.5 
Basic earnings per share from discontinued operations
 - 
 - 
 (0.3)
 (4.0)
Basic earnings per share
3.3 
45.5 
4.4 
61.5 
Adjusting items:
Non-underlying items attributable to the parent from continuing operations
 - 
0.4 
0.4 
5.8 
Non-underlying items attributable to the parent from discontinued operations
 - 
 - 
0.3 
3.9 
Non-underlying items attributable to the parent (see note 2.6)
 - 
0.4 
0.7 
9.7 
Tax effect of non-underlying items from continuing operations
 (0.1)
 (1.4)
 (0.3)
 (3.1)
Tax effect of non-underlying items from discontinued operations
 - 
 - 
0.1 
0.9 
Tax effect of non-underlying items
 (0.1)
 (1.4)
 (0.2)
 (2.2)
Underlying earnings per share from continuing operations (Non-GAAP measure)
3.2 
44.5 
4.9 
68.2 
Underlying earnings per share from discontinued operations (Non-GAAP measure)
 - 
 - 
0.1 
0.8 
Underlying earnings per share (Non-GAAP measure)
3.2 
44.5 
5.0 
69.0 
Diluted earnings per share from continuing operations
3.1 
45.5 
4.6 
65.5 
Diluted earnings per share from discontinued operations
 - 
 - 
 (0.3)
 (4.0)
Diluted earnings per share 
3.1 
45.5 
4.3 
61.5 
Diluted earnings per share - underlying from continuing operations (Non-GAAP measure)
3.1 
44.5 
4.8 
68.2 
Diluted earnings per share - underlying from discontinued operations (Non-GAAP measure)
 - 
 - 
0.1 
0.8 
Diluted earnings per share - underlying (Non-GAAP measure)
3.1 
44.5 
4.9 
69.0 
The calculation of basic, adjusted and diluted earnings per share is based on 
the following number of shares in issue (millions):
 2022
Number 
 2021
Number 
Weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue
1,392.9 
1,390.7 
Weighted average number of dilutive shares under option
51.8 
25.1 
Weighted average number of shares in issue taking account of applicable 
outstanding share options
1,444.7 
1,415.8 
Non-dilutive shares under option
20.7 
28.7 
The Directors consider that the underlying earnings per share figure provides a better measure of comparative performance.
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

144
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
	
This section contains the notes and information to support those assets and liabilities presented in the Consolidated 
Balance Sheet that relate to the Group’s operating activities.	
 
3.1 
Intangible assets and goodwill 
 
3.5 
Movement in contract hire vehicle balances 
	
3.2	
Property, plant and equipment	
	
3.6	
Trade and other receivables
	
3.3	
Assets held for sale and discontinued operations	 	
3.7	
Trade and other payables	 	
	
	
3.4	 Inventories	
	
3.8	
Deferred income	
	
	 	
3.1	Intangible assets and goodwill	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
Accounting policies	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
All business combinations are accounted for by applying the purchase method. Goodwill represents the excess of the cost 
of acquisition over the net fair value of the identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities of the acquired subsidiary 
undertakings at the effective date of acquisition and is included in the balance sheet under the heading of intangible 
assets. The goodwill is allocated to cash generating units (CGUs), which are franchise groups and other business units. 
An impairment test is performed annually as detailed below. Goodwill is then held in the balance sheet at cost less any 
accumulated impairment losses.	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
 
Adjustments are applied to bring the accounting policies of the acquired businesses into alignment with those of the 
Group. The costs associated with reorganising or restructuring are charged to the post acquisition income statement. For 
those acquisitions made prior to 1 January 2004, goodwill is recorded on the basis of its deemed cost which represented 
its carrying value as at 1 January 2004 under UK GAAP. Fair value adjustments are made in respect of acquisitions. If 
at the balance sheet date the fair value of the acquiree’s identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities can only 
be established provisionally then these values are used. Any adjustments to these values made within 12 months of the 
acquisition date are taken as adjustments to goodwill.  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
Internally generated intangible assets relate to activities that involve the development of dealer management systems 
by the Group’s Pinewood division. Development expenditure is capitalised only if development costs can be measured 
reliably, the product is technically and commercially feasible, future economic benefits are probable and the Group intends 
to and has sufficient resources to complete development and to use or sell the asset. The expenditure capitalised includes 
the costs of labour and overhead costs that are directly attributable to preparing the asset for its intended use. If the 
development expenditure does not meet the above criteria it is expensed to the income statement.	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Capitalised development expenditure is measured at cost less accumulated amortisation and accumulated impairment 
losses and is amortised over a period of five years. 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
 
Intangible assets other than goodwill are stated at cost less accumulated amortisation and any impairment losses. This 
category of asset includes purchased computer software and internally generated intangible assets which are amortised 
by equal instalments over four years and the fair value of the benefit of forward sales orders assumed on acquisition, which 
is amortised by reference to when those orders are delivered. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	 	
 
Subsequent expenditure on capitalised intangible assets is capitalised only when it increases the future economic benefits 
embodied in the specific asset to which it relates. All other expenditure is expensed as incurred.  
 
 
	 	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
 
Intangible assets arising on an acquisition are recognised separately from goodwill if the fair value of the asset can be 
identified separately and measured reliably. Amortisation is calculated on a straight line basis over the estimated useful life 
of the intangible asset. Amortisation methods and useful lives are reviewed annually and adjusted if appropriate.
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

145
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.1	Intangible assets and goodwill continued
	
	 	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
   Goodwill 
 £m 
  Development
 costs 
 £m 
  Other
intangibles
 £m 
 Total 
 £m 
Cost 
At 1 January 2021
406.8 
20.4 
4.4 
431.6 
Additions
 - 
5.0 
0.1 
5.1 
At 31 December 2021
406.8 
25.4 
4.5 
436.7 
At 1 January 2022
406.8 
25.4 
4.5 
436.7 
Additions
 - 
5.7 
0.5 
6.2 
Disposals
 (8.2)
 - 
 (0.1)
 (8.3)
At 31 December 2022
398.6 
31.1 
4.9 
434.6 
Amortisation
At 1 January 2021
256.5 
11.0 
3.6 
271.1 
Amortised during the year
 - 
3.7 
0.5 
4.2 
At 31 December 2021
256.5 
14.7 
4.1 
275.3 
At 1 January 2022
256.5 
14.7 
4.1 
275.3 
Amortised during the year
 - 
4.2 
0.7 
4.9 
Impairment of goodwill on sale of DAF business
3.6 
 - 
 - 
3.6 
Disposals
 (6.1)
 - 
 (0.1)
 (6.2)
At 31 December 2022
254.0 
18.9 
4.7 
277.6
Carrying amounts
  
At 1 January 2021
150.3 
9.4 
0.8 
160.5 
At 31 December 2021
150.3 
10.7 
0.4 
161.4 
At 31 December 2022
144.6 
12.2 
0.2 
157.0 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

146
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.1	Intangible assets and goodwill continued
	
Goodwill is allocated across multiple cash-generating units which are UK Motor franchise groups, Pinewood and Leasing. 
This is the lowest level at which cash-generating units are formed. Therefore there is a consistent approach to performing 
the annual impairment test to assess the carrying value of this amount is taken. This value was determined by comparing 
the carrying value of the asset with the higher of its fair value less costs to sell (where value is determined by applying 
a trading multiple to the estimated future cash flow or by assessing the depreciated replacement cost of the individual 
assets) and value in use (where value is determined by discounting the future cash flows generated from the continuing 
use of the unit and was based on the following key assumptions): 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
Future cash flows were projected into perpetuity with reference to the Group’s forecasts for 2023. The 2023 forecast was 
derived from the corporate plan, approved by the Board and compiled on a bottom up basis. New car volume growth was 
based on the latest SMMT forecasts. Used car and aftersales revenue and gross profit growth has been based on latest run-
rates for the CGUs. The 2024 to 2027 forecast represents a projection from the 2023 bottom up forecast with new volume 
growth based on the latest market projections and run-rates applied to determine used volume growth, with associated 
gross profits calculated from adjusted GPUs. Short term income and costs growth have been applied at 2.0% and 2.5% 
respectively. These have been applied based on short term market inflation assumptions. The directors have considered 
the impact of climate change in respect of the impairment testing of goodwill. Climate change is impacting the profile of 
vehicles the group sells, but is not fundamentally impacting the total cash flows in each CGU and therefore no specific 
adjustments have been made.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
All goodwill CGUs carrying values have been based on their respective value in use. 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
It is anticipated that the units will grow revenues in the future. For the purpose of the impairment testing, a long-term 
growth rate of 2.0% (2021: 2.0%) has been assumed beyond 2027. The growth rate of 2.0% that has been used in the 
impairment calculations is based on long-term inflation.
 
Goodwill has been reviewed for any possible impairment and as a result of this review there was an impairment charge 
of £3.6m made during the year (2021: £nil). The £3.6m impairment related to the goodwill in respect of the DAF business 
which was classified for sale when the Group presented its interim results at 30 June 2022, prior to its eventual sale 
in October 2022.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The following have been recognised in the income statement within net operating 
expenses:
2022
£m
2021
£m
Amortisation of internally generated intangible assets
4.2 
3.7 
Amortisation of other intangible assets
0.7 
0.5 
Impairment of goodwill
3.6 
 - 
Research and development costs
1.2 
1.0 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Goodwill by segment
2022
£m
2021
£m
UK Motor
122.3 
128.0 
Pinewood
0.3 
0.3 
Leasing
22.0 
22.0 
144.6 
150.3 

147
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.1	Intangible assets and goodwill continued 
 
The pre-tax discount rates are estimated to reflect current market estimates of the time value of money and is calculated 
after consideration of market information and risk adjusted for individual circumstances. The pre-tax discount rates used are 
specific to each CGU. Pinewood and Leasing pre-tax discount rates is 16.7% (2021: 15.2% and 11.3% respectively). Please see 
the below table for the UK Motor Segment:
	
Sensitivity of assumptions 
	
The forecasts used to determine impairment are sensitive to the key assumptions used in preparing those forecasts. Future 
uncertainty with respect to the markets we operate in could have an effect on sales volumes and margins and the general 
costs of doing business. The key assumptions used in our forecasts are the vehicle volumes and margins. The sensitivities 
below indicate the total change in the value in use forecast, keeping other assumptions constant.
	
The directors and management have considered and assessed reasonably possible changes to the key assumptions. Within 
a downside scenario, the reasonably possible changes to the key assumptions are a severe downturn to vehicle volumes 
and margins. This considers both a worsening in economic conditions and restricted new car supply due to manufacturing 
constraints. This gives sensitivity of an overall reduction in free cashflow of 11.2%.
 
This downside sensitivity, there was no effect on both the Pinewood and Leasing segment goodwill values, only UK Motor, 
which gives rise to an impairment charge to the Vauxhall CGU of £7.5m, no other CGU impairment noted. The breakeven 
point for the Vauxhall CGU would require a reduction in both new and used units of 2.8% into perpetuity or a reduction in 
both new and used GPU of 1.2% into perpetuity.
3.2	Property, plant and equipment
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
Freehold land is not depreciated. Depreciation is provided to write off the cost less the estimated residual value of other 
assets by equal instalments over their estimated useful economic lives. On transition to IFRS as at 1 January 2004, all land 
and buildings were restated to fair value as permitted by IFRS 1, which is then treated as the deemed cost. All other assets 
are initially measured and recorded at cost.	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
Depreciation rates are as follows: 
 
•	 Freehold buildings – 2% per annum
•	 Right of use assets - over the period of the lease	
	
	
	
•	 Leasehold property improvements – 2% per annum or over the period of the lease if less than 50 years
•	 Fixtures, fittings and office equipment – 10 – 20% per annum 
 
 
 
•	 Plant and machinery – 10 – 33% per annum 
 
 
 
•	 Motor vehicles – 20 – 25% per annum  
 
 
•	 Contract hire vehicles are depreciated to their residual value over the period of their lease
	
	
	
	
 
The residual value of all assets, depreciation methods and useful economic lives, if significant, are reassessed annually.
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
UK Motor CGUs
Goodwill 
Value
£m
Current 
Headroom
£m
Pre-tax 
Discount 
Rate
Ford
69.8 
56.1 
13.9% 
Vauxhall
35.2 
6.8 
12.9%
Other UK Motor
17.3 
56.1 
8.2% - 12.6%
122.3 
119.0 
 

148
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.2	Property, plant and equipment continued
	
The Group recognises in the carrying amount of an item of property, plant and equipment the cost of replacing part of 
such an item when that cost is incurred if it is possible that the future economic benefits embodied with the item will flow 
to the Group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably. All other costs are recognised in the income statement as 
an expense as incurred.  
	
Gains and losses on disposal of an item of property, plant and equipment are determined by comparing the proceeds from 
disposal with the carrying amount of property, plant and equipment and are recognised net within other income in the 
income statement.
 
The depreciation charge in respect of property, plant and equipment is recognised within administrative expenses within 
the income statement.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
   Land & 
 buildings 
 £m 
    Plant & 
 equipment 
 £m 
   Motor 
 vehicles 
 £m 
   Contract 
hire 
 vehicles 
 £m 
 Total 
 £m 
Cost
At 1 January 2021
689.1 
85.2 
25.7 
230.4 
1,030.4 
Reclassification
 - 
 - 
 (22.7)
 - 
(22.7)
Exchange adjustments
0.1 
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.1
Additions
17.4 
4.4 
0.1 
42.4 
64.3 
Business disposals
 - 
 (1.6)
 - 
 - 
(1.6)
Other disposals
 (19.9)
 (1.5)
 (0.6)
 - 
 (22.0)
Contract hire vehicles transferred to inventory
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (48.0)
 (48.0)
Classified as non-current assets held for sale
 (10.5)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (10.5)
Reinstated from non-current assets held for sale
7.1 
0.1 
 - 
 - 
7.2 
At 31 December 2021
683.3 
86.6 
2.5 
224.8 
997.2 
At 1 January 2022
683.3 
86.6 
2.5 
224.8 
997.2 
Additions
47.5 
10.3 
0.2 
46.6 
104.6 
Business disposals
 (0.5)
 (1.9)
 - 
 - 
 (2.4)
Other disposals
 (39.0)
 (9.9)
 (0.3)
 - 
 (49.2)
Contract hire vehicles transferred to inventory
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (51.4)
 (51.4)
Classified as non-current assets held for sale
 (2.8)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (2.8)
Reinstated from non-current assets held for sale
3.8 
 - 
 - 
 - 
3.8 
At 31 December 2022
692.3 
85.1 
2.4 
220.0 
999.8 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

149
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.2	Property, plant and equipment continued
	
	 	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
   Land & 
 buildings 
 £m 
    Plant & 
 equipment 
 £m 
   Motor 
 vehicles 
 £m 
   Contract 
hire 
 vehicles 
 £m 
 Total 
 £m 
Depreciation
At 1 January 2021
320.7 
59.0 
4.9 
73.0 
457.6 
Reclassification
 - 
 - 
 (3.8)
 - 
(3.8)
Exchange adjustments
0.1 
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.1
Charge for the year
24.8 
6.6 
0.5 
38.5 
70.4 
Impairment
9.6 
 - 
 - 
 - 
9.6 
Business disposals
 - 
 (1.2)
 - 
 - 
(1.2)
Other disposals
 (14.0)
 (0.7)
 (0.6)
 - 
 (15.3)
Contract hire vehicles transferred to inventory
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (17.9)
 (17.9)
Classified as non-current assets held for sale
 (2.7)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (2.7)
Reinstated from non-current assets held for sale
0.8 
0.1 
 - 
 - 
0.9 
At 31 December 2021
339.3 
63.8 
1.0 
93.6 
497.7
At 1 January 2022
339.3 
63.8 
1.0 
93.6 
497.7 
Charge for the year
21.6 
6.9 
0.1 
36.1 
64.7 
Impairment
1.0 
0.2 
 - 
 - 
1.2 
Business disposals
 (0.5)
 (1.7)
 - 
 - 
 (2.2)
Other disposals
 (33.9)
 (9.3)
 (0.3)
 - 
 (43.5)
Contract hire vehicles transferred to inventory
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (34.6)
 (34.6)
Classified as non-current assets held for sale
 (0.9)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (0.9)
Reinstated from non-current assets held for sale
1.5 
 - 
 - 
 - 
1.5 
At 31 December 2022
328.1 
59.9 
0.8 
95.1 
483.9 
Carrying amounts
    
At 1 January 2021
368.4 
26.2 
20.8 
157.4 
572.8 
At 31 December 2021
344.0 
22.8 
1.5 
131.2 
499.5 
At 31 December 2022
364.2 
25.2 
1.6 
124.9 
515.9 
Assets leased out under operating leases
    
Cost at 31 December 2022
30.2 
 - 
 - 
220.0 
250.2 
Accumulated depreciation at 31 December 2022
 (13.9)
 - 
 - 
 (95.1)
 (109.0)
Accumulated impairment at 31 December 2022
 (4.4)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (4.4)
Carrying value of assets leased out under 
operating leases at 31 December 2022
11.9 
 - 
 - 
124.9 
136.8 

150
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.2	Property, plant and equipment continued 
	
Property, plant and equipment includes right-of-use assets of £130.5m  (see Note 4.7).		
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
During the year two properties were re-classified as property, plant and equipment following a decision to withdraw them 
from sale.  The properties have been re-instated at the lower of their recoverable amount, or the carrying amount had the 
assets never been moved to assets held for sale. In this instance the properties were re-instated at their recoverable values 
having been previously impaired down to those values. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Cash flows relating to the purchase of contract hire vehicles are disclosed within Movement in contract hire vehicle balances 
(see note 3.5).  
2022
£m
2021
£m
Building projects currently under construction for which no depreciation has 
been charged during the year
7.6 
8.7 
Future capital expenditure which has been contracted for but not yet provided 
in the financial statements - property development and refurbishment
2.8 
7.1 
Cumulative interest charges capitalised as construction costs and included in 
land and buildings
6.0 
5.2 
The following items have been charged to the income statement as operating 
expenses during the year:
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment - leased
15.2 
18.5 
Depreciation of contract hire vehicles - leased
36.1 
38.5 
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment - owned
13.4 
13.4 
Cash flow statement information
2022
£m
2021
£m
Additions to property, plant, equipment and intangible assets:
Additions to land and buildings
 (47.5)
 (17.4)
Additions to plant and equipment
 (10.3)
 (4.4)
Additions to motor vehicles
 (0.2)
 (0.1)
Additions to intangible assets (see note 3.1)
 (6.2)
 (5.1)
Total additions
 (64.2)
 (27.0)
Less additions of property, plant and equipment acquired under leases for 
which no cash flow arises (excludes fees capitalised of £2.6m (2021: £0.1)) (see 
note 4.7) 
19.9 
8.7 
Cash flows relating to additions of property, plant and equipment made by the 
US disposal group disclosed within assets held for sale 
 - 
 (0.3)
Cash flows from investing activities in respect of additions to property, plant 
and equipment
 (44.3)
(18.6)
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

151
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.3	Assets held for sale and discontinued operations	 	
	
	 	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Non-current assets that are expected to be recovered primarily through sale rather than through continuing use are 
classified as held for sale. Immediately before classification as held for sale, the assets are measured in accordance with 
the Group's accounting policies. Thereafter the assets are measured at the lower of their carrying amount and fair value 
less costs to sell. Impairment losses on remeasurement are recognised in the income statement. Gains are not recognised 
in excess of any cumulative impairment loss. Non-current assets classified as held for sale are available for immediate sale 
and a resultant disposal is highly probable within one year.   
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
 
A non-current asset that stops being classified as held for sale is remeasured at the lower of its carrying amount prior 
to the asset or disposal group being classified as held for sale, adjusted for any depreciation or amortisation that would 
have been recognised if the asset had not been classified as held for sale, or, its recoverable amount at the date of the 
decision not to sell.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Discontinued operations
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
There were no buinsesses in the Group classified as a discontinued operation in 2022.  During the previous period, 2021, 
the Group sold its two remaining stores in its US Business, which was shown as a discontinued operation within the 
comparative information in these consolidated financial statements.   
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The results of the discontinued operation are set out on the face of the consolidated income statement. Other financial 
information relating to the discontinued operation for the period is set out below. 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Assets and liabilities of a disposal Group held for sale	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
From 31 December 2018 until the sale of the final business unit in March 2021, the US motor business was classified as a 
disposal group which was stated at fair value less costs to sell and comprised the following assets and liabilities.
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2022
£m
2021
£m
Net cash used in operating activities
 - 
 (5.4)
Net cash from investing activities
 - 
27.6 
Net cash used in financing activities
 - 
 (31.3)
Net cash decrease generated by discontinued operation
 - 
 (9.1)
Included within net cash used in financing activities for 2021 is £28.8m in respect of a dividend paid by the US company to its UK 
holding company.
2022
pence
2021
pence
Basic earnings per share from discontinued operation
 - 
 (0.3)
Underlying basic earnings per share from discontinued operation
 - 
 (0.1)
Diluted earnings per share from discontinued operation
 - 
 (0.3)

152
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
The following items have been credited/(charged) 
to the income statement during the year:
 Income statement category 
2022
£m
2021
£m
Profit on sale of assets classified as held for sale
Other income - gains on the sale of busi-
nesses and property, plant and equipment 
8.0 
1.7 
3.3	Assets held for sale and discontinued operations continued
	
Balance sheet		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group holds a number of freehold properties that are currently being marketed for sale which are expected to be 
disposed of during 2023. Properties are valued using a combination of external qualified valuers and in-house experts. Due 
to the nature of the market, especially in light of current economic conditions, a property may ultimately realise proceeds 
that vary from those valuations applied. 
	
Income statement
 
If the fair value less costs to sell assigned to each property were to be reduced by 10% a further impairment loss of £0.1m 
would have been recognised (2021: £0.4m).
3.4	Inventories
	
Accounting policies	
	
	
 
Motor vehicle inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Costs incurred in bringing each product 
to its present location and condition are included and cost is based on price including delivery costs less specific trade 
discounts. Fair value reviews of stock are conducted regularly utilising our market intelligence and analysis of the market 
which we conduct by segment and by model, these fair values are updated in the light of any changing trends by model 
line. The assessment of fair values involves an element of estimation: the Group takes the age profile of our inventories 
at the year end, estimates the likely sale period and the expected profit or loss on sale to determine the fair value at the 
balance sheet date. Whilst this data is deemed representative of current values it is possible that ultimate sales values can 
vary from those applied. Parts inventories are based on an average purchase cost principle and are written down to net 
realisable value by providing for obsolescence on a time in stock based formula approach.	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Consignment vehicles are regarded as being effectively under the control of the Group and are included within inventories 
on the balance sheet as the Group has the significant risks and rewards of ownership even though legal title has not yet 
passed. The corresponding liability is included in trade and other payables. Movements in consignment vehicle inventory 
and its corresponding liability within trade and other payables are not included within movements of inventories and 
payables as stated in the consolidated cash flow statement as no cash flows arise in respect of these transactions until the 
vehicle is either sold or purchased at which point it is reclassified within new and used vehicle inventory.  
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Motor vehicles are transferred from contract hire activities at the end of their lease term to inventory at their depreciated 
cost. No physical cash flow arises from these transfers. 
Assets classified for sale comprise: 
2022
£m
2021
£m
Property, plant and equipment
6.1
10.4 
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

153
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Balance sheet	
	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
New and used vehicles
559.7 
461.2 
Consignment vehicles
35.3 
27.2 
Vehicle parts and other inventories
25.3 
24.4 
620.3 
512.8 
2022
£m
2021
£m
Inventories recognised as an expense during the year
3,126.2 
2,972.0 
Carrying value of inventories subject to retention of title clauses
462.1
447.8 
Write-down of inventories to net realisable value (included within cost of sales)
8.1 
10.1 
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.4	Inventories continued
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
Included within the write-down of inventories to net realisable value is the write-down of used vehicle inventory of £6.9m 
(2021: £8.0m). The key assumptions underpinning the write-down of net realisable value of the used vehicle inventory are 
(i) the time to sell each vehicle; (ii) the expected sales price at the date of sale. Sensitivities have been performed on the 
key assumptions; (i) a 30 day sensitivity has been used for the time to sell each vehicle as this is a plausible scenario and 
(ii) a £500 sensitivity has been used for the expected sales price at the date of sale as in the region of £500 variations in 
GPUs have been seen in previous reporting periods.
 
If the average time to sell a vehicle is increased by 30 days then it would increase the write-down of the used vehicle 
inventory by £2.5m (2021: £0.2m). If the expected sales prices at the date of sale were to decrease by £500 per vehicle, 
then it would increase the value of the write-down of used vehicle inventory by £3.7m (2021: £4.1m) at the balance sheet 
date. Whereas if the average time to sell a vehicle is decreased by 30 days then it would decrease the value of the write-
down of used vehicle inventory by £2.3m (2021: £1.3m). Also if the expected sales prices at the date of sale were to 
increase by £500 per vehicle then it would decrease the value of the write-down of used vehicle inventory by £2.4m (2021: 
£3.1m) at the balance sheet date.
Cash flow statement information	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Movement in inventory 
(107.5)
96.0 
Reclassification from property, plant and equipment (see note 3.2)  
 - 
18.9 
Inventory changes in business combinations and disposals 
 (37.2)
 (0.6)
Impact of exchange differences 
 - 
0.1 
Non cash movement in consignment vehicles 
8.1 
 (54.5)
Classified as held for sale 
 - 
17.8 
Transfer value of contract hire vehicles from fixed assets to inventory 
16.8 
30.1 
Cash flow (decrease)/increase due to movements in inventory 
(119.8)
107.8 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

154
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.5	Movement in contract hire vehicle balance
3.6	Trade and other receivables	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Trade and other receivables are recognised initially at fair value and are subsequently stated at amortised cost using the 
effective interest method, less any impairment losses. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
 
Impairment losses are measured in accordance with IFRS 9, which is based on an ‘expected credit loss’ (ECL) model. The 
impairment model applies to financial assets measured at amortised cost. 
 
The calculation of ECLs are a probability-weighted estimate of credit losses. Credit losses are measured as the present 
value of all cash shortfalls (i.e. the difference between the cash flows due to the entity in accordance with the contract and 
the cash flows that the Group expects to receive).
 
The Group considers a trade or other receivable to be in default when the borrower is unlikely to pay its credit obligations 
to the Group in full after all reasonable actions have been taken to recover the debt.	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Credit risk management	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group is exposed to credit risk primarily in respect of its trade receivables and financial assets. Trade receivables are 
stated net of provision for estimated impairment losses. Exposure to credit risk in respect of trade receivables is mitigated 
by the Group’s policy of only granting credit to certain customers after an appropriate evaluation of credit risk. Credit risk 
arises in respect of amounts due from vehicle manufacturers in relation to bonuses and warranty receivables. This risk is 
mitigated by the range of manufacturers dealt with, the Group’s procedures in effecting timely collection of amounts due 
and management’s belief that it does not expect any manufacturer to fail to meet its obligations. Financial assets comprise 
trade and other receivables (as above) and cash balances. The counterparties are banks and management does not expect 
any counterparty to fail to meet its obligations. The maximum exposure to credit risk is represented by the carrying 
amount of each financial asset, including derivative financial instruments, in the balance sheet.  
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Before granting any new customer credit terms the Group uses external credit scoring systems to assess the potential new 
customer’s credit quality and defines credit limits by customer. These limits and credit worthiness are regularly reviewed 
and use is made of monitoring alerts provided by the providers of the credit scoring systems. The Group has no customer 
that represents more than 5% of the total balance of trade receivables. 
2022
£m
2021
£m
 Depreciation 
36.1 
38.5 
 Changes in trade and other payables and deferred income 
 (7.9)
 (30.2)
 Purchases of contract hire vehicles 
 (46.6)
 (42.4)
 Unwinding of discounts in contract hire residual values 
 (2.5)
 (2.7)
 (20.9)
 (36.8)
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

155
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.6	Trade and other receivables continued
	
	
 
All amounts are due within one year. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
 
All trade receivables are classified as loans and receivables and held at amortised cost in the current year and prior year. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Total trade receivables held by the Group at 31 December 2022 was £58.6m (2021: £45.4m).  
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The average credit period taken on sales of goods is 29 days (2021: 29 days). No interest is charged on trade receivables. 
The Group makes an impairment provision based on the expected credit losses it deems likely to incur. The calculation 
is based on an average of previous default experiences which is assessed against the risk of the current total in light of 
current economic expectations.  An expense has been recognised in respect of impairment losses during the year of 
£0.3m (2021: £0.1m). 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The ageing of trade and other receivables at the reporting date was:
Balance sheet	
	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Trade receivables
58.9 
45.7 
Allowance for doubtful debts
 (0.3)
 (0.3)
58.6 
45.4 
Manufacturer bonus receivables
23.3 
17.4 
Other receivables
24.3 
34.7 
Prepayments
9.5 
3.8 
115.7 
101.3 
 Trade
receivables
 2022
£m
 Manufacturer 
bonus
receivables
 2022
£m
  Other
receivables
 2022 
 £m 
 Trade
receivables
 2021
£m
 Manufacturer 
bonus
receivables
 2021
£m
  Other
receivables
 2021 
 £m 
Not past due
27.6 
22.8 
23.4 
20.6 
12.5 
31.3 
Past due 0-30 days
19.8 
0.2 
0.6 
10.7 
2.4 
0.8 
Past due 31-120 days
8.5 
0.3 
0.3 
12.4 
2.5 
2.6 
Past due 120+ days 
3.0 
 - 
 - 
2.0 
 - 
 - 
58.9 
23.3 
24.3 
45.7 
17.4 
34.7 
Provision for impairment
 (0.3)
 - 
 - 
 (0.3)
 - 
 - 
58.6 
23.3 
24.3 
45.4 
17.4 
34.7 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

156
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.6	Trade and other receivables continued
 
The movement in the allowance for impairment in respect of trade receivables during the year was as follows:
	
The Directors consider that the carrying amount of trade and other receivables approximates their fair value. 
	
Finance lease receivables	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Where the group acts as a lessor of properties of which it is a lessee and the term of the head lease and sub lease are 
coterminous, rather than recognise a right of use asset the Group recognises a finance lease receivable which is measured 
at the net present value of future cash receipts discounted at the Group's incremental borrowing rate. The finance income 
element of rentals received under these leases is credited so as to give a constant rate of finance income on the remainder 
of the obligation. Finance income is credited in the income statement. The finance lease receivable is reduced by rentals 
received and increased by the interest income recognised.
	
Finance lease rentals are invoiced quarterly on standard rent quarter days, no credit terms are extended beyond these 
dates. Expected credit losses in respect of finance lease receivables are deemed immaterial.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Non-current
14.8 
15.5 
Current
2.4 
2.1 
17.2 
17.6 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
	
	 	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Balance at 1 January
0.3 
0.4 
Utilisation
 (0.3)
 (0.3)
Impairment loss recognised
0.3 
0.2 
Balance at 31 December
0.3 
0.3 

157
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.7	Trade and other payables	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Trade and other payables are recognised initially at fair value and are subsequently stated at amortised cost using the 
effective interest method, less any write-offs.  
	
 
Trade payables are classified as other financial liabilities. Fair value is deemed to be the same as carrying value. 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Details of the stocking loan facilities are presented in the Capital Management section of note 4.2 below.  
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The non-current element of trade and other payables relates to contract hire buyback commitments where the Group 
has contracted to repurchase vehicles, at predetermined values and dates, that have been let under operating leases or 
similar arrangements.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group enters into leasing arrangements whereby it agrees to repurchase vehicles from providers of lease finance at 
the end of the lease agreement, typically two to four years in the future. The repurchase price is determined at the time 
the agreement is entered into based on the then estimate of a vehicle’s future residual value. The actual value of the 
vehicles at the end of the lease contract, and therefore the proceeds that can be realised from eventual sale, can vary from 
these estimates. Annual reviews are undertaken to reappraise residual values and to recognise impairment write downs 
where necessary. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Balance sheet	
	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Trade payables
71.8 
56.4 
Vehicle stocking loans
547.4
420.6 
Contract hire buyback commitments
58.2 
62.0 
Consignment vehicle liabilities
35.3 
27.2 
Payments received on account
30.4 
26.2 
Other taxation and social security
2.9
24.7 
Accruals
101.8 
117.5 
847.7
734.6 
Non-current
35.7 
41.9 
Current
812.0 
692.7 
847.7 
734.6 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

158
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 3 - OPERATING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
3.8	Deferred income	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Warranty policies sold		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The income received in respect of warranty policies sold and administered by the Group is recognised over the period of 
the policy on a straight line basis. The unrecognised income is held within deferred income.
	
Contract hire	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Vehicles supplied to a leasing group for contract hire purposes where the Group undertakes to repurchase the vehicle 
at a predetermined date are accounted for in accordance with IFRS 16 Leases, where the Group is considered to be an 
operating lessor for all arrangements in place. The initial amounts received in consideration from the leasing group are 
allocated between the present value of the repurchase commitment, held within trade and other payables and a residual 
amount of deferred revenue held within deferred income. The deferred revenue, which effectively represents rentals 
received in advance, is taken to the income statement on a straight line basis over the related lease term.
 
The deferred income balance at 31 December for warranty policies and contract hire is the aggregate transaction price 
allocated to performance obligations that are unsatisfied or partly satisfied at the reporting date. No information is provided 
about remaining performance obligations at 31 December 2022 or 31 December 2021 that have an original expected 
duration of one year or less as allowed by IFRS 15.
 Warranty
 policies 
 £m 
  Contract 
 hire 
 £m 
 Total
 £m 
At 1 January 2022
16.5 
57.5 
74.0 
Created in the year
19.0 
29.7 
48.7 
Recognised as income during the year
 (9.5)
 (33.8)
 (43.3)
Warranty claims paid
 (4.8)
 - 
 (4.8)
At 31 December 2022
21.2 
53.4 
74.6 
Non-current
8.7 
27.7 
36.4 
Current
12.5 
25.7 
38.2 
21.2 
53.4 
74.6 
Recognition of opening balance as at 31 December 2021
Recognised during the year
9.1 
28.1 
37.2 
Carried forward at 31 December 2022
7.4 
29.4 
36.8 
16.5 
57.5 
74.0 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

159
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
 
This section contains the notes and information to support the elements of both net debt and equity financing as presented 
in the Consolidated Balance Sheet. 	
	
	
	
4.1	
Accounting policies	
	
	
	
4.5	
Dividends	
	
	
	
	
4.2	
Financial instruments and derivatives	
	
4.6	
Share based compensation	
	
	
4.3 
Net financing costs 
 
 
 
4.7 
Leases 
 
 
	
4.4	
Capital and reserves	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
4.1	Accounting policies	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
IFRS 9 requires an entity to recognise a financial asset or a financial liability in its statement of financial position when it 
becomes party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. At initial recognition, an entity measures a financial asset or 
a financial liability at its fair value plus or minus, in the case of a financial asset or a financial liability not at fair value through 
profit or loss, transaction costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition or issue of the financial asset or the financial 
liability. Subsequent to initial recognition financial assets and financial liabilities are classified and measured as described 
below.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Financial assets
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
IFRS 9 classifies assets according to the business model for their realisation, as determined by the expected contractual 
cashflows.  This classification determines the accounting treatment, and the classification under IFRS 9 is by reference to 
the accounting treatment i.e. amortised cost, fair value through other comprehensive income or fair value through profit 
and loss.
 
A financial asset is measured at amortised cost if both of the following conditions are met:
 
the asset is held within a business model whose objective is to hold assets in order to collect contractual cash flows; and 
the contractual terms of the financial asset give rise on specified dates to cash flows that are solely payments of principal 
and interest on the principal amount outstanding. 
 
Financial assets are therefore classified and measured in these financial statements at amortised cost.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group recognises loss allowances for expected credit losses (ECLs) on financial assets measured at amortised cost, 
debt investments measured at FVOCI and contract assets (as defined in IFRS 15).
 
The Group measures loss allowances at an amount equal to lifetime ECL, except for other debt securities and bank balances 
for which credit risk (i.e. the risk of default occurring over the expected life of the financial instrument) has not increased 
significantly since initial recognition which are measured as 12-month ECL.
 
Loss allowances for trade receivables and contract assets are always measured at an amount equal to lifetime ECL.
 
When determining whether the credit risk of a financial asset has increased significantly since initial recognition and when 
estimating ECL, the Group considers reasonable and supportable information that is relevant and available without undue 
cost or effort. This includes both quantitative and qualitative information and analysis, based on the Group’s historical 
experience and informed credit assessment and including forward-looking information. 
 
The Group assumes that the credit risk on a financial asset has increased significantly if it is more than 30 days past due.
 
The Group considers a financial asset to be in default when:
•	  the borrower is unlikely to pay its credit obligations to the Group in full, without recourse by the Group to actions such 
as realising security (if any is held); or
•	 the financial asset is more than 90 days past due. 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

160
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.1	Accounting policies continued	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Lifetime ECLs are the ECLs that result from all possible default events over the expected life of a financial instrument.
 
12-month ECLs are the portion of ECLs that result from default events that are possible within the 12 months after the 
reporting date (or a shorter period if the expected life of the instrument is less than 12 months).
 
The maximum period considered when estimating ECLs is the maximum contractual period over which the Group is 
exposed to credit risk.
	
 
Measurement of ECLs
 
ECLs are a probability-weighted estimate of credit losses. Credit losses are measured as the present value of all cash 
shortfalls (i.e. the difference between the cash flows due to the entity in accordance with the contract and the cash flows 
that the Group expects to receive). ECLs are discounted at the effective interest rate of the financial asset.
 
Credit-impaired financial assets
 
At each reporting date, the Group assesses whether financial assets carried at amortised cost and debt securities at FVOCI 
are credit-impaired. A financial asset is ‘credit-impaired’ when one or more events that have a detrimental impact on the 
estimated future cash flows of the financial asset have occurred.
	
Write-offs
 
The gross carrying amount of a financial asset is written off (either partially or in full) to the extent that there is no realistic 
prospect of recovery. 
	
Impairment of financial assets	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
IFRS 9 adopts an expected credit loss approach (ECL).  The IFRS 9 approach does not require a credit event (an actual 
loss or a debt past a number of days due)  to occur but is based on changes in expectations of credit losses.  IFRS 9 also 
requires that impairment of financial assets be shown as a separate line item in either the statement of comprehensive 
income or the income statement.  
	
Trade and other receivables - see note 3.6	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
Cash and cash equivalents	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash in hand and demand deposits, and other short term highly liquid investments 
that are readily convertible to a known amount of cash and are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.
Financial assets	 	
	
IFRS 9
classification 
£m
Trade and other receivables
Amortised cost 
106.2 
Finance lease receivables
Amortised cost 
17.2 
Cash and cash equivalents
Amortised cost 
69.4 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

161
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
Adjusted net debt
2022
£m
2021
£m
Cash and cash equivalents 
69.4 
37.6 
Current interest bearing loans and borrowings
 (1.7)
 - 
Non-current interest bearing loans and borrowings
 (91.0)
 (87.3)
 (23.3)
 (49.7)
The Group has since adoption of IFRS 16 Leases excluded Lease liabilities from its measure of Adjusted Net Debt.  Full 
details of lease liabilities are presented in note 4.7. The Group also exclude Vehicle stocking loans from its measure of 
Adjusted Net Debt which are presented as current liabilities in note 3.7.
Cash and cash equivalents
Carrying value
and fair value
2022
£m
Restated - see note 1 
Carrying value 
and fair value
2021
£m
Bank balances and cash equivalents
69.4 
37.6 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
4.1	Accounting policies continued	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Loans and borrowings
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings are recognised initially at fair value less attributable transaction costs. Subsequent 
to initial recognition, interest-bearing borrowings are stated at amortised cost with any difference between cost and 
redemption value being recognised in the income statement over the period of the borrowings on an effective interest 
basis. The effective interest basis is a method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial liability and of allocating 
interest payments over the relevant period. The effective interest rate is the rate that exactly discounts estimated future 
cash payments through the expected life of the financial liability, or where appropriate, a shorter period.  
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Trade and other payables - see note 3.7	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
Hedging Instruments 	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group no longer holds any hedging instruments to hedge currency risks arising from its activities. There are no 
material Group operations conducted in currencies other than GBP.	
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives
 
	
Bank overdrafts reflect the aggregated overdrawn balances of Group companies (even if those companies have other 
positive cash balances).
2022
£m
2021
£m
Cash and cash equivalents in the Balance Sheet 
171.9 
200.1 
Bank overdrafts repayable on demand and used for cash management in the 
Balance Sheet
 (102.5)
(162.5) 
Cash and cash equivalents in the statement of cash flows
 69.4
 37.6

162
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
Current  margin
Commitment 
(non-utilisation) 
fee
RCF
5.00%
2.25%
SFA
6.00%
n/a
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
	
Borrowings
 
In March 2022, the Group refinanced its £175m RCF and £60m Private Placement, both of which were due to mature in 
March 2023. The new facilities comprise a  5 year £100m Senior Term Finance Agreement (SFA), maturing March 2027, 
with the Group’s existing Private Placement lender plus a new lender, and a £75m 3+1+1 Revolving Credit Facility (RCF) 
with four out of the five of the Group’s existing bankers, maturing March 2025, with extensions at the option of lenders to 
March 2026 and then March 2027. The SFA comprises a term loan, with principal repayments at 1% per quarter in years 
1 and 2, and at 2.5% per quarter thereafter. The RCF comprises a "bullet" facility i.e. there are no scheduled reductions. 
Both the SFA and RCF are secured over the assets of the Group (with the exception of the Pension Fund's Central Asset 
Reserve assets set out at note 5.1) , and rank pari-passu with the Pension Fund. Interest in respect of the RCF is in a range 
of SONIA + 5.00%-6.00%, and for the SFA at SONIA + 6.00%-7.00%, both dependent on the same leverage ratio. Financial 
covenants are common to both the RCF and SFA, and comprise leverage, fixed charge cover and minimum underlying 
EBITDA.
 
As at 31 December 2022, total facility commitments and expiry are as set out below: 
 
At 31 December 2022 the following margins and fees were in place:
	
 
The leverage covenant is calculated as the ratio of net debt to underlying profit before tax, depreciation, amortisation and 
finance charges (excluding vehicle stocking plan interest charges disclosed in note 4.3) calculated on an IAS 17 basis. This 
ratio can not exceed 2.00 times. At 31 December 2022 the ratio was 0.2 times. 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The fixed charge cover covenant is calculated as the ratio of underlying profit before tax, depreciation, amortisation and 
finance charges (excluding vehicle stocking plan interest charges disclosed in note 4.3) calculated on an IAS 17 basis plus 
rent paid, to finance charges (excluding vehicle stocking plan interest charges disclosed in note 4.3) plus payments for 
rent, scheduled amortisation under the SFA and pension contributions. This ratio must exceed 1.60 times. At 31 December 
2022 the ratio was 2.7 times. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
 
The minimum underlying EBITDA covenant is calculated as for the leverage covenant ratio i.e. underlying profit before tax, 
depreciation, amortisation and finance charges (excluding vehicle stocking plan interest charges disclosed in note 4.3) 
calculated on an IAS 17 basis. This must exceed £75.0m at 31 December 2022 and was £124.9m.  
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Expiry Date
£m
RCF
March 2025
75.0 
SFA
March 2027
97.0 
172.0 

163
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Summary of borrowings	
	
	
 Carrying 
value
2022
£m 
 Fair value
2022
£m 
  Carrying 
value
2021
£m 
Fair value
2021
£m 
Non-current:
Bank borrowings (RCF)
 - 
 - 
27.1 
27.1 
SFA
90.8 
90.8 
 - 
 - 
5.75% Senior note 2023
 - 
 - 
60.0 
60.0 
Other loan notes
0.2 
0.2 
0.2 
0.2 
Lease liabilities
197.9 
197.9 
195.4 
195.4 
Total non-current
288.9 
288.9 
282.7 
282.7 
SFA
1.7 
1.7 
 - 
 - 
Bank overdraft*
102.5 
102.5 
162.5 
 162.5 
Lease liabilities
20.0 
20.0 
26.7 
26.7 
Total current
124.2 
124.2
189.2
189.2 
Total borrowings
413.1
413.1 
471.9 
471.9 
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
	
* 2021 restated - see note 1 

164
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
Reconciliation of movements of liabilities to cash flows arising from financing activities
	
	
	
	
Long term
borrowings
 £m 
Finance
Lease
 £m 
 Share 
 capital 
 £m 
 Other 
 reserves 
 £m 
 Retained 
 earnings 
 £m 
Total
£m
At 1 January 2022
87.3 
222.1 
69.9 
75.0 
80.7 
535.0 
Cash flows from financing activities
Payment of lease liabilities
 - 
 (22.2)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (22.2)
Repayment of loans
 (90.5)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (90.5)
Proceeds from issue of loans (net of directly attributable 
transaction costs)
93.8 
 - 
 - 
 - 
93.8 
3.3 
 (22.2)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (18.9)
Other changes
The effect of changes in foreign exchange rates
0.1 
0.1 
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.2 
New leases undertaken - non cash
 - 
35.3 
 - 
 - 
 - 
35.3 
Disposal of finance leases - non cash
 - 
 (17.6)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 (17.6)
Liability-related : Lease expenses - non cash
 - 
0.2 
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.2 
Liability-related : Amortisation of fees and expenses
2.0 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
2.0 
Equity-related : Total other changes
 - 
 - 
 - 
0.5 
54.9 
55.4 
At 31 December 2022
92.7 
217.9 
69.9 
75.5 
135.6 
591.6 
 
Interest payments in respect of the above borrowings are reported in operating cash flows in the Consolidated Cash Flow 
Statement.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Fair value hierarchy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Financial instruments carried at fair value are required to be measured by reference to the following levels: 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Level 1: quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities	
	
	
	
	
	
Level 2: inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly 
(i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices)	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Level 3: inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data (unobservable inputs)	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The RCF and SFA have been measured by a Level 2 valuation method. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
____Borrowings___
__________Equity_________
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

165
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
 
The effective interest rates for all borrowings are all based by reference to SONIA. Leases are effectively held at fixed 
rates of interest within the range set out below. Information regarding classification of balances and interest, the range of 
interest rates applied in the year to 31 December 2022 and repricing periods, is set out in the table below.
	
	
 
The carrying amounts of the Group’s borrowings are denominated in the following currencies:
	
 
Classification
	 Carrying
	
value
	
 £m
	
	
 
Classification
	
Interest
 classification
	
Interest
	
rate range
	
Repricing periods
Bank balances and cash equivalents
	 Loans and receivables
69.4 
	 Amortised cost
	 Floating GBP
	
0.45%-4.50%
	
6 months or less
Borrowings
Non - current:
RCF
 Other financial liabilities
 - 
	 Amortised cost
	 Floating GBP
N/A - not drawn	
6 months or less
SFA
 Other financial liabilities
90.8 
	 Amortised cost
	 Floating USD
6.75% - 8.94%	
6 months or less
Other loan notes
 Other financial liabilities
0.2 
	 Amortised cost
	
Fixed GBP
12.50%	
n/a
Lease liabilities
 Other financial liabilities
197.9 
	 Amortised cost
	
Fixed GBP
1.91% - 8.00%	
n/a
Total non-current
288.9 
	
RCF
Other financial liabilities
 - 
	 Amortised cost
	 Floating USD
N/A - not drawn	
6 months or less
SFA
Other financial liabilities
1.7 
	 Amortised cost
	 Floating USD
6.75% - 8.94%	
6 months or less
Bank overdraft *
Other financial liabilities
102.5 
	 Amortised cost
	 Floating GBP
0%	
6 months or less
Lease liabilities
Other financial liabilities
20.0 
	 Amortised cost
	
Fixed GBP
1.91% - 8.00%
n/a
Total current
124.2
Total borrowings
413.1
 2022
 £m 
2021
 £m
Pound sterling
413.1 
463.8 
US dollar
 - 
8.1 
413.1
471.9 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
	
* 2021 restated - see note 1 
	
* 2021 restated - see note 1 

166
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
 2022
 £m 
2021
 £m
Between 1 and 2 years
7.3 
87.1 
Between 2 and 5 years
83.7 
0.2 
91.0 
87.3 
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
	
Treasury policy, financial risk, funding and liquidity management	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Financial risk management	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group is exposed to the following risks from its use of financial instruments:
 
Funding and liquidity risk - the risk that the Group will not be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall due.
 
Credit risk - the risk of financial loss to the Group if a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument fails to meet its 
contractual obligations, and arises principally from the Group’s receivables from customers and investment securities.
 
Market risk - the risk that changes in market prices, such as interest rates and foreign exchange rates, have on the Group's 
financial performance.
 
The Group's quantitative exposure to these risks is explained throughout these financial statements whilst the Group's 
objectives and management of these risks is set out below.
	
Treasury policy and procedures
 
Group treasury matters are managed within policy guidelines set by the Board with prime areas of focus being liquidity and 
interest rate exposure. Management of these areas is the responsibility of the Group’s central treasury function. The Board 
does not permit the speculative use of derivatives..
	
Funding and liquidity management
 
The Group is financed primarily by its SFA, RCF, vehicle stocking credit lines and operating cash flow. The RCF and SFA 
are committed facilities which mature within appropriate timescales and are maintained at levels in excess of planned 
requirements. .	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Each business within the Group is responsible for its own day-to-day cash management and the overall cash position is 
monitored on a daily basis by the Group treasury department.  	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
The maturity of non-current borrowings is as follows, excluding lease liabilities:

167
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
 
Maturities include amounts drawn under revolving credit facilities which are contractually repayable generally within a 
month of the year end but which may be redrawn at the Group’s option, together with contractual repayment dates for 
the amortising SFA. The maturities above therefore represent the final repayment dates for these facilities. If the amounts 
drawn at the year end were redrawn at the Group’s usual practice of monthly drawings, the total cash outflows associated 
with all borrowings, assuming interest rates remain at the same rates as at the year end, are estimated on an undiscounted 
basis as follows:
 
The above reflects that £5m has been drawn on the RCF by way of bank guarantees to third parties, but such amounts do 
not constitute borrowings.
 Carrying 
amount 
 Contractual 
cashflows 
 Within 6 
months 
 6 - 12 
months 
 1-2 years 
 2-5 years 
 over 5 
years 
RCF
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
SFA
92.5 
126.0 
5.4 
5.3 
15.9 
99.4 
 - 
Loan notes
0.2 
0.4 
- 
- 
- 
0.4 
 - 
92.7 
126.4 
5.4 
5.3 
15.9 
99.8 
 - 
Bank overdraft  
102.5 
102.5 
102.5 
- 
- 
- 
- 
Leases liabilities
217.9 
371.3 
17.9 
16.4 
32.2 
76.5 
228.3 
Trade payables
71.7 
71.7 
71.7 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
Vehicle stocking loans
582.7 
598.4 
336.9 
261.5
 - 
 - 
 - 
1,067.5
1,270.3 
534.4 
283.2 
48.1 
176.3 
228.3 
The Group has the following undrawn borrowing facilities:
 2022 
 £m 
2021
 £m
Expiring in 1-2 years
 - 
87.9 
Expiring in 2-5 years
70.0
 - 
70.0
87.9 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

168
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued 
	
Interest rate risk management	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The objective of the Group’s interest rate policy is to minimise interest costs whilst protecting the Group from adverse 
movements in interest rates. Borrowings issued at variable rates expose the Group to cash flow interest rate risk whereas 
borrowings issued at fixed rates expose the Group to fair value interest rate risk. The Group does not actively manage cash 
flow interest rate risk as the Board believes that the retail sector in which the Group operates provides a natural hedge 
against interest rate movements. Consequently, it is normal Group policy to borrow on a floating rate basis and all fair value 
interest rate risk arising from fixed rate borrowings entered into by the Group are usually managed by swaps into floating 
rate. However, due to the relatively low historical rates in floating interest rates, there was relatively low downside risk in 
maintaining the Group’s £60.0m Senior note 2023  at fixed rate. On refinancing in March 2022, all loans were at floating 
rate, which were maintained in line with the Group's normal policy.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Interest rate risk sensitivity analysis
	
 
As some of the Group’s borrowings and vehicle stocking credit lines are floating rate instruments they therefore have a 
sensitivity to changes in market rates of interest. The table below shows the effect of a 100 basis points change in interest 
rates for floating rate instruments outstanding at the period end, showing how profit or loss would have varied in the period 
on the assumption that the instruments at the period end were outstanding for the entire period.
	
Foreign exchange risk management	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group faces currency risk in respect of its net assets denominated in currencies other than sterling. On translation 
into sterling, movements in currency will affect the value of these assets. The Group’s policy is therefore to match, where 
possible, net assets in overseas subsidiaries which are denominated in a foreign currency with borrowings in the same 
currency. With very little  US assets remaining at the year end following the disposal all US business interests in prior years, 
no material hedging requirement remains so the Group now has no USD borrowings (2021: USD 10.0m) against its net 
assets held in overseas subsidiaries.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 Profit/(loss)
2022 
 £m 
Profit/(loss) 
2021
 £m
100 basis points increase
 (5.5)
 (3.8)
Tax effect
1.0 
0.7 
Effect on net assets
 (4.5)
 (3.1)
100 basis points decrease
5.5 
1.9 
Tax effect
 (1.0)
 (0.4)
Effect on net assets
4.5 
1.5 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

169
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
	
Hedges of net investments in overseas operations	
	
A gain or loss in respect of an effective hedge of a net investment in an overseas operation is recognised directly in 
equity. Any ineffective portion of the hedge is recognised in the income statement.	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Included within bank borrowings are balances denominated in US dollars which are designated as a hedge of the net 
investment in the Group’s US subsidiaries. Foreign exchange differences on translation of the borrowings to sterling at 
the balance sheet date are recognised within the translation differences reserve in equity, net of exchange differences in 
respect of the net investments being hedged.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Capital management	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group views its financial capital resources as primarily comprising share capital, loans (RCF and SFA), vehicle stocking 
credit lines and operating cashflow. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
Core debt is essentially funded by the Group’s SFA. The Group requires its revolving credit facility to fund its day-to-day 
working capital requirements. A fundamental element of the Group’s financial resources is the provision of vehicle  stocking 
credit lines, provided by the vehicle manufacturers’ funding arms and other third party providers. The Group’s funding of 
its vehicle inventories is set out below:
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Inventories are stated net of any Value Added Tax (VAT) whilst the related creditor is a gross amount. The creditor may 
also be higher than the inventory value due to timing of the vehicle sale and payment of the related liability. 
 
When considering vehicle stocks from a funding risk view point we split the funding into that which is funded by the vehicle 
manufacturers through their related finance arms and that funded through third party stock finance facilities and bank 
borrowings. Financing for stock other than through bank borrowings is shown in trade creditors in the balance sheet. The 
maturity analysis on page 167 includes stock finance facilities.
 2022 
 $m 
2021
 $m
Aggregate fair value of borrowings designated as hedge of net investment 
in the Group's US subsidiaries
- 
10.0 
 £m 
£m
Foreign exchange gains/(losses) on translation of borrowings to sterling at 
balance sheet date
 - 
0.5 
Foreign exchange (losses)/gains on translation of net investments to ster-
ling at balance sheet date
0.5 
 (0.5)
Net exchange gain/(loss) recognised within translation reserve in equity
0.5 
 - 
   
 2022 
 £m 
2021
 £m
Manufacturer finance arm
286.0
224.7 
Third party stock finance
296.7 
262.5 
Total inventories
582.7 
487.2 
   
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 2022 
 £m 
2021
 £m
New and used vehicles
559.7 
461.2 
Consignment vehicles 
35.3 
27.2 
595.0
488.4
   

170
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
 
The third party stock facilities have prescribed limits and can be used to fund virtually any vehicle. Any undrawn amount 
is therefore directly relatable to the ability of the Group to increase inventory and fund it accordingly. Undrawn third party 
stock finance facilities at 31 December 2022 amounted to £65.9m (2021: £73.1m). In contrast, manufacturer limits vary with 
the manufacturer’s requirements (depending on the amount of stocks each manufacturer wishes to put into the network, 
which varies depending on the time of year and level of production) and are therefore not directly related to the Group’s 
liquidity:  it is therefore not appropriate to quote an undrawn facility. 
	
The key contractual terms of the facilities (both manufacturer and third party) are:	
	
	
	
•	 The facilities are usually structured as an agency to purchase vehicles on behalf of the funder .
•	 Those vehicles are immediately sold back to Pendragon on deferred payment terms.
•	 Legal title to the vehicles thus remains with the funder as the funder has purchased the vehicles (via the dealer as agent) 
and has an unpaid invoice (either in part or in full) outstanding from Pendragon.
•	 The unpaid invoice is therefore trade credit and is accounted for as a trade payable in the financial statements.
•	 The payment terms for the invoice vary with the type of vehicle:  
 
 
 
 
•	 A new vehicle invoice typically requires no upfront deposit payment (a new i.e. unregistered vehicle, does not 
depreciate) and remains outstanding for varying periods up to 360 days.
•	 A used vehicle invoice typically requires an immediate payment of c.10% i.e. so that the effective “loan to value” given 
for the vehicle is c.90%. As a used vehicle depreciates with age and mileage, periodic instalment payments might 
also be required, for example 2% per month or 10% at day 90.	 	
	
	
	
	
•	  Interest is payable in respect of the unpaid invoice. Most new vehicle invoices from manufacturers have an interest free 
period followed by commercial rates of interest. Interest rates from third party stock funders are at a commercial rate 
from the start.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Payment of any outstanding amounts is due on the earlier of the sale of the vehicle by Pendragon to a customer, or upon 
the expiry of a pre-determined maturity period. The maturity period varies by funder and by type of vehicle but is up to 
360 days in respect of new vehicles and 330 days in respect of used vehicles.  
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Manufacturer facility agreements are tied to the franchise agreement i.e. for as long as the franchise agreement is 
operational the manufacturer will provide funding facilities to enable the franchisee to sell the product. Other than that, 
the normal provisions regarding immediate termination due to an insolvency event or change of control would apply. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Third party facility agreements are uncommitted and can be terminated immediately upon default or upon written notice 
by either party; those notice periods vary by agreement but can be from 30-120 days. In practice, if notice is given, no 
new contracts for funding individual vehicles would be entered into by the funding partner and the facility in respect of 
each individual vehicle would be paid down over time as normal i.e. on the earlier of the normal maturity of the facility for 
a particular vehicle or upon sale of the vehicle to a customer. Despite the uncommitted nature of the agreements, most 
relationships with funders are of a long standing nature.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

171
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
 
The Group is also responsible for funding the pension deficit. The total financial resources required by the Group to fund 
itself at 31 December 2022 comprises:
 
The Board’s policy is to maintain a strong capital base to maintain market confidence and to sustain the development of 
the business, whilst maximising the return on capital to the Group’s shareholders. The Group’s strategy will be to maintain 
facilities appropriate to the working requirements of the Group and to service its debt requirements through generating 
cash flow. At 31 December 2022 the adjusted net debt : underlying EBITDA ratio achieved was 0.1 : 1, calculated as follows:
	
	
2022 
 £m 
2021
 £m
Net debt
23.3 
49.7 
Finance lease liabilities
217.9 
222.1 
Stock finance
582.7
447.8 
Pension deficit
2.6 
23.6 
826.5 
743.2 
2022 
 £m 
2021
£m
Underlying operating profit
98.5 
116.3 
Depreciation
64.7 
70.4 
Amortisation
4.9 
4.2 
Underlying EBITDA
168.1 
190.9 
Adjusted net debt (being net debt as set out in the alternative performance measures 
in note 1)
23.3 
49.7 
Adjusted net debt : underlying EBITDA ratio
0.1 
0.3 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

172
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
2022
2021
Underlying profit before tax (£m)
57.6 
83.0 
Underlying earnings per share (p)
3.2 
5.0 
Net debt : underlying EBITDA
0.1 
0.3 
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.2	Financial instruments and derivatives continued
 
The key measures which management uses to evaluate the Group's use of its financial resources, and performance achieved 
against these in 2022 and 2021 are set out below:
 
The Group’s capital structure and capital allocation priorities were reassessed during 2020 as part of the determination 
of the Group's strategy for the next five years. That strategy shall require investment to grow the used car non-franchise 
business, to develop Pinewood's offering and to maintain and improve the UK Motor franchise business.
	
The Group has previously engaged in share buyback programmes though none are currently operating. The Group may 
also issue shares or purchase them in the market to satisfy share incentives issued to employees of the Group. The Group 
encourages employees to be shareholders of the Group, providing selective share option and LTIP schemes from time to 
time.		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Certain of the Group’s subsidiaries are required to maintain issued share capital at levels to support capital adequacy under 
Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) requirements. The Group ensures these requirements are met by injections of equity to 
the subsidiaries in question, when required. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
 
Other than specifically set out above, there were no changes to capital management in the year. 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

173
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.3	Net financing costs	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Finance income comprises interest income on funds invested, return on net pension scheme assets and gains on hedging 
instruments that are recognised in profit and loss. Interest income is recognised as it accrues in profit and loss, using the 
effective rate method.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Finance expense comprises interest expense on borrowings, unwinding of the discount on provisions, interest on net 
pension scheme obligations and losses on hedging instruments recognised in profit and loss. All borrowing costs are 
recognised in profit and loss using the effective interest method. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
Gross finance costs directly attributable to the construction of property, plant and equipment are capitalised as part of the 
cost of those assets until such a time as the assets are substantially ready for their intended use or sale. 
	
Finance expense
	
Interest of £0.8m has been capitalised during the year on assets under construction at an average rate of 7.47% (2021: 
£0.3m).
	
Finance income
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
Recognised in profit and loss
2022 
 £m 
2021
 £m
Interest payable on bank borrowings, SFA, Senior note and loan notes
10.8
9.4 
Vehicle stocking plan interest
14.7 
9.8 
Interest payable on leases
14.7 
12.6 
Costs incurred on refinancing (non-underlying - see note 2.6)
2.6 
- 
Net interest on pension scheme obligations (non-underlying - see note 2.6)
0.3 
1.0 
Less: interest capitalised
 (0.8)
 (0.3)
Total interest expense being interest expense in respect of financial liabili-
ties held at amortised cost
42.3 
32.5 
Unwinding of discounts in contract hire residual values
2.5 
2.7 
Total finance expense
44.8 
35.2 
Recognised in profit and loss
2022 
 £m 
2021
 £m
Interest receivable on finance leases
1.0 
0.9 
Total finance income
1.0 
0.9 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

174
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.4	Capital and reserves	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Ordinary share capital	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Ordinary shares are classified as equity.  Incremental costs directly attributable to the issue of ordinary shares are 
recognised as a deduction from equity, net of any tax effects.  
 
There were no issues of ordinary shares during the year.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
The holders of ordinary shares are entitled to receive dividends as declared from time to time and are entitled to one vote 
per share at meetings of the Group. All shares rank equally with regard to the Group’s residual assets. 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Capital redemption reserve
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The capital redemption reserve has arisen following the purchase by the Group of its own shares and comprises the 
amount by which distributable profits were reduced on these transactions in accordance with s733 of the Companies Act 
2006.  There were no transfers into the capital redemption reserve during the year in respect of shares purchased by the 
Group and subsequently cancelled (2021: £nil).
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Other reserves	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Other reserves comprise the amount of demerger reserve arising on the demerger of the Group from Williams Holdings 
PLC in 1989.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Own shares held by Employee Benefit Trust (EBT)	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
Transactions of the Group-sponsored EBT are included in the Group financial statements. In particular, the trust’s 
purchases of shares in the Group, which are classified as own shares, are debited directly to equity through retained 
earnings. When own shares are sold or reissued the resulting surplus or deficit on the transaction is also recognised within 
retained earnings.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The market value of the investment in the Group's own shares at 31 December 2022 was £0.3m (2021: £1.3m), being 
1.5m (2021: 5.8m) shares with a nominal value of 5p each, acquired at an average cost of £0.24 each (2021: £0.33). The 
trustee of the EBT is Salamanca Group Trust (Jersey) Limited. The shares in trust may subsequently be awarded to 
Executive Directors and employees under the Pendragon 1999 Approved Executive Share Option Scheme, Pendragon 
1999 Unapproved Executive Share Option Scheme and to satisfy amounts under LTIPs. Details of the plans are given in the 
Directors' Remuneration Report on pages 77 to 95..	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
 
Dividends on the shares owned by the trust, the purchase of which were funded by interest free loans to the trust from 
Pendragon PLC, are waived. All expenses incurred by the trust are settled directly by Pendragon PLC and charged in the 
accounts as incurred.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The trust is regarded as a quasi subsidiary and its assets and results are consolidated into the financial statements of the 
Group.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Number
 £m 
Allotted, called up and fully paid shares of 5p each at 31 December 2021 and 
31 December 2022
1,396,944,405 
69.9 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

175
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.4	Capital and reserves  continued		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Translation reserve	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
The translation reserve comprises all foreign exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment 
in foreign operations as well as from the translation of liabilities held to hedge the respective net investment in foreign 
operations.	
4.5	Dividends	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Board is not recommending the payment of a final dividend for 2022 (2021: nil).
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

176
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.6	Share based compensation	
	
	
	 	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	 	
 
The Group operates a number of employee share option schemes and an executive share ownership plan 'exsop' awarded 
in 2010. The fair value at the date at which the share options are granted is recognised in the income statement on a 
straight line basis over the vesting period, taking into account the number of options that are expected to vest. The fair 
value of the options granted is measured using an option pricing model, taking into account the terms and conditions 
upon which the options were granted. The number of options that are expected to become exercisable is reviewed at each 
balance sheet date and if necessary estimates are revised. 	
	
	 	
	
Executive share options	
	
	
	 	
 
The number and weighted average exercise prices of share options is as follows:
 
The options outstanding at 31 December 2022 have an exercise price of 31.82p and a weighted contractual life of 1.7 years. 
All share options are settled in equity.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
 
Movements in the number of options to acquire ordinary shares under the Group's various share option schemes, together 
with exercise prices and the outstanding position at 31 December 2022 were as follows: 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
All grants of share options were issued pursuant to the 2009 Executive Share Option Scheme, which prescribed an earnings 
per share performance criterion. It is a precondition to the exercise of grants made under the 2009 Scheme that the growth 
in the Group's earnings per share over the prescribed three year period must exceed by at least 3 percent per annum 
compound the annual rate of inflation as shown by the RPI Index.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
The weighted average share price at the date of exercise for share options exercised in the year was 27.50p (2021: 
17.68p).  	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
All options are settled by physical delivery of shares.
Exercise period
Date of grant
 Exercise 
 price per 
 share 
  At 31 
December 
 2021
 Number 
  Exercised 
 Number 
  Lapsed 
 Number 
 At 31 
December 
 2022 
 Number 
31 March 2015 to 30 March 2022
30 March 2012
13.50p
1,000,000  (500,000)
 (500,000)
 - 
19 September 2017 to 19 September 2024 18 September 2014
31.82p
2,829,500 
 - 
 - 
2,829,500 
    
    
3,829,500  (500,000)
 (500,000)
2,829,500 
  Weighted 
 average 
 exercise 
 price 
 2022 
  Number 
 of 
 options 
millions
2022 
  Weighted 
 average 
 exercise 
 price 
 2021 
 Number 
 of 
 options 
millions
 2021 
Outstanding at beginning of period
24.0p
3.8 
24.0p
4.6 
Exercised during the period
13.5p
 (0.5)
8.8p
 (0.6)
Lapsed during the period
13.5p
 (0.5)
8.8p
 (0.2)
Outstanding at the end of the period
31.8p
2.8 
24.0p
3.8 
Exercisable at the end of the period
31.8p
2.8 
27.0p
3.8 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

177
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.6	Share based compensation continued	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The fair value of the services received in return for share options is measured by reference to the fair value of the options 
granted. The estimate of the fair value of the services received in respect of share option schemes is measured using the 
Black-Scholes option pricing model. The weighted average fair value of the options at the date of grant for those that are 
outstanding at 31 December 2022 is 7.7p (2021: 6.4p). 
	
Executive Long Term Incentive Plan (“LTIPs”)
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The number and weighted average exercise prices of executive LTIPs is as follows:
	
 
Movements in the number of options to acquire ordinary shares under the Group's LTIP, together with the outstanding 
position at 31 December 2022 were as follows:
	
	
 
All grants of LTIPs were issued pursuant to the Long Term Incentive Plan. Vesting of the 2020 and 2021 Awards under the 
LTIP is subject to the satisfaction of certain performance conditions, 50% of which is based on achieving a defined earnings 
per share target over a defined performance period, commencing on the grant date and measured at the respective year 
end, with the remaining 50% based on the achievement of certain qualitative strategic performance metrics aligned to 
the Company’s strategic milestones as set out in the Company’s Group Strategy Investor Presentation (available at www.
pendragonplc.com). For both the 2020 and 2021 LTIP, the Remuneration Committee concluded that the performance 
conditions had been satisfied in full in terms of the EPS metric, and the Company had delivered significantly on stretching 
strategic targets for 2021, such that both plans would vest at 91.6% in October 2023 and July 2024 respectively. 
 
For awards made in August 2022, the performance metrics applicable were (i) achieving a defined earnings per share 
target over a three year performance period, commencing on 01 January 2022 and measured at year end 2024, namely 
achieving a target EPS derived from a mix of the most recently available analyst/broker consensus published at or around 
the time of making the award and our business plan of 4.0p at target by year end 2024 (70% weighting); (ii) achieving an 
overall reduction in carbon emissions of 5% at target by 2024 (5% weighting); (iii) deliver a year end 2024 gross profit of 
£180m in used cars at target (15% weighting) and (iv) deliver revenue of £30m by year end 2024 in Pinewood at target 
(10% weighting).  
 
If the performance conditions are not satisfied, none of the LTIP award shares will vest. 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
  Weighted 
 average 
 exercise 
 price 
 2022 
  Number 
 of 
 options 
millions
2022 
  Weighted 
 average 
 exercise 
 price 
 2021
 Number 
 of 
 options 
millions
 2021
Outstanding at the start of the period
0.00p
44.1 
 0.00p 
27.6 
Granted during the period
0.00p
12.3 
0.00p
16.5 
Outstanding at the end of the period
0.00p
56.4 
0.00p
44.1 
Exercise period
Date of grant
At 31 
December
2021 
Number 
  
 Granted 
Number 
At 31 
December
2022
 Number 
27 October 2023
28 October 2020
27,648,123 
 - 
27,648,123 
12 July 2024
13 July 2021
16,506,004 
 - 16,506,004 
13 August 2025
14 August 2022
-
19,562,808 
19,562,808 
44,154,127 
19,562,808 
63,716,935

178
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.6	Share based compensation continued
	
Executive bonuses relating to performance in 2020 were granted in the form of deferred share awards that have vested 
one year after grant date. They automatically convert into one ordinary share each on vesting at an exercise price of nil. 
The executives do not receive any dividends and are not entitled to vote in relation to the deferred shares during the 
vesting period. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
The fair value at the date at which the share options are granted is recognised in the income statement on a straight line 
basis over the vesting period, taking into account the number of options that are expected to vest. The number of options 
that are expected to become exercisable is reviewed at each balance sheet date and if necessary estimates are revised. The 
fair value of the services received in return for the LTIPs is measured by reference to the fair value of the LTIPs granted. 
The estimate of the fair value of the services received in respect of the LTIPs is measured using the Black-Scholes option 
pricing model.  The weighted average fair value of the options at the date of grant for those that are outstanding at 31 
December 2022 is 14.08p (2021: 14.08p).	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Expected volatility was determined by calculating the historical volatility of the Group's share price over the corresponding 
historical period.  The expected life used in the model has been adjusted, based on management's best estimate, for the 
effects of exercise restrictions and associate turnover.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Income statement
 
The Group recognised a total net expense of £3.3m (2021: £2.9m) as an employee benefit cost in respect of all equity-
settled share based payment transactions included within administration costs.
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Executive LTIP Scheme
  2022 
2021 
Number of share options granted in year
19,562,808 
16,506,004 
Weighted average share price (pence)
0.00 
0.00 
Weighted average exercise price (pence)
0.00 
0.00 
Weighted average fair value (pence)
23.72 
19.09 
Expected volatility (%)
50.6%
48.9%
Expected life (years)
3.0 
3.0 
Risk free rate (%)
358.3%
69.3%
Expected dividend yield (%)
0.0%
0.0%

179
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.7	Leases
	
Accounting policies	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Leases as a Lessee 
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
At inception of a contract, the Group assesses whether a contract is, or contains, a lease. A contract is, or contains, a lease 
if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange for consideration. 
To assess whether a contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset, the Group uses the definition of a 
lease in IFRS 16. This policy is applied to contracts entered into, on or after 1 January 2019.	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group recognises a right of use asset and a lease liability at the lease commencement date. The right of use asset is 
initially measured at cost, and subsequently at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses, and adjusted for 
certain remeasurements of the lease liability. Cost comprises the initial amount of the lease liability adjusted for any initial 
direct costs incurred less any lease incentives received. Depreciation is recognised on a straight line basis over the period 
of the lease the right of use asset is expected to be utilised.		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
The lease liability is initially measured at the present value of lease payments that are not paid at the commencement 
date, discounted by the interest rate implicit in the lease or when this is not readily attainable, the Group’s incremental 
borrowing rate. Lease payments include fixed rental payments and amounts expected to be payable under a residual 
value guarantee. Generally the Group uses its incremental borrowing rate as the discount rate. The Group determines 
its incremental borrowing rate by obtaining interest rates from various external financing sources and makes certain 
adjustments to reflect the terms of the lease and type of the asset leased. 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The lease liability is subsequently increased by the interest cost on the lease liability and reduced by payments made. It is 
remeasured when there is a change in future lease payments arising from a change of index or rate, a variation in amounts 
payable following contractual rent reviews and changes in the assessment of whether an extension/termination option is 
reasonably certain to be exercised. When the lease liability is remeasured in this way, a corresponding adjustment is made 
to the carrying amount of the right-of-use asset, or is recorded in profit or loss if the carrying amount of the right-of-use 
asset has been reduced to zero.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
 
Sale and leaseback transactions. When a transfer of an asset is made and it is deemed a sale in accordance with IFRS 15, 
the resulting right-of-use asset arising from the leaseback is measured at the proportion of the previous carrying amount 
of the asset that relates to the right of use retained by the seller/lessee. Gain or loss is recognised only at the amount that 
relates to the rights transferred to the buyer/lessor.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
 
The Group presents right-of-use assets that do not meet the definition of investment property in ‘property, plant and 
equipment’ and lease liabilities in ‘loans and borrowings’ in the Balance Sheet.  
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group has elected not to recognise right-of-use assets and lease liabilities for leases of low-value assets and short-
term leases. The Group recognises the lease payments associated with these leases as an expense on a straight-line basis 
over the lease term.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

180
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.7	Leases continued	
	
	
	
Balance Sheet	
 
The Group leases a large number of properties for use as motor vehicle dealerships, parts distribution warehouses, storage 
compounds and offices.  Lease terms vary and at 31 December 2022 property leases had an average of around 12.4 years 
to expiry.  These leases comprise those with provision for periodic rent reviews, fixed scheduled increases and those 
with periodic increases based on the RPI. The Group does not have any property leases that contain extension clauses. A 
number of property leases have break clauses allowing the Group to terminate the agreement earlier than the lease expiry 
date.  The Group has applied judgement in that unless it is reasonably certain that such a break option will be exercised, the 
calculation of the lease liability and right of use asset is made up to the expiry date of the lease. Had the Group recognised a 
shorter lease term then right of use assets and lease liabilities would both be lower than currently reported and the interest 
expense for the current year on lease liabilities would be reduced with the possibility depreciation charges could increase.
	
In addition to property leases the Group have leases for various items of plant and equipment and motor vehicles.		
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Right of use assets are presented as part of property, plant and equipment as presented in note 3.2.	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Right of Use Assets
	
	
	
Disposals of right of use assets have occurred on assignment of leases, derecognition on entering into sub leases and early 
terminations. 
  Land & 
 buildings 
 £m 
  Motor 
vehicles
£m 
 Total
£m
Balance at 1 January 2021
145.6 
0.4 
146.0 
Additions to right of use assets
8.7 
0.1 
8.8 
Reinstated from assets held for sale as part of a disposal group
5.0 
 - 
5.0 
Depreciation charge
 (18.1)
 (0.4)
 (18.5)
Impairment
 (9.6)
 - 
 (9.6)
Disposals of right of use assets 
 (5.2)
 - 
 (5.2)
Balance at 31 December 2021
126.4 
0.1 
126.5 
Balance at 1 January 2022
126.4 
0.1 
126.5 
Additions to right of use assets
22.5 
 - 
22.5 
Depreciation charge
 (15.1)
 (0.1)
 (15.2)
Impairment
 (0.2)
 - 
 (0.2)
Disposals of right of use assets 
 (3.1)
 - 
 (3.1)
Balance at 31 December 2022
130.5 
 -
130.5 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

181
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.7	Leases continued
	
Lease liabilities
	
 
During the year a lease regear was undertaken with our largest property partner in which 30 prime leaseholds were extended 
until 2042 with the Group benefitting from reductions in rent payable from the agreement to hand-back 12 vacant properties 
to the landlord in exchange for the lease extensions. The extensions were deemed lease modifications in light of the increased 
duration with all other terms of the leases remaining unchanged. An updated discount rate appropriate to these modified 
leases was applied in determining the increased liability and right of use asset. The 12 leases terminated had a lease liability 
of £16.8m in respect of right of use assets of £0.7m and finance lease receivables of £1.1m, giving an overall net liability at 
the time of the transaction of £15.0m, which, because the extensions were considered to subsidise the terminations, has 
been recognised as a lease incentive and as such a reduction in the value of the 30 extended right of use assets. In respect 
  Land & 
 buildings 
 £m 
  Motor 
vehicles
£m 
 Total
£m
 Included within 
liabilities 
associated with 
the assets held 
for sale
£m
Balance at 1 January 2021
 (242.7)
 (0.5)
 (243.2)
 (30.6)
Additions to right of use assets
 (8.7)
 (0.1)
 (8.8)
 - 
Additions to lease receivables
 (0.4)
 - 
 (0.4)
 - 
Interest expense related to lease liabilities
 (12.5)
 - 
 (12.5)
 (0.1)
Disposals of lease liabilities on sale of business
 - 
 - 
 - 
27.8 
Other disposals of lease liabilities
5.8 
 - 
5.8 
 - 
Reinstated from liabilities held for sale as part of a disposal group
 (2.5)
 - 
 (2.5)
2.5 
Repayment of lease liabilities (including interest element)
38.9 
0.5 
39.4 
0.4 
Exchange adjustments
0.2 
 - 
0.2 
 - 
Other movements
 (0.1)
 - 
 (0.1)
 - 
Balance at 31 December 2021
 (222.0)
 (0.1)
 (222.1)
 - 
Non-current
 (195.4)
 - 
 (195.4)
Current
 (26.6)
 (0.1)
 (26.7)
Balance at 31 December 2021
 (222.0)
 (0.1)
 (222.1)
Balance at 1 January 2022
 (222.0)
 (0.1)
 (222.1)
Additions to right of use assets
 (34.9)
 - 
 (34.9)
Additions to lease receivables
 (0.4)
 - 
 (0.4)
Interest expense related to lease liabilities
 (14.7)
 - 
 (14.7)
Disposals of lease liabilities
17.6 
 - 
17.6 
Repayment of lease liabilities (including interest element)
36.8 
0.1 
36.9 
Exchange adjustments
 (0.1)
 - 
 (0.1)
Other movements
 (0.2)
 - 
 (0.2)
Balance at 31 December 2022
 (217.9)
 - 
 (217.9)
Non-current
 (197.9)
 - 
 (197.9)
Current
 (20.0)
 -
 (20.0)
Balance at 31 December 2022
 (217.9)
 - 
 (217.9)
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

182
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.7	Leases continued
	
of the tables above this transaction resulted in additions to right of use assets of £16.5m (after deduction of the £15.0m 
lease incentive and including £2.6m of additional costs incurred), disposals of right of use assets of £0.7m, disposals of 
finance lease receivables of £1.1m, disposals of lease liabilities of £16.8m and an addition of a lease liability of £28.9m.
	
The calculation of the lease liability and the right of use asset relies upon the estimation of a suitable interest rate.  The 
Group has applied rates to represent the different types of leases it has by applying its incremental borrowing rate for 
shorter term leases and a higher rates based upon market rates for borrowing against equivalent assets with similar risk 
profiles in specific markets for medium to longer term leases. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
 
Future increases in rentals linked to an index or rate are not included in the lease liability until the change in cash flows 
takes effect.  Approximately 69.0% (2021: 69.5%) of the Group’s lease liabilities are subject to inflation linked rentals. Rental 
changes linked to inflation or rent reviews typically occur on an annual basis and are subject to caps. Remeasurement 
adjustments in respect of these increases are included in additions to right of use assets and lease liabilities in the tables 
above. 
 
Other future possible cash outflows not included in the lease liability include the payment of dilapidations in respect of 
properties where the lease contains specific condition of return clauses. Whilst the Group endeavours to maintain its 
properties to a high standard it is likely that such payments will be made in the future when lease contracts end. 
	
	
	
Amounts recognised in profit or loss
	
Expenses relating to variable lease payments not included in lease liabilities relate to the payment of dilapidation claims 
made on properties.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group as lessor	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
Leases as a Lessor 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
When the Group acts as a lessor, it determines at lease inception whether each lease is a finance lease or an operating 
lease. 
 
To classify each lease, the Group makes an overall assessment of whether the lease transfers substantially all of the risks 
and rewards incidental to ownership of the underlying asset. If this is the case, then the lease is a finance lease; if not, then 
it is an operating lease. As part of this assessment, the Group considers certain indicators such as whether the lease is for 
the major part of the economic life of the asset. 
	
2022
 £m 
2021
 £m 
Depreciation of right of use assets
15.2 
18.5
Impairment of right of use assets (non-underlying)
0.2 
 9.6
Gains on the dispoal, termination and assignment of leases  (non-underlying) (included 
in Other income - gains on the sale of businesses and property, plant and equipment)
0.6 
 1.5 
Interest on lease liabilities
14.7 
12.6 
Expense relating to variable lease payments not included in lease liabilities
0.1 
0.1 
Expenses relating to low value leases
0.7 
0.1 
Expenses relating to short term leases
6.5 
1.1 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

183
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.7	Leases continued
	
When the Group is an intermediate lessor, it accounts for its interests in the head lease and the sub-lease separately. It 
assesses the lease classification of a sub-lease with reference to the right-of-use asset arising from the head lease, not with 
reference to the underlying asset. 
	
Where the Group acts as a Lessor of an operating lease, receipts of lease payments are recognised in the income statement 
on a straight line basis over the period of the lease. Where the Group acts as a Lessor of a finance lease the Group will, 
rather than recognise a right of use asset, recognise a finance lease receivable, this being the present value of future lease 
receipts discounted at the interest rate implicit in the lease or if this is not specified the Group's incremental borrowing 
rate. The finance lease receivable will be increased by the interest received and reduced by payments made by the lessee.
	
Balance Sheet
	
Lease receivables
 
The following table sets out a maturity analysis of lease payments receivable, showing the undiscounted lease payments 
to be received after the reporting date:
Land and buildings
2022
 £m 
2021
 £m 
Balance at 1 January 
17.6 
18.6 
Additions to lease receivables
2.6 
2.7 
Interest income related to lease receivables
1.0 
0.9 
Disposals of lease liabilities
 (1.0)
 (1.5)
Payment of lease receivables (including interest element)
 (3.0)
 (3.1)
Balance at 31 December
17.2 
17.6 
Non-current
14.8 
15.5 
Current
2.4 
2.1 
17.2 
17.6 
2022 
 £m 
2021 
 £m 
Less than one year
3.3 
3.0 
Between one and two years
3.1 
3.0 
Between two and three years
2.5 
2.9 
Between three and four years
2.3 
2.2 
Between four and five years
2.3 
2.0 
More than five years
8.0 
9.5 
Total undiscounted lease receivable
21.5 
22.6 
Unearned finance income
 (4.3)
 (5.0)
17.2 
17.6 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

184
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 4 - FINANCING ACTIVITIES AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
4.7	Leases continued
	
	
 
At the 31 December 2022 balance sheet date, the Group had contracted with tenants for the following future minimum 
lease payments on leases classified as operating leases. 
	
The Group has no properties that are treated as investment properties.
	
Amounts recognised in profit or loss
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2022 
 Property
£m 
2021 
Property
£m 
Less than one year
2.4 
2.2 
Between one and two years
2.3 
1.9 
Between two and three years
2.2 
1.9 
Between three and four years
1.8 
1.8 
Between four and five years
1.1 
1.8 
More than five years
2.8 
4.5 
12.6 
14.1 
2022 
 £m 
2021 
 £m 
Operating lease rentals received
2.9 
1.8 
Interest received on finance lease receivables
1.0 
0.9 
3.9 
2.7 

185
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES
This section explains the pension scheme obligations of the Group.
5.1	Pension obligations	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group operated a number of defined benefit and defined contribution plans during the year. The assets of the defined 
benefit plan and one defined contribution plan are held in independent trustee administered funds. The Group also operates 
a Group Personal Pension Plan which is a defined contribution plan where the assets are held by the insurance Group under 
a contract with each individual.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
 
Defined contribution plans - A defined contribution plan is one under which the Group pays fixed contributions and has 
no legal or constructive obligation to pay further amounts. Therefore, no assets or liabilities of these plans are recorded 
in these financial statements. Obligations for contributions to defined contribution pension plans are recognised as an 
employee benefit expense in the income statement when they are due. 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Defined benefit plans - Pension accounting costs for defined benefit plans are assessed by determining the pension 
obligation using the projected unit credit method after including a net return on the plan assets. Under this method, in 
accordance with the advice of qualified actuaries, the amounts charged in respect of employee benefits reflect the cost of 
benefits accruing in the year and the cost of financing historical accrued benefits. The Group recognises all actuarial gains 
and losses arising from defined benefit plans in the statement of other comprehensive income immediately. 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The present value of pension obligations is measured by reference to market yields on high quality corporate bonds 
which have terms to maturity approximating to the terms of the related pension liability. Plan assets are measured at fair 
value. When the calculation results in a benefit to the Group, the recognised asset is limited to the total of the present 
value of economic benefits available in the form of any future refunds from the plan or reductions in future contributions 
to the plan. An economic benefit is available to the Group if it is realisable during the life of the plan, or on settlement of 
the plan liabilities.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Under IAS 19 Employee Benefits, the Group recognises an interest expense or income which is calculated on the net 
defined benefit liability or asset respectively by applying the discount rate to the net defined benefit liability or asset. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Remeasurements arising from defined benefit plans comprise actuarial gains and losses and the return on plan assets 
(excluding interest) are immediately recognised directly in the statement of other comprehensive income. Actuarial 
gains and losses are the differences between actual and interest income during the year, experience losses on scheme 
liabilities and the impact of any changes in assumptions. Details of the last independent statutory actuarial valuation and 
assumptions are set out below.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
Pension arrangements		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group operated six defined benefit pension schemes (one of which had a defined contribution section) which closed 
to new members and accrual of future benefits on 30 September 2006 and a defined contribution scheme which was 
closed to new contributions from April 2006. All affected employees were offered membership of a defined contribution 
pension arrangement with Friends Provident. A Group Personal Pension arrangement with Legal & General replaced the 
Friends Provident arrangement from 1 January 2010. Total contributions paid by the Group in 2021 to the Legal & General 
arrangement were £4.7m (2021: £3.0m). To comply with the Government’s automatic enrolment legislation, the Group 
chose to participate in the People’s Pension Scheme in April 2013. This is a defined contribution occupational pension 
scheme provided by B&CE. Total contributions paid by the Group to the People’s Pension in 2022 were £6.0m (2021: 
£4.2m). The combined contributions to the Group's Personal Pension arrangement and the Peoples Pension scheme 
therefore totalled £10.7m in the period (2021: £7.2m).
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

186
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES
5.1	Pension obligations continued
 
During 2012 the Trustees merged the six defined benefit schemes into one new defined benefit scheme, ‘the Pendragon 
Group Pension Scheme’, which remains closed to new members and accrual of future benefits. The assets of the six 
schemes have all been transferred into the new scheme and the benefits previously accrued in the six schemes were 
transferred without amendment of the benefit entitlement of members to the new scheme.  
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The scheme is subject to the funding legislation outlined in the Pensions Act 2004 which came into force on 30 December 
2005. This, together with documents issued by the Pensions Regulator, and Guidance Notes adopted by the Financial 
Reporting Council, set out the framework for funding defined benefit occupational pension schemes in the UK. 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Board of the Trustees of the pension scheme is currently composed of two member nominated trustees (i.e. members 
of the pension scheme nominated by other members to be trustees), two employer representatives and a professional 
independent trustee, who became chair during 2018. The Trustee of the scheme is required to act in the best interest of the 
scheme’s beneficiaries. The appointment of the Trustee is determined by the scheme’s trust documentation. 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Under IAS 24, the pension schemes are related parties of the Group. At 31 December 2022 there was an outstanding 
balance of £0.9m (2021: £0.9m)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
Funding	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Pendragon Group Pension Scheme is fully funded by the Group’s subsidiaries. The funding requirements are based on 
the Scheme’s actuarial measurement framework set out in the funding policies of the Scheme. Employees are not required 
to contribute to the plans.
	
Explanation of the Pension Deficit	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
 
The liability to pay future pensions is a liability to settle a stream of future cashflows. These future cashflows have the 
following profile:
	
	 	
	
	
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
2030	
2040	
2050	
2060	
2070	
2080	
2090	
2100	
2110	
2120
 Deferreds    
 Pensioners    
 Expenses
Annual Payment £m
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

187
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES	
5.1	Pension obligations continued	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
'Deferred' are those pension scheme members not yet drawing a pension as at 31 December 2022; 'Pensioners' are those 
in receipt of pension at 31 December 2022.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
 
The actual total cash liabilities shown above are estimated at £766m. The value of these liabilities discounted to present 
value at 31 December 2022 are £368.9m.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
 
In order to meet those future cashflows, the Pension Scheme has to grow its assets sufficient to settle those liabilities. The 
risk of the future value of those assets is dependent on the financial return; the liabilities will change dependent on the 
rate of inflation (as most pensions are inflation adjusted) and longevity (how long the pensioner lives for and therefore 
in receipt of pension). The pension deficit is the gap between those assets and liabilities and can be calculated in one of 
two ways, both of which are arithmetically identical: either forecast future assets at the asset growth rate to offset against 
actual liabilities or discount future liabilities by the asset growth rate and compare with the present value of the assets. The 
latter method is the one commonly adopted and accounting standards require that the asset growth rate (the discount 
rate) should be estimated on a similar basis for every Group, to enhance comparability and to assume a relatively low level 
of risk. The more realistic picture is provided by the actuarial valuation which considers what the prudent estimate of the 
asset growth rate should be and hence what the gap is that the Group will be required to fund through cash contributions. 
These actuarial valuations are conducted every three years (the triennial valuation). The last triennial valuation was 
conducted as at 31 December 2021 giving the following comparison:  
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The triennial valuation of the pension scheme reflecting the position as at 31 December 2021 was agreed by the Trustees 
on 2 November 2022. The Group has agreed with the trustees that it will aim to eliminate the deficit over a period of 
2 years from December 2021 until December 2023 by the payment of deficit recovery contributions of £13.06m each 
year, increasing at 2.25% p.a. These contributions include the expected quarterly distributions from the Central Asset 
Reserve (CAR) over the recovery period. Recognising that both the Trustee and the Group aim to achieve full funding 
on a long term funding target, contributions will continue beyond 31 December 2023, but only in respect of the quarterly 
distributions from the CAR. On this basis, contributions will reduce to £3.45m p.a. from 1 January 2024, increasing at a rate 
of 2.25% p.a, and will be paid until 31 December 2026.  The next triennial valuation of the pension scheme will reflect the 
position as at 31 December 2024.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
As at 31 December 2021
IAS 19
(Accounts)
 £m 
Actuarial 
valuation
 £m
Assets
545.6 
 545.6
Liabilities 
 (569.2)
 (578.7)
Pension deficit
 (23.6)
 (33.1)
At each term p.a.
Discount rate used
1.80%
Nominal Gilt 
Yield + 0.75%
RPI inflation
3.50%
Gilt inflation 
curve
CPI inflation
3.00%
Gilt inflation 
curve less 
0.70% to 2020, 
no adjustment 
thereafter
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

188
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES
5.1	Pension obligations continued
	
Central Asset Reserve	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Pendragon PLC is a general partner and the Pendragon Group Pension Scheme is a limited partner of the Pendragon 
Scottish Limited Partnership (the Partnership). The Partnership holds properties with a book value of £45.1m (with a most 
recent market valuation of £47.1m), which have been leased back to the Group at market rates. The Group retains control 
over these properties, including the flexibility to substitute alternative properties. As such, the Partnership is consolidated 
into the results of the Group. During the year the Group has paid £3.2m to the Pendragon Group Pension Scheme through 
the Partnership (2021: £3.1m) and this will increase by 2.25% on 1 August each year until the leases expire on 31 July 2031. 
These payments could cease in advance of that date if the Pension Scheme’s actuarial valuation reaches a point where 
there is a surplus of 5% over the liability value (on the actuarial triennial valuation basis). The Pension Scheme therefore 
has a right to receive a future stream of rental receipts. No asset is recognised in these financial statements as the Group 
has to consent to any proposed disposal of this asset by the Pension Scheme. However, if the Group became insolvent the 
properties themselves would be retained by the Pension Scheme.
	
	
IAS 19 assumptions	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The assumptions used by the actuary in performing the triennial valuation at 31 December 2021 include an element of 
caution and are chosen from a range of possible actuarial assumptions which, due to the timescale covered, may not 
necessarily be borne out in practice. The IAS assumptions have been updated at 31 December 2022 and differ from those 
used for the earlier independent statutory actuarial valuations explained above.	
 
The principal assumptions used by the independent qualified actuaries for the purposes of IAS 19 for all schemes were:
	
	
	
	 	
	
 
*The mortality table assumption implies the following expected future lifetime from age 65:
	
 
 No adjustments have been made to mortality assumptions at the year end to reflect the potential effects of Covid-19 as the 
actual plan experience is not yet available and it is to soon to make a judgement on the impact of the pandemic on future 
mortality improvements.	
	
During 2010 the Government announced a change to the index to be used for pension increases from RPI to CPI. The 
change applied to certain elements of pension increases depending on the nature of the pension entitlement, the period in 
which it was earned and the rules of each scheme. The application of either RPI or CPI to calculate the pension liability has 
been assessed for each scheme and the relevant elements of pension increases within each scheme. 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 2022
 2021 
Inflation - RPI
3.25%
3.50%
Inflation - CPI
2.85%
3.00%
Discount rate
5.00%
1.80%
Mortality table assumption *
111% of the standard tables S3PMA/
S3PFA_M, Year of birth, no age rat-
ing projected using CMI_2021 (1.25%)
VitaCurves CMI 2020 M/F 
(1.25%)
 2022 
Years
 2021
Years 
Males aged 45
22.7 
22.6 
Females aged 45
24.7 
24.8 
Males aged 65
21.4 
21.3 
Females aged 65
23.2 
23.2 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

189
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES	
 
5.1	Pension obligations continued	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The outcome of the formal consultation on the proposed changes to RPI was announced on 25 November 2020 and 
confirmed that RPI will match CPI including Housing (CPIH) from 2030.   On balance, it is reasonable to assume that RPI 
reform is priced into the market implied RPI curve and therefore, as last year, the assumption makes no change to the base 
derivation of the break-even RPI assumption, other than a general allowance for the inflation risk premium of 0.2% within 
the inflation curve.  
 
At present there is no reliable indicator for market expectations of CPI inflation.  Therefore typical market practice is to 
make an adjustment to the RPI assumption which takes into account the expected difference between the two inflation 
measures.  The RPI/CPI gap of 0.40% p.a. (2021: 0.50% p.a.) broadly reflects an average of a long term assumed gap of 
1.0% p.a. before 2030 and 0% thereafter, suitably weighted to reflect the scheme’s exposure to CPI liabilities. 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The sensitivities regarding the principal assumptions used to measure scheme liabilities are set out below. The Group 
regards these sensitivities as reasonably likely to occur.
 
The sensitivities shown above are approximate.  The discount rate sensititity has been set at 1.00% for 2022 to reflect 
current market uncertainty.. Each sensitivity considers one change in isolation. The inflation sensitivity includes the impact 
of changes to the assumptions for revaluation and pension increases. The average duration of the defined benefit obligation 
at the period ending 31 December 2022 is 14 years (2021: 16 years).	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
The scheme typically exposes the Group to actuarial risks such as investment risk in assets (the return and gain or loss 
on assets invested in), inflation risk (as pensions typically rise in line with inflation) and mortality risk (the length of time a 
pensioner lives for) in respect of liabilities. As the accounting deficit is calculated by reference to a discount rate linked to 
corporate bonds then the Group is also exposed to interest rate risk i.e. the discounted value of liabilities will rise or fall in 
line with changes in the interest rate used to calculate (discount) the future pension liabilities to present value. A decrease 
in corporate bond yields, a rise in inflation or an increase in life expectancy would result in an increase to scheme liabilities. 
This would detrimentally impact the balance sheet position and may give rise to increased charges in future income 
statements. This effect could be partially offset by an increase in the value of the scheme’s assets. In order to further 
mitigate risk, the scheme’s investment strategy  operates within a framework known as Liability Driven Investments (‘LDI’) 
i.e. the scheme invests in a mix of assets that are broadly expected to match the expected movement in the net present 
value of liabilities. This is achieved by investing in assets that are broadly expected to hedge the underlying inflation and 
interest rate risks of 100% of the liabilities. The nature of the products available for liability driven investing mean that a 
greater proportion of the scheme’s assets can be used to invest in assets that are expected to have a higher growth rate 
than low risk assets. The scheme's assets can therefore be broadly subdivided into two categories: return -seeking assets 
which aim to achieve a level of growth to reduce the deficit and "protection seeking" assets, which comprise the LDI 
assets held to mitigate the changes in liabilities. There is further diversification within these individual categories, as further 
described below, and a strategy to "de-risk" assets when certain pre-defined benchmarks are met: in this way the Scheme 
disinvests from assets with more risk into assets with lower risk. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Assumption
Change in assumption
Impact on scheme liabilities
Discount rate
Increase/decrease by 1.00%
Decrease of 10.9%/increase of 13.2%
Rate of inflation
Increase/decrease by 0.25%
Increase of 1.2%/decrease of 1.5%
Mortality
Increase in life expectancy of 1 year
Increase by 2.9%
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

190
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES
5.1	Pension obligations continued
 
The fair value of the scheme’s assets which are not intended to be realised in the short term and may be subject to 
significant change before they are realised, and the value of the schemes liabilities, which is derived from cash flow 
projections over long periods and thus inherently uncertain, are:
	
Scheme assets and liabilities	
	
 
In addition to the assets and liabilities set out above there are a small number of insurance policies (with a value of £4.4m at 
the last triennial valuation date of 31 December 2021) purchased to pay annuities to 70 pensioners. These policies represent 
both an asset and liability of the scheme and therefore have no impact on the net deficit position. 
 
None of the fair values of the assets shown above include any of the Group’s own financial instruments or any property 
occupied by, or other assets used by, the Group. 	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
All of the assets are held within pooled investment vehicles (where cash is invested in a quoted fund designed by the fund 
manager).	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
Investment  risk	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The pension scheme has exposure to a number of risks:
 
Credit risk: this is the risk that one party to a financial instrument will cause a financial loss for the other party by failing to 
discharge an obligation.
 
Currency risk: this is the risk that the fair value or future cash flows of a financial asset will fluctuate because of changes in 
foreign exchange rates.
 
Interest rate risk: this is the risk that the fair value or future cash flows of a financial asset will fluctuate because of changes 
in market interest rates.
 
Other price risk: this is the risk that the fair value of future cash flows of a financial asset will fluctuate because of changes 
in market prices (other than those arising from interest rate risk or currency risk).
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Credit risk	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Scheme is subject to credit risk as it has credit fund exposure and has cash balances. The Scheme invests in pooled 
investment vehicles and is therefore directly exposed to credit risk in relation to the holdings in the pooled investment 
vehicles, and is indirectly exposed to credit risks arising on the financial instruments that make up the pooled investment 
vehicles.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Direct credit risk arising from pooled investment vehicles is mitigated by the underlying assets of the pooled arrangements 
being ring-fenced from the pooled manager, the regulatory environments in which the pooled managers operate and 
diversification of investments amongst a number of pooled arrangements. 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 2022
£m
 2021
£m
Global equities
31.0 
81.0 
Credit funds
134.9 
182.8 
Private markets
69.0 
92.8 
Liability driven investments
86.3 
106.7 
Diversified growth fund
20.7 
52.0 
Cash
24.4 
30.3 
Fair value of scheme assets
366.3 
545.6 
Present value of funded defined benefit obligations
 (368.9)
 (569.2)
Net liability on the balance sheet
 (2.6)
 (23.6)
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

191
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES	
 
5.1	Pension obligations continued	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Currency risk
	
The Scheme’s liabilities are denominated in sterling. The Scheme is exposed to currency risk because some of its investments 
are held in overseas markets. For example, the Scheme invests in pooled funds that hold overseas equities, global credit 
and also funds where the manager has discretion to hold overseas assets. The respective fund managers hedge all, or a 
proportion of,  these risks back to sterling.
	
Interest rate risk and other price risk
	
The Scheme is subject to interest rate risk on the investments comprising of bonds and cash held through pooled vehicles 
and other price risk arises principally in relation to the Scheme’s return-seeking portfolio which includes equities held in 
pooled investment vehicles. The Scheme manages this exposure to other price risk by constructing a diverse portfolio of 
investments across various markets.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Fair value determination
 
The fair value of financial instruments has been determined using the following fair value hierarchy: 
 
 
Level 1: The unadjusted quoted price in an active market for identical assets or liabilities which the entity can access at the 
measurement date	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Level 2: Inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 which are observable (i.e. developed using market data) 
for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Level 3: Inputs which are unobservable (i.e. for which market data is unavailable) for the asset or liability  
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
A summary of the risks and the fair value determination is set out in the table below 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
 
No specific risk is assigned to investment held in multi asset pooled investment vehicles, as they are multi asset by 
definition, and therefore the asset allocations within these funds, and the associated risk theron, change frequently. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Private markets investments have a level 3 valuation as they comprise investments in one fund invested in property.	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
It is the policy of the Trustee and the Group to review the investment strategy at the time of each funding valuation and 
keep this under review. The Trustee investment objectives and the processes undertaken to measure and manage the risks 
inherent in the scheme investment strategy are documented in the scheme’s Statement of Investment Principles.	 	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 Interest 
rate risk
£m 
 Other 
price risk
£m 
 Other
£m 
 Level 1
£m 
 Level 2
£m 
 Level 3
£m 
LDI and cash
110.7 
 - 
 - 
24.4
86.3
 - 
Credit funds
134.9 
 - 
 - 
 - 
134.9
 - 
Equity
31.0 
 - 
 - 
31.0
 - 
Private markets
 - 
69.0 
 - 
45.6 
23.4
DGF
 - 
20.7 
 - 
20.7
 - 
245.6 
31.0 
89.7 
24.4
318.5 
23.4
Being:
Indirect - Bonds
221.2 
 - 
 - 
 - 
221.2 
 - 
Indirect - Cash
24.4 
 - 
 - 
24.4 
 - 
 - 
Indirect - equities
 - 
31.0 
 - 
 - 
31.0 
 - 
Indirect - multi-asset
 - 
 - 
89.7 
 - 
66.3 
23.4 
245.6 
31.0 
89.7 
24.4 
318.5 
23.4 

192
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES	
 
5.1	Pension obligations continued	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group has reviewed implications of the guidance provided by IFRIC 14 and have concluded that it is not necessary 
to make any adjustments to the IAS 19 figures in respect of an asset ceiling or Minimum Funding Requirement as at 31 
December 2022 and at 31 December 2021.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
 
The Trust Deed provides Pendragon with an unconditional right to a refund of surplus assets assuming the full settlement 
of plan liabilities in the event of a plan wind-up. Based on this right, any net surplus in the UK scheme is recognised in 
full.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Movements in the net liability for defined benefit obligations recognised in the balance sheet
	
	
	
Total in the income statement
 2022 
£m
 2021
£m 
Net liability for defined benefit obligations at 1 January
 (23.6)
 (75.5)
Contributions received
13.1 
12.8 
Expense recognised in the income statement
 (0.3)
 (1.0)
Actuarial gains and losses recognised in the statement of other comprehensive income
8.2 
40.1 
Net liability for defined benefit obligations at 31 December
 (2.6)
 (23.6)
The defined benefit obligation can be allocated to the plan’s participants as follows: 
	
 2022 
%
 2021
% 
Deferred plan participants
51 
58 
Retirees
49 
42 
	
	
 2022
£m
 2021
£m 
Actual return on assets
28.3 
28.3 
Expected contributions in following year
13.1 
13.1 
 2022
£m
 2021
£m 
Net interest on obligation
0.3 
1.0 
The expense is recognised in the following line items in the income statement:
	
	
 2022 
£m
 2021
£m 
Finance costs
0.3 
1.0
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

193
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES
5.1	Pension obligations continued
 
The expected discount rate as at 31 December 2022 was 5.00%. This compares to the discount rate of 1.80% used in the 
calculation of the interest income for the period ending 31 December 2021.
 
Based on the reported deficit of £2.6m at 31 December 2022 and the discount rate assumption of 5.00% the charge in 2023 
is expected to be £0.1m. 
	
Past service costs
	
The High Court ruling in the Lloyds Banking Group Pension Trustees Limited v Lloyds Bank plc and others published in 
October 2018 held that UK pension schemes with Guaranteed Minimum Pensions (GMPs) accrued from 17 May 1990 must 
equalise for the different effects of these GMPs between men and women. Allowance was made in the benefit obligations 
at 31 December 2018 for the estimated impact, with a cost recorded as a benefit change in the Income Statement. The 
Trustees and Company have yet to implement GMP equalisation and there is no new evidence. Therefore, the previous 
GMP equalisation allowance has been retained but adjusted for the passage of time and to reflect the estimated impact of 
changes in market conditions.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
A further High Court ruling on 20 November 2020 in the Lloyds Bank Trustees' case extends the scope of the GMP 
equalisation to include previous transfer values paid from the scheme since 1990. An allowance for the estimated impact 
of this was included in the benefit obligations at 31 December 2020 of £3.3m and similarly recorded as a past service cost 
in the Income Statement in 2020. This approximate allowance for GMP equalisation in historic transfers out of the Plan has 
been retained but adjusted for the passage of time and to reflect the estimated impact of changes in market conditions. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Actuarial gains and losses recognised directly in the statement of other comprehensive income
	
Defined benefit income recognised in statement of other comprehensive income
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 2022
£m
 
 2021
£m 
Cumulative amount at 1 January
 (37.4)
 (77.5)
Recognised during the period
8.2 
40.1 
Cumulative amount at 31 December
 (29.2)
 (37.4)
 2022 
£m
 
 2021
£m 
Return on plan assets, excluding interest income
 (184.1)
21.0 
Experience gain on scheme liabilities
 (25.6)
8.7 
Changes in assumptions underlying the present value of scheme obligations
217.9 
10.4 
8.2 
40.1 

194
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 5 - PENSION SCHEMES	
 
5.1	Pension obligations continued	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Changes in the present value of the defined benefit obligation
	
	
Movement in fair value of scheme assets during the period
	
History of experience adjustments
	
	 	
	
 2022 
£m
 
 2021
£m 
Opening present value of defined benefit obligation
569.2 
599.1 
Interest cost
10.1 
8.3 
Remeasurements:
Experience adjustments
25.6 
 (8.7)
Actuarial gains due to changes in demographic assumptions
 (1.3)
4.2 
Actuarial (gains) due to changes in financial assumptions
 (216.6)
 (14.6)
Benefits paid
 (18.1)
 (19.1)
Closing present value of defined benefit obligation
368.9 
569.2 
 2022 
£m
 
 2021
£m 
Opening fair value of assets
545.6 
523.6 
Interest income
9.8 
7.3 
Return on plan assets, excluding interest income
 (184.1)
21.0 
Contributions by employer 
13.1 
12.8 
Benefits paid
 (18.1)
 (19.1)
End of period
366.3 
545.6 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2022
£m
2021
£m
2020
£m
2019
£m
2018
£m
Present value of defined benefit obligation
368.9 
569.2 
599.1 
531.2 
486.3 
Fair value of scheme assets
366.3 
545.6 
523.6 
472.2 
418.0 
Deficit in schemes
2.6 
23.6 
75.5 
59.0 
68.3 
Experience adjustments on scheme liabilities:
Amount
 (192.3)
 (19.1)
74.6 
55.6 
 (37.9)
Percentage of scheme liabilities (%)
(52.1%)
(3.4%)
12.5%
10.5% 
(7.8%)
Experience adjustments on scheme assets: 
Amount
 (184.1)
21.0 
50.0 
54.3 
 (38.8)
Percentage of scheme assets (%)
(50.3%)
3.8%
9.5%
11.5%
(9.3%)

195
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
SECTION 6 - OTHER NOTES
This section contains the notes and information relating to acquisitions and disposals and related party transactions:	 	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
6.1	
Business disposals	
	
6.2    Related party transactions	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
6.1	Business disposals	
	
	
	
Accounting policy	
	
The results of businesses disposed of during the year are included up to the effective date of disposal using the acquisition 
method of accounting. 
	
	
	
Activity	
 
During the year the Group disposed of its remaining motor cycle and trucks businesses for net proceeds of £3.2m which 
resulted in a profit on disposal of £0.3m. 
	
Net assets at the date of disposal:
 
No cash was disposed as part of any business disposal during the year.
 
Goodwill in respect of the DAF business was impaired by £3.6m when it was classified for sale.
 
Deferred consideration received during the year relates to the sale of the US businesses where a retention was held 
pending the successful completion of a store development in progress at the time of the sale.
 
During the previous year the Group disposed of two US and three UK dealerships for proceeds of £27.6m and realising a 
profit of £0.7m on disposal.
Total net 
book value
£m
Assets held for sale 
 - 
Goodwill 
2.1 
Property, plant and equipment 
0.2 
Inventories 
37.2 
Trade and other receivables 
0.1 
Trade and other payables 
 (36.7)
2.9 
Profit on sale of businesses  
0.3 
Total proceeds 
3.2 
Proceeds on sale comprise  
Proceeds on sale satisfied by cash and cash equivalents 
3.2 
Deferred consideration   
0.7 
3.9 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

196
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
 2022 
£m
 
 2021
£m 
Short term employee benefits
3.0 
3.2 
Post-employment benefits
0.1 
0.1 
Share based payments
1.9 
2.0 
5.0 
5.3 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SECTION 6 - OTHER NOTES
6.2	Related party transactions	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Subsidiaries
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Group's ultimate parent company is Pendragon PLC. A listing of subsidiaries is shown within the financial statements 
of the Group on page 205.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Transactions with key management personnel
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The key management personnel of the Group comprise the executive and non-executive directors. The details of the 
remuneration, long term incentive plans, shareholdings, share option and pension entitlements of individual directors are 
included in the Directors' Remuneration Report on pages 77 to 95. 	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
Directors of the Group and their immediate relatives control 1.000% of the ordinary shares of the Group.		
	
	 	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
During the year key management personnel compensation was as follows:
6.3 Contingent liabilities
 
One of the Group’s subsidiary companies, Pinewood Technologies PLC (“Pinewood”), is currently in dispute with one of its 
former software resellers, Pinewood Technologies Asia Pacific Limited (“PAP”).   
 
 
PAP historically contributed c.£0.2m of profit p.a. to the overall Pinewood performance.  PAP owes Pinewood approximately 
£0.5m (including daily interest and other charges), which relates to unpaid invoices arising from the reseller agreements. 
Subsequent to the non-payment of this debt, PAP has claimed that Pinewood is in breach of the reseller agreements and 
has made a claim against Pinewood.  It is not practicable to estimate any potential financial effect of this claim because it 
is at a level that Pinewood considers to be entirely disproportionate to the scale of the business. This claim includes a claim 
for ‘loss of profits’ which is specifically excluded from the reseller agreement.  
 
 
Notwithstanding the size of the claim, Pinewood considers PAP's claim to be entirely misconceived and lacking merit such 
that no provision needs to be made for it on that basis.  Pinewood has also applied for summary judgment to dismiss PAP's 
claim and on Pinewood's claim for payment of the outstanding debt.  

197
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
COMPANY BALANCE SHEET
At 31 December 2022
Notes
2022
£m
2021
£m
Fixed assets
Investments
5
 981.2 
 981.2 
Loans to subsidiary undertakings
 90.0 
 90.0 
 1,071.2 
 1,071.2 
Current assets
   
   
Debtors (amounts due after more than one year : £23.0m)
6
 24.7 
 30.6 
Cash at bank and in hand
 0.5 
 0.3 
 
 25.2 
 30.9 
Creditors: amounts falling due within one year
7
 (491.4)
 (475.7)
Net current liabilities
 (466.2)
 (444.8)
Total assets less current liabilities
 605.0 
 626.4 
Creditors: amounts falling due after more than one year
8
 (90.8)
 (87.1)
Retirement benefit obligations
 (2.6)
 (23.6)
Net assets
 511.6 
 515.7 
Capital and reserves
Called up share capital
11
 69.9 
 69.9 
Share premium account
 56.8 
 56.8 
Capital redemption reserve
11
 5.6 
 5.6 
Other reserves
11
 13.9 
 13.9 
Profit and loss account
 365.4 
 369.5 
Equity shareholders' funds
511.6
515.7
Approved by the Board of Directors on 22 March 2023 and signed on its behalf by:
W Berman	
M S Willis
Chief Executive 
Chief Finance Officer
Registered Company Number: 2304195
The notes on pages 200 to 208 form part of these financial statements.
	
 

198
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
COMPANY STATEMENT OF OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
Year ended 31 December 2022 
2022
£m
2021
£m
  (Loss)/profit for the year 
 (15.0)
 167.0
Other comprehensive income 
Items that will never be reclassified to profit and loss: 
Defined benefit plan remeasurement gains and (losses)  
 9.7 
 41.6 
Income tax relating to defined benefit plan remeasurement gains and (losses)   
 (1.6)
 (6.9)
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 
 8.1 
 34.7 
Total comprehensive (expense)/income for the year 
 (6.9)
 201.7 
The notes on pages 200 to 208 form part of these financial statements.

199
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
COMPANY STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
Year ended 31 December 2022 
Share 
 capital 
 £m 
Share 
premium
 account 
 £m 
Capital
redemption 
 reserve 
 £m 
Other
 reserves 
 £m 
Retained 
 earnings 
 £m 
 Total 
 £m 
Balance at 1 January 2022
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 13.9 
 369.5 
 515.7 
Total comprehensive income for 2022
Loss for the year
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 (15.0)
 (15.0)
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 8.1 
 8.1 
Total comprehensive expense for the year
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 (6.9)
 (6.9)
Transactions with owners, recorded directly in equity
Share based payments
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 3.3 
 3.3 
Income tax relating to share based payments
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 (0.1)
 (0.1)
Own shares issued by EBT
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 0.1 
 0.1 
Own shares purchased by EBT
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 (0.5)
 (0.5)
Total contributions by and distributions to owners
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 2.8 
 2.8 
Balance at 31 December 2022
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 13.9 
 365.4 
 511.6 
Balance at 1 January 2021
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 13.9 
 164.7 
 310.9 
Total comprehensive income for 2021
Profit for the year
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 167.0 
 167.0 
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 34.7 
 34.7 
Total comprehensive income for the year
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 201.7 
 201.7 
Transactions with owners, recorded directly in equity
Share based payments
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 2.9 
 2.9 
Income tax relating to share based payments
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 0.2 
 0.2 
Total contributions by and distributions to owners
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 3.1 
 3.1 
Balance at 31 December 2021
 69.9 
 56.8 
 5.6 
 13.9 
 369.5 
 515.7 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The notes on pages 200 to 208 form part of these financial statements.
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	

200
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
1	
Accounting Policies 
	
(a) Basis of preparation Pendragon PLC is a company incorporated and domiciled in England, UK.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
These financial statements were prepared in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 101 Reduced Disclosure 
Framework ('FRS 101'). 
 
In preparing these financial statements, the Company applies the recognition, measurement and disclosure requirements 
of UK-adopted international accounting standards (“Adopted IFRSs”), but makes amendments where necessary in order 
to comply Companies Act 2006 and has set out below where advantage of the FRS 101 disclosure exemptions has been 
taken.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
These financial statements have been prepared on a going concern basis as explained in note 1 of the Group Financial 
Statements.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Principal risks and uncertainties are outlined in the Group Financial Statements on pages 38 to 48.	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
 
In these financial statements, the Company has applied the exemptions available under FRS 101 in respect of the following 
disclosures:
•	 a Cash Flow Statement and related notes;
•	 Comparative period reconciliations for share capital, tangible fixed assets and intangible assets;
•	 Disclosures in respect of transactions with wholly owned subsidiaries;
•	 Disclosures in respect of capital management;
•	 The effects of new but not yet effective IFRSs;
•	 Disclosures in respect of the compensation of Key Management Personnel.
•	 Disclosures of transactions with a management entity that provides key management personnel services to the company;
•	 Certain disclosures required by IAS 36 Impairments of Assets in respect of the impairment of assets.
 
As the consolidated financial statements of the Company include the equivalent disclosures, the Company has also taken 
the exemptions under FRS 101 available in respect of the following disclosures:
•	  IFRS 2 Share Based Payments in respect of group settled share based payments;
•	 Certain disclosures required by IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement and the disclosures required by IFRS 7 Financial 
Instrument Disclosures.
	
 
The accounting policies set out below have, unless otherwise stated, been applied consistently to all periods presented in 
these financial statements. 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	
	
Judgements	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The Company applies judgement in how it applies its accounting policies, which do not involve estimation, but could 
materially affect the numbers disclosed in these financial statements. There are however no such key accounting 
judgements applied in these financial statements.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	
	
Accounting estimates	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with FRS 101 requires the use of estimates and assumptions that 
affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of 
revenues and expenses during the reporting year.  Although these estimates are based on management's best knowledge 
of the amount, events or actions, actual results ultimately may differ from those estimates.	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

201
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY
Key estimate area
Key assumption
Potential impact 
within the next 
financial year
Potential 
impact in 
the longer 
term
Note 
reference
Retirement benefit 
obligations	
The main assumptions in determining the 
Company’s Retirement Benefit Obligations are: 
discount rate, mortality and rate of inflation.  
Full detail is included in the pension note in the 
Consolidated Financial Statements in note 5.1.
3
3
5.1 Group
Investment 
impairment	
The balances of investment in subsidiary 
companies and loans to subsidiary companies 
are held at cost less any impairment. An 
impairment exists when their recoverable 
amount is less than the costs held in the 
accounts. There are a number of factors which 
could impact the recoverable amount which 
creates a risk of this recoverable amount being 
lower than the investment balance held.
3
3
5 and
3.1 Group
1	
Accounting Policies continued
	
The estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis.  The estimates and associated assumptions 
are based on historical experience and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. 
Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only that 
period, or in the period of the revision and future periods if the revision affects both current and future periods.  The directors 
consider the following to be the key estimates applicable to the financial statements, which have a significant risk of resulting 
in a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year or in the long-term:
	
(b) Deferred taxation  Full provision is made for deferred taxation on all timing differences which have arisen but have not 
reversed at the balance sheet date, except as follows: 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	
(i) tax payable on the future remittance of the past earnings of subsidiaries is provided only to the extent that dividends 
have been accrued as receivable or a binding agreement to distribute all past earnings exists; 
 
 
(ii) deferred  tax assets are recognised only to the extent that it is more likely than not that they will be recovered. 
	 	
	
	
	
 
Deferred tax is measured on a non-discounted basis at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the periods in which the 
timing differences reverse, based on tax rates and laws substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
(c) Impairment excluding deferred tax assets
	
Financial assets (including trade and other debtors)
 
A financial asset not carried at fair value through profit or loss is measured for impairment losses in accordance with IFRS 
9 using an expected credit loss (ECL) model. The impairment model applies to financial assets measured at amortised 
cost.  The calculation of ECLs are a probability-weighted estimate of credit losses. For trade receivables, the Company 
applies the simplified approach set out in IFRS 9 to measure expected credit losses using a lifetime expected credit loss 
allowance. The Company considered a trade or other receivables, including intercompany receivables, to be in default 
when the borrower is unlikely to pay its credit obligations to the Company in full after all reasonable actions have been 
taken to recover the debt.
 
Non-financial assets
 
The carrying amounts of the Company’s non-financial assets, other than deferred tax assets, are reviewed at each reporting 
date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment. If any such indication exists, then the asset’s recoverable 
amount is estimated.

202
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
	
The recoverable amount of an asset or cash-generating unit is the greater of its value in use and its fair value less costs to 
sell. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount 
rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset. For the purpose 
of impairment testing, assets that cannot be tested individually are grouped together into the smallest group of assets that 
generates cash inflows from continuing use that are largely independent of the cash inflows of other assets or groups of 
assets (the 'cash-generating unit').
	
An impairment loss is recognised if the carrying amount of an asset or its CGU exceeds its estimated recoverable amount. 
Impairment losses are recognised in profit or loss. Impairment losses recognised in respect of CGUs are allocated first to 
reduce the carrying amount of any goodwill allocated to the units, and then to reduce the carrying amounts of the other 
assets in the unit (group of units) on a pro rata basis. 
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Fair value hedges	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Where a derivative financial instrument hedges the changes in fair value of recognised assets or liabilities, any gain or loss 
is recognised in profit and loss.  The hedged item is also stated, separately from the derivative, at fair value in respect of 
the risk being hedged with any gain or loss also recognised in profit and loss.  This will result in variations in the balance 
sheet values of the gross debt and the offsetting derivatives as the market value fluctuates. 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
(d) Investments Investments held as fixed assets are stated at cost less any impairment losses. For Investments the 
recoverable amount is estimated at each balance sheet date. The recoverable amount is the higher of fair value less costs 
to sell and value in use. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using 
a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the 
asset for which the estimates of future cash flows have not been adjusted. Further details of impairment testing policies 
are presented in note 3.1 of the Group Financial Statements.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
(e) Employee benefits - Share based payments  The Company operates a number of employee share option schemes.  The 
fair value at the date at which the share options are granted is recognised in profit and loss on a straight line basis over 
the vesting period, taking into account the number of options that are expected to vest.  The number of options that are 
expected to become exercisable is reviewed at each balance sheet date and if necessary estimates are revised.    
	 	
	
	
(f) Pension obligations The Company operated a defined benefit and defined contribution plan during the year, the 
assets of which are held in independent trustee administered funds.  Pension accounting costs for defined benefit plans 
are assessed by determining the pension obligation using the projected unit credit method after including a net return 
on the plan assets.  Under this method, in accordance with the advice of qualified actuaries, the amounts charged in 
respect of employee benefits reflect the cost of benefits accruing in the year and the cost of financing historical accrued 
benefits.  The Company recognises all actuarial gains and losses arising from defined benefit plans in the statement of 
other comprehensive income immediately.
	
	 	
	
	
 
The present value of pension obligations is measured by reference to market yields on high quality corporate bonds which 
have terms to maturity approximating to the terms of the related pension liability.  Plan assets are measured at fair value. 
When the calculation results in a benefit to the Company, the recognised asset is limited to the total of the present value 
of economic benefits available in the form of any future refunds from the plan or reductions in future contributions to the 
plan.  An economic benefit is available to the Company if it is realisable during the life of the plan, or on settlement of the 
plan liabilities.		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Under IAS 19  Employee Benefits, the Group recognises an interest expense or income which is calculated on the net 
defined benefit liability or asset respectively by applying the discount rate to the net defined benefit liability or asset.   
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
A defined contribution plan is one under which the Company pays fixed contributions and has no legal or constructive 
obligation to pay further amounts.  Obligations for contributions to defined contribution pension plans are recognised as 
an employee benefit expense in the income statement when they are due. 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
1	
Accounting Policies continued
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

203
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
1     Accounting Policies continued 
 
In accordance with IFRIC 14 surpluses in schemes are recognised as assets only if they represent unconditional economic 
benefits available to the Company in the future.  Provision is made for future unrecognisable surpluses that will arise 
as a result of regulatory funding requirements.  Movements in unrecognised surpluses are included in the statement of 
recognised income and expense.  If the fair value of the assets exceeds the present value of the defined benefit obligation 
then the surplus will only be recognised if the nature of the arrangements under the trust deed, and funding arrangements 
between the Trustee and the Company support the availability of refunds or recoverability through agreed reductions in 
future contributions.  In addition, if there is an obligation for the Company to pay deficit funding, this is also recognised. 
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Under the provisions of FRS 101 Pendragon PLC is designated as the principal employer of the Pendragon Group Pension 
Scheme and as such applies the full provisions of IAS 19 Employee benefits (2011).  In line with IAS 19 Employee benefits 
(2011), the Company has recognised a pension prepayment with respect to an extraordinary contribution made during 31 
December 2011 as this does not meet the definition of a planned asset and therefore the amount is held in pension prepayment 
and will be unwound over the period in which Pendragon Scottish Limited Partnership Limited makes contributions to the 
pension scheme. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 Information relating to pension obligations can be found in the Consolidated Financial Statements in note 5.1.	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(g) Dividends  Dividends proposed by the Board and unpaid at the end of the year are not recognised in the financial 
statements until they have been approved by the shareholders at the Annual General Meeting.  Interim dividends are 
recognised when they are paid. 
	
(h) Own shares held by ESOP trust  Transactions of the group-sponsored ESOP trust are included in the Company financial 
statements.  In particular, the trust’s purchases and sales of shares in the Company are debited and credited directly to 
equity.
	
(i) Contingent liabilities  Where the Company enters into financial guarantee contracts to guarantee the indebtedness 
of other companies within its group, the Company considers these to be insurance arrangements, and accounts for them 
as such.  In this respect, the Company treats the guarantee contract as a contingent liability until such time as it becomes 
probable that the Company will be required to make a payment under the guarantee.
2	
Profit and loss account of the company and distributable reserves	 	
	
	
 
In accordance with the exemption allowed by Section 408 of the Companies Act 2006, the profit and loss account of the 
Company is not presented.  The loss after taxation attributable to the Company dealt with in its own accounts for the year 
ended 31 December 2022 is £15.0m (2021: profit £167.0m).  
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
 
The profit and loss account of the Parent Company does not include any unrealised profits.  The amount available for 
distribution under the Companies Act 2006 by reference to these accounts is £365.4m (2021: £369.5m) which is stated 
after deducting the ESOT reserve of £18.5m (2021: £18.1m).  The Group's subsidiary companies which earn distributable 
profits themselves are expected to make distributions each year up to the Parent Company in due course to ensure a 
regular flow of income to the Company such that surplus cash generated can continue to be returned to our external 
shareholders.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

204
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
3	
Directors	
	
	
Total emoluments of directors (including pension contributions) amounted to £5.0m (2021: £5.3m).  Information relating to 
directors' emoluments, share options and pension entitlements is set out in the Directors' Remuneration Report on pages 
77 to 95.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
The directors are the only employees of the Company.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
4	 Dividends
 
The Board is not recommending the payment of a final dividend for 2022 (2021: nil).
5	
Investments
	
In assessing the carrying value of investments in subsidiary undertakings, an assessment of the recoverable amount 
of each investment has been undertaken using the same methodology and assumptions that were used to derive the 
recoverable amounts of CGUs (which have been allocated to the relevant subsidiary) that was undertaken as part of the 
Group CGU impairment assessment (note 3.1); included the intercompany receivables and payables due between group 
entities and then assessed whether there were additional current assets, such as cash, which should be included in the 
Investment recoverable amount assessment. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
These recoverable amounts have been assessed during the period in line with IAS 36. The assessment resulted in nil 
provision for impairment for the year ended 31 Decemeber 2022 (2021: impairment charges reversal of £177.2m) to the 
investment in subsidary undertakings.  When assessing the carrying value, the value was determined by the higher of its 
value in use and its fair value less costs to sell, as described in note 3.1. The range of pre-tax discount rates used was 9.1% 
- 16.7%. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The directors have considered and assessed reasonably possible changes to the key assumptions used in determining 
the recoverable amounts and have performed sensitivities on these key assumptions. This assessment resulted in the 
reasonably possible key assumption changes not leading to any impact on the carrying value of investments in subsidiary 
undertakings for year ended 31 December 2022.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 Shares in subsidiary 
	
 undertakings 
	
 £m 
Cost
 
At 31 December 2021 and at 31 December 2022
 981.2 
Impairment
At 31 December 2021 and at 31 December 2022
 -   
Carrying amounts
At 31 December 2021 and at 31 December 2022
 981.2 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

205
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
	
	
Shares in subsidiary undertakings are stated at cost.  
 
Pendragon PLC owns directly or indirectly 100 percent of the issued ordinary share capital of the following subsidiaries. 
	
Incorporated in Great Britain having a registered office at Loxley House, 2 Little Oak Drive, Annesley, Nottingham, NG15 0DR:
	
Incorporated in Great Britain having a registered office at Citypoint, 65 Haymarket Terrace, Edinburgh, Scotland, EH12 5HD: 
	
Pendragon General Partner Limited *	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Incorporated in the United States of America having a registered office at 2171 Campus Dr Ste 260, Irvine, California: 
 
	
Pendragon North America Automotive, Inc.	
Penegon Glendale, Inc.	
SouthCounty, Inc.	
 
Penegon West, Inc. 
Lincoln Irvine, Inc. 
Bauer Motors, Inc. 
 
 
 
Penegon Mission Viejo, Inc. 
Penegon South Bay, Inc. 
Penegon Properties, Inc. 
 
 
Penegon Newport Beach, Inc. 
Penegon Santa Monica, Inc. 
Penegon East, Inc.
	
Incorporated in Sweden having a registered office at Eversheds Sutherland, Strandvägen, Box 11451, 104 40, Stockholm
 
Pinewood Technologies Northern Europe AB 
 
 
	
	
	
* 	Direct subsidiary of Pendragon PLC	
	
	
 
** Pendragon PLC owns 95% of the issued ordinary share capital 
 
 
5	
Investments continued
Bramall Quicks Dealerships Limited
Stratstone Motor Holdings Limited *
Evans Halshaw Motor Holdings Limited
Bramall Quicks Limited
Stratstone.com Limited
Executive Motor Group Limited
Car Store Limited
Suresell Limited
G.E. Harper Limited
Car Store.com Limited
Victoria (Bavaria) Limited
Godfrey Davis (Trust) Limited
CD Bramall Limited *
Allens (Plymouth) Limited
Godfrey Davis Motor Group Limited
Chatfields Limited
Alloy Racing Equipment Limited
Lewcan Limited
Derwent Vehicles Limited
Andre Baldet Limited
Manchester Garages Holdings Limited
Evans Halshaw Limited
Arena Auto Limited
Paramount Cars Limited
Evans Halshaw.com Limited
Bletchley Motor Company Limited
Pendragon Motor Group Limited 
National Fleet Solutions Limited
Bletchley Motor Group Limited
Petrogate Limited
Pendragon Automotive Services Limited *
Bramall Contracts Limited
Petrogate Properties Limited
Pendragon Finance & Insurance Services Limited *
Bridgegate Limited
Pinewood Computers Limited
Pendragon Group Pension Trustees Limited *
Brightdart Limited
Plumtree Motor Company Limited
Pendragon Group Services Limited *
C.G.S.B Holdings Limited
Quicks (1997) Motor Holdings Limited
Pendragon Limited Partner Limited *
CD Bramall Dealerships Limited
Quicks Finance Limited
Pendragon Management Services Limited
CD Bramall Motor Group Limited
Reg Vardy (Property Management) Limited
Pendragon Overseas Limited *
CD Bramall Pension Trustee Limited
Reg Vardy (TMC) Limited
Pendragon Premier Limited
Central Motor Company (Leicester) Limited
Reg Vardy (TMH) Limited
Pendragon Property Holdings Limited
Charles Sidney Limited
Skipper of Darlington Limited
Pendragon Sabre Limited
Chatfields - Martin Walter Limited
Skipper of Wakefield Limited
Pendragon Stock Finance Limited
Dunham & Haines Limited
Stripestar Limited
Pendragon Vehicle Management Limited
Evans Halshaw (Cardiff) Limited
The Car and Van Store Limited
Pinewood Technologies PLC *
Evans Halshaw (Dormants) Limited *
The Skipper Group Limited
Reg Vardy Limited *
Evans Halshaw (Midlands) Limited
Trust Properties Limited
Stratstone Limited 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

206
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
6	
Debtors
 
	
	
Expected credit losses in respect of trade and other intercompany receivables are deemed immaterial.	
	
7	
Creditors: amounts falling due within one year	
	
	 	
	
	
 
Amounts due to subsidiary undertakings are repayable on demand but may remain outstanding indefinitely.
8	
Creditors: amounts falling due after more than one year
	
	
	
	
 
Full details of the Company’s borrowings including security and maturity are given in note 4.2 to the consolidated financial 
statements.
2022
£m
2021
£m
Amounts due within one year:
Prepayments
1.7 
 24.5 
1.7
 24.5 
Amounts due after more than one year:
Prepayments
 21.1 
 - 
Deferred tax (see note 9)
1.9 
 6.1 
 23.0 
 6.1 
24.7 
 30.6
2022
£m
2021
£m
Amounts due to subsidiary undertakings
 489.2
 454.2 
Senior Term Finance Agreement
1.7 
 -  
Bank loans and overdrafts
 0.5 
 21.5 
 491.4 
 475.7 
2022
£m
2021
£m
Bank loans (repayable between one and two years)
 -   
 27.1 
5.75% Senior notes 2023
 -   
 60.0 
Senior Term Finance Agreement
 90.8 
 -   
 90.8 
 87.1 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

207
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
Number
 £m 
Allotted, called up and fully paid shares of 5p each
at 31 December 2021 and at 31 December 2022
1,396,944,405
 69.9 
9	
Deferred tax	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets 
against current tax liabilities and when the deferred income taxes relate to the same fiscal authority.  There are no offset 
amounts as follows:
 
The movement in the deferred tax assets for the year is as follows:
 
Deferred tax asset is shown within debtors (see note 6).
10	 Share based payments	
	
	
 
Details of share schemes in place for the Group of which the Company participates as at 31 December 2022 are fully 
disclosed above in note 4.6 of this report.
	
	
11	 Called up share capital and reserves	
 
There were no issues of ordinary shares during the year.  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
	 	
 
Movements in the number of options to acquire ordinary shares under the Group's various share option schemes, together 
with exercise prices and the outstanding position at 31 December 2021 are fully disclosed above in note 4.6 of this report.
 
Transactions of the Group-sponsored EBT are included in the Company's financial statements. In particular, the trust’s 
purchases of shares in the Company, which are classified as own shares, are debited directly to equity through retained 
earnings. When own shares are sold or reissued the resulting surplus or deficit on the transaction is also recognised within 
retained earnings.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2022
£m
2021
£m
Deferred tax assets
 1.9 
 6.1 
 Retirement 
 benefit 
 obligations 
£m 
 Other 
 provisions 
 £m 
 Total 
 £m 
At 1 January 2021
 14.4 
 0.7 
 15.1 
(Charged)/credited to income statement
 (2.4)
 0.1 
 (2.3)
(Charged)/credited to equity
 (6.9)
 0.2 
 (6.7)
At 31 December 2021
 5.1 
 1.0 
 6.1 
At 1 January 2022
 5.1 
 1.0 
 6.1 
(Charged) to income statement
 (2.5)
 -   
 (2.5)
(Charged) to equity
 (1.6)
 (0.1)
 (1.7)
At 31 December 2022
 1.0 
 0.9 
 1.9 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

208
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
	
	 	
	
	
	
The market value of the investment in the Group's own shares at 31 December 2022 was £0.3m (2021: £1.3m), being 
1.5m (2021: 5.8m) shares with a nominal value of 5p each, acquired at an average cost of £0.24 each (2021: £0.33). The 
trustee of the EBT is Salamanca Group Trust (Jersey) Limited. The shares in trust may subsequently be awarded to 
Executive Directors and employees under the Pendragon 1999 Approved Executive Share Option Scheme, Pendragon 
1999 Unapproved Executive Share Option Scheme and to satisfy amounts under LTIPs. Details of the plans are given in the 
Directors' Remuneration Report on pages 77 to 95.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
 
Dividends on the shares owned by the trust, the purchase of which were funded by interest free loans to the trust from 
Pendragon PLC, are waived.  All expenses incurred by the trust are settled directly by Pendragon PLC and charged in the 
accounts as incurred.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Capital redemption reserve
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
The capital redemption reserve has arisen following the purchase by the Group of its own shares and comprises the 
amount by which distributable profits were reduced on these transactions in accordance with s733 of the Companies Act 
2006. There were no transfers into the capital redemption reserve during the year in respect of shares purchased by the 
Group and subsequently cancelled (2021: nil).
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Other reserves	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Other reserves comprise the amount of demerger reserve arising on the demerger of the Group from Williams Holdings 
PLC in 1989.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
12	 Retirement benefit obligations	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Details of Pendragon Group Pension Scheme are fully disclosed above in note 5.1 of this report.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
13	 Related party transactions	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Identity of related parties
 
The Company has related party relationships with its subsidiaries and with its key management personnel.
 
Transactions with related parties
 
The transactions with directors of the Company are set out in note 6.2 to the consolidated financial statements.
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
14	 Contingent liabilities	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
(a) The company has entered into cross-guarantees with its bankers whereby it guarantees payment of bank borrowings 
in respect of UK subsidiary undertakings.		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(b) The company has given performance guarantees in the normal course of business in respect of subsidiary undertaking 
obligations.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY

209
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
ADVISORS, BANKS AND SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION
Share dealing service
Pendragon’s company registrar offers a share dealing service, 
provided by Link Asset Services (a trading name of Link 
Market Services). Details appear at www.linksharedeal.com  
Shareholder and investor information  
Making some of our corporate materials and policies available 
on our website reduces the length of this Report. This year 
we have placed certain background information on policy and 
governance on our website. We also display historic financial 
reports and have a section on company news, which we 
regularly update on www.pendragonplc.com
Online services
Shareholders can choose to receive communications and 
access a variety of share-related services online via the share 
portal offered by Pendragon’s company registrar. This allows 
shareholders to manage their shareholding electronically and 
is free of charge. For details, visit www.mypendragonshares.
com 
Getting company reports online
Reduces the environmental impacts of report distribution. 
To choose online only reporting, visit the share portal and 
register for electronic form reporting, or contact our registrar, 
whose details are:
Registrar and shareholder enquiries
Link Asset Services
The Registry
34 Beckenham Road
Beckenham
Kent
BR3 4TU
shareholderenquiries@linkgroup.co.uk
Tel: 0871 664 0300
Financial Calendar 2023
22 March 
date of this Report            
22 March 
preliminary announcement of 2022 results
Auditor
KPMG LLP
Banks
Barclays Bank PLC
Lloyds TSB Bank plc
Royal Bank of Scotland plc
Allied Irish Banks plc
HSBC Bank plc
Stockbrokers
Joh. Berenberg, Gossler & Co. KG 
Jefferies International Limited 
Solicitors
CMS Cameron McKenna Nabarro Olswang LLP
Geldards LLP
Eversheds LLP
How to find Pendragon PLC’s offices
Visit Contacts on the company’s website
www.pendragonplc.com.
Stock Classification
The company’s ordinary shares are traded on the London 
Stock Exchange.  Investment codes for Pendragon’s shares 
are:
London Stock Exchange:	
PDG
Bloomberg:	
PDG.LN
GlobalTOPIC and Reuters:	 PDG.L

210
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022
5 YEAR GROUP REVIEW
2022
IFRS 16
£m
2021
IFRS 16
£m
2020
IFRS 16
£m
2019
IFRS 16
£m
2018
IAS 17
£m
Revenue
 3,620.0 
 3,449.9 
 2,924.6 
 4,506.1 
 4,627.0 
Gross profit
 457.2 
 441.3 
 353.2 
 472.7 
 550.5 
Operating profit/(loss) before other income
93.3 
 104.9 
16.0 
 (104.4)
 (30.1) 
Profit/(loss) before taxation
57.2 
 73.3 
(29.6)
 (114.1)
 (44.4) 
Basic earnings per share
3.3p
4.4p
(1.8p)
(8.4p)
(3.6p)
Net assets 
 281.0 
 225.6 
 126.7
 168.9 
 345.6 
Adjusted Net borrowings (note 1)
 23.3 
 49.7 
 100.4 
 119.7 
 126.1 
Other financial information
Underlying profit/(loss) before tax
57.6 
 83.0 
 8.2 
 (16.4)
 47.8 
Underlying earnings per share (note 4)
3.2p
5.0p
0.6p
(1.2p)
2.8p
Adjusted net debt: underlying EBITDA (note 6)
 0.1 
 0.3 
 0.8 
 1.1 
 0.9 
Gross margin
12.6%
12.8%
12.1%
10.5%
11.9%
Total operating margin (note 2)
2.6%
3.0%
0.5%
-2.3%
-0.7%
After tax return on equity (note 3)
18.0%
34.9%
-16.7%
-45.6%
-13.1%
Dividends per share (note 5)
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
1.5p
Dividend cover (times) (note 7)
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 2.0 
Interest cover (times) (note 8)
2.3 
 3.1 
 0.2 
 (1.7)
 (0.5)
Gearing (note 9)
8.3%
22.0%
79.2%
70.9%
36.5%
Business summary
Number of franchise points
131
138
146
166
186
note 1 
Adjusted net borrowings comprise interest bearing loans and borrowings, cash and cash equivalents and derivative financial instruments, excluding lease liabilities.
note 2	
Total operating margin is calculated after adding back non-underlying items, and excluding other income.	
	
	
	
note 3 
Return on equity is profit after tax for the year as a percentage of average shareholders’ funds. 
note 4 
Basic earnings per share adjusted to eliminate the effects of non-underlying operating, non-underlying finance and tax items, see note 2.8 of the financial statements. 
note 5 
Dividends per share are based on the interim dividend paid and final dividend proposed for the year.
note 6 
Full details of the calculation of the net debt : underlying EBITDA ratio are given in note 4.2 to the financial statements. 
note 7 
Dividend cover is underlying profit after tax divided by the total of the interim dividend paid and the final dividend per share.
note 8 
Interest cover is operating profit divided by net finance expense. 
note 9 
Gearing is calculated as net borrowings as a percentage of net assets. 
 
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	
	
	 	
	
	
	

211
Pendragon PLC Annual Report 2022

ADDRESS I Pendragon PLC Loxley House, 2 Oakwood Court, Little Oak Drive, Annesley, Nottingham NG15 0DR 
TELEPHONE I 01623 725200  E-MAIL I enquiries@pendragon.uk.com
WEBSITE I www.pendragonplc.com
DESIGN I Creative Services Loxley House, 2 Oakwood Court, Little Oak Drive, Annesley, Nottingham NG15 0DR